1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.98"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
54 .set drivernamemax "64"
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
61 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
62 . provided in the xfpt library.
63 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
65 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
67 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
69 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
70 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
72 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
73 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
75 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
76 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
77 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
79 . --- Also one for multiple option def headings be grouped in a single
80 . --- table (but without the split capability).
83 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
87 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
98 .orow "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .orow "$+1" "$+2" "$+3" "$+4"
113 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
114 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
115 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
117 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
118 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
122 . --- A macro for a plain variable, including the .vitem and .vindex
128 . --- A macro for a "tainted" marker, done as a one-element table
130 .itable none 0 0 1 10pt left
135 . --- A macro for a tainted variable, adding a taint-marker
141 . --- A macro for a cmdline option, including a .oindex
142 . --- 1st arg is the option name, undecorated (we do that here).
143 . --- 2nd arg, optional, text (decorated as needed) to be appended to the name
145 .vitem &%$1%&$=2+&~$2+
149 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
150 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
151 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
155 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
159 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
167 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
168 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
169 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
170 . --- ID that ties them together.
171 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
172 . --- head, or list-item.
175 &<indexterm role="concept">&
176 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
178 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
184 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
185 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
187 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
193 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
197 &<indexterm role="option">&
198 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
200 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
205 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
206 . --- head, or varlist item.
209 &<indexterm role="variable">&
210 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
212 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
218 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
222 . use this for a concept-index entry for a header line
224 .cindex "&'$1'& header line"
225 .cindex "header lines" $1
227 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
231 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
233 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
237 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
238 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
242 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
243 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
244 <revhistory><revision>
246 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
247 </revision></revhistory>
250 </year><holder>The Exim Maintainers</holder></copyright>
255 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
256 . These implement index entries of the form "x, see y" and "x, see also y".
257 . However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
258 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
259 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
261 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
265 <indexterm role="$2">
266 <primary>$3</primary>
268 <secondary>$5</secondary>
270 <$1><emphasis>$4</emphasis></$1>
275 . NB: for the 4-arg variant the ordering is awkward
277 .seeother see "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
280 .seeother seealso "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
283 .see variable "<emphasis>$1</emphasis>, <emphasis>$2</emphasis>, etc." "numerical variables"
284 .see concept address rewriting rewriting
285 .see concept "Bounce Address Tag Validation" BATV
286 .see concept "Client SMTP Authorization" CSA
287 .see concept "CR character" "carriage return"
288 .see concept CRL "certificate revocation list"
289 .seealso concept de-tainting "tainted data"
290 .see concept delivery "bounce message" "failure report"
291 .see concept dialup "intermittently connected hosts"
292 .see concept exiscan "content scanning"
293 .see concept fallover fallback
294 .see concept filter "Sieve filter" Sieve
295 .see concept headers "header lines"
296 .see concept ident "RFC 1413"
297 .see concept "LF character" "linefeed"
298 .seealso concept maximum limit
299 .see concept monitor "Exim monitor"
300 .see concept "no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis>" "entry for xxx"
301 .see concept NUL "binary zero"
302 .see concept "passwd file" "/etc/passwd"
303 .see concept "process id" pid
304 .see concept RBL "DNS list"
305 .see concept redirection "address redirection"
306 .see concept "return path" "envelope sender"
307 .see concept scanning "content scanning"
309 .see concept string expansion expansion
310 .see concept "top bit" "8-bit characters"
311 .see concept variables "expansion, variables"
312 .see concept "zero, binary" "binary zero"
315 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
316 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
317 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
318 . chapter "Introduction"
319 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
321 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
322 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
323 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
324 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
326 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
327 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
328 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
329 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
330 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
331 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
332 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
334 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
335 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
336 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
338 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
339 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
340 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
342 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
343 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
344 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
345 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
346 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
348 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
349 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
350 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
351 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
352 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
354 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
355 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
356 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
357 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
361 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
362 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
365 .cindex "documentation"
366 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
367 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
368 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
369 capable of showing a change indicator.
372 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
373 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
374 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
375 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
376 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
377 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
378 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
381 .cindex "books about Exim"
382 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
383 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
384 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
385 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
387 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
388 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
389 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
390 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
392 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
393 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
394 Debian-specific features in the file
395 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
396 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
399 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
400 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
402 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
403 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
404 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
405 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
406 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
408 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
409 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
410 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
411 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
413 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
414 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
416 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
417 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
418 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
422 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
423 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
424 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
425 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
426 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
427 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
428 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
429 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
432 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
433 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
434 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
438 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
441 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
442 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
443 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
447 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
448 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
449 online information is &url(https://wiki.exim.org,the Exim wiki),
450 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
451 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
452 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
453 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
456 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
457 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
458 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
459 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
462 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
463 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
464 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
467 .row &'exim-announce@lists.exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
468 .row &'exim-users@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list"
469 .row &'exim-users-de@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list in German language"
470 .row &'exim-dev@lists.exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
471 .row &'exim-cvs@lists.exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
474 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
475 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
476 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
477 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
478 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
481 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
483 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
486 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
487 .cindex "bug reports"
488 .cindex "reporting bugs"
489 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
490 via &url(https://bugs.exim.org,the Bugzilla). However, if you are unsure
491 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
492 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
496 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
498 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
499 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
500 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
501 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
503 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
505 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
506 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
508 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
509 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
510 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
512 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
513 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
514 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
515 here are top-level directories.
517 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
518 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
520 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
521 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
522 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
523 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
527 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
529 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
530 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
531 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
532 most portable to old systems.
534 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
535 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
536 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
537 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
538 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
539 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
540 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
541 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
542 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
543 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
544 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
546 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
547 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
548 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
549 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
551 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
553 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
554 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
555 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
557 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
558 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
559 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
561 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
562 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
563 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
564 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
566 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
568 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
569 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
571 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
572 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
575 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
577 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
578 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
579 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
580 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
581 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
582 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
583 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
584 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
586 .cindex "domainless addresses"
587 .cindex "address" "without domain"
588 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
589 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
590 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
591 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
594 .cindex "transport" "external"
595 .cindex "external transports"
596 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
597 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
598 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
599 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
600 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
601 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
603 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
604 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
605 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
608 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
609 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
610 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
611 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
612 a number of common scanners are provided.
616 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
617 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
618 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
619 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
620 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
621 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
624 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
625 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
626 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
627 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
628 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
629 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
630 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
631 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
632 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
633 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
634 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
635 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
637 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
638 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
639 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
640 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
644 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
645 .cindex "terminology definitions"
646 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
647 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
648 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
649 below) by a blank line.
651 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
652 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
653 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
654 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
655 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
656 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
657 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
658 rise to further bounce messages.
660 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
661 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
662 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
665 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
666 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
667 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
670 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
671 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
672 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
674 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
675 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
676 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
677 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
678 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
679 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
680 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
681 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
683 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
684 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
685 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
686 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
687 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
688 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
691 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
692 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
693 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from
694 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822), is used to refer to the
695 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
696 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
698 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
699 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
700 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
701 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
702 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
703 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
705 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
706 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
709 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
710 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
711 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
712 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
713 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
715 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
717 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
718 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
719 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
721 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
722 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
723 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
724 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
725 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
726 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
734 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
736 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
737 .cindex "incorporated code"
738 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
741 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
744 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
745 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE2 library, copyright
746 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE2 is not longer shipped with
747 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE2 shipped with your system,
748 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
749 &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
751 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
752 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
753 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
754 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
755 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
756 following statements:
759 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
761 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
762 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
763 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
765 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
766 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
767 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
768 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
769 restrictions applied to it).
772 .cindex "SPA authentication"
773 .cindex "Samba project"
774 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
775 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
776 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
777 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
781 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
782 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
783 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
784 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
785 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
786 conditions expressed therein.
789 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
791 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
792 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
796 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
797 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
799 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
800 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
801 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
804 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
805 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
806 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
807 details, please contact
809 Office of Technology Transfer
810 Carnegie Mellon University
812 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
813 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
814 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
817 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
820 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
821 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
823 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
824 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
825 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
826 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
827 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
828 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
829 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
834 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
837 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
838 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
839 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
840 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
843 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
844 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
848 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
849 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
850 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
851 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
852 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
853 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
854 software without specific, written prior permission.
856 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
857 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
858 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
859 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
860 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
861 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
866 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
867 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
868 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
869 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
870 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
874 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
875 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
876 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
884 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
886 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
887 "Receiving and delivering mail"
890 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
891 .cindex "design philosophy"
892 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
893 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
894 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
895 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
896 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
897 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
900 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
901 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
902 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
903 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
904 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
905 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
906 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
909 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
910 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
911 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
912 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
913 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
914 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
915 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
916 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
917 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
920 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
921 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
923 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
924 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
925 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
926 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
928 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
929 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
930 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
931 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
932 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
934 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
935 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
936 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
938 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
939 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
940 runs at the start of every delivery process.
945 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
946 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
947 .cindex "Sieve filter"
948 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
949 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
950 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
951 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
952 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
953 of filtering are available:
956 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
957 by &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3028.html,RFC 3028).
959 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
960 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
963 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
967 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
968 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
969 .cindex "format" "of message id"
970 .cindex "id of message"
975 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
976 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is 23
977 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
978 example &`16VDhn-000000001bo-D342`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
979 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
980 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
981 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
982 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
983 not always case-sensitive.
985 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
986 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
987 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
988 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
989 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
990 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
994 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
995 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
996 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
997 way of representing the date and time of day).
999 After the first hyphen, the next
1001 characters are the id of the process that received the message.
1003 There are two different possibilities for the final four characters:
1005 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1006 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1007 time of reception, normally in units of
1010 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1011 systems), the units are
1014 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by
1015 500000 (250000) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 2 us (4 us).
1020 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1021 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1022 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1023 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1024 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026 The exim_msgdate utility (see section &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>&) can be
1027 used to display the date, and optionally the process id, of an Exim
1031 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1032 .cindex "receiving mail"
1033 .cindex "message" "reception"
1034 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1035 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1036 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1037 there are several possibilities:
1040 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1041 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1042 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1044 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1045 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1046 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1047 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1048 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1049 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1051 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1052 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1053 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1054 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1055 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1057 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1058 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1059 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1060 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1064 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1065 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1066 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1067 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1068 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1069 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1070 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1071 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1072 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1073 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1074 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1075 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1076 users to change sender addresses.
1078 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1079 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1080 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1081 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1082 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1083 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1084 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1086 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1087 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1088 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1089 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1090 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1091 message is received.
1097 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1098 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1099 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1100 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1101 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1102 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1103 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1104 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1106 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1107 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1108 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1109 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1110 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1111 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1112 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1113 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1114 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1115 affect file system performance.
1117 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1118 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1119 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1120 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1121 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1123 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1124 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1125 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1126 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1127 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1128 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1129 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1130 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1131 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1132 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1133 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1134 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1138 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1139 .cindex "message" "life of"
1140 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1141 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1142 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1143 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1144 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1145 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1146 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1148 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1149 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1150 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1151 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1152 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1155 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1156 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1157 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1158 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1159 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1161 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1162 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1163 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1164 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1165 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1166 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1167 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1168 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1169 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1170 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1173 .cindex "journal file"
1174 .cindex "file" "journal"
1175 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1176 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1177 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1178 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1179 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1180 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1181 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1182 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1184 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1185 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1186 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1187 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1188 deliveries caused by crashes.
1192 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1193 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1194 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1195 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1196 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1197 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1198 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1199 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1200 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1202 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1203 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1204 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1205 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1206 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1207 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1208 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1209 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1210 the driver's features in general.
1212 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1213 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1214 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1215 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1218 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1219 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1220 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1221 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1222 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1223 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1225 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1226 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1227 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1228 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1229 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1230 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1232 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1233 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1234 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1237 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1238 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1239 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1240 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1241 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1242 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1243 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1244 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1245 configured to fail the address.
1247 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1248 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1249 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1250 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1251 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1252 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1254 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1255 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1256 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1257 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1258 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1259 the address is bounced.
1263 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1264 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1265 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1266 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1267 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1268 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1269 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1270 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1272 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1273 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1274 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1275 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1276 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1277 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1278 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1279 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1284 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1285 .cindex "router" "running details"
1286 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1287 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1288 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1289 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1290 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1291 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1295 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1296 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1297 original address ceases
1298 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1299 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1300 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1301 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1302 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1305 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1306 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1307 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1308 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1309 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1311 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1312 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1313 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1314 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1315 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1317 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1318 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1319 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1320 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1321 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1323 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1324 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1325 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1327 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1328 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1329 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1330 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1332 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1333 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1336 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1337 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1338 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1339 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1340 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1342 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1343 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1344 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1345 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1346 facility for this purpose.
1349 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1350 .cindex "case of local parts"
1351 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1352 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1353 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1354 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1355 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1356 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1357 routed addresses are shown.
1361 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1362 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1363 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1364 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1365 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1366 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1369 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1370 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1371 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1372 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1373 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1374 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1375 of any other conditions.
1377 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1378 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1379 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1381 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1382 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1383 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1384 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1385 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1387 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1388 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1389 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1390 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1391 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1393 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1394 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1395 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1397 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1398 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1401 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1402 of domains that it defines.
1403 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
1404 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
1405 A match verifies the variable &$domain$& (which carries tainted data)
1406 and assigns an untainted value to the &$domain_data$& variable.
1407 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1408 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1409 refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&.
1411 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1412 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1415 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1416 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
1417 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1418 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1419 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
1420 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1421 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1422 the set of local parts that it defines.
1423 A match verifies the variable &$local_part$& (which carries tainted data)
1424 and assigns an untainted value to the &$local_part_data$& variable.
1425 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1426 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1427 refer to section &<<SECTlocparlis>>&.
1429 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1430 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1432 If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1433 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1434 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1435 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1436 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&,
1437 &$local_part_prefix_v$&, &$local_part_suffix$&
1438 and &$local_part_suffix_v$& as necessary.
1441 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1442 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1444 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1445 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1446 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1447 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1448 remaining preconditions.
1451 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1452 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1453 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1454 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1455 could lead to confusion.
1458 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1459 set of addresses that it defines.
1462 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1463 specified files is tested.
1466 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1467 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1468 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1469 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1471 Note that while using
1472 this option for address matching technically works,
1473 it does not set any de-tainted values.
1474 Such values are often needed, either for router-specific options or
1475 for transport options.
1476 Using the &%domains%& and &%local_parts%& options is usually the most
1477 convenient way to obtain them.
1481 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1482 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1483 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1484 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1485 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1486 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1487 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1491 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1492 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1493 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1496 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1497 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1498 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1499 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1500 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1502 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1503 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1505 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1506 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1507 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1508 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1509 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1510 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1513 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1514 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1515 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1516 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1517 processed entirely independently of each other.
1519 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1520 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1521 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1522 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1523 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1524 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1525 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1526 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1527 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1529 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1530 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1531 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1532 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1533 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1534 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1535 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1536 addresses to the same domain.
1538 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1539 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1540 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1541 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1542 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1543 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1544 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1545 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1547 .cindex "queue runner"
1548 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1549 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1550 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1551 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1552 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1553 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1554 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1555 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1556 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1558 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1559 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1560 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1561 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1562 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1563 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1565 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1566 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1567 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1568 messages to other addresses.
1570 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1571 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1572 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1575 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1576 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1577 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1583 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1584 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1585 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1586 .cindex "queue runner"
1587 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1588 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1589 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1590 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1591 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1592 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1593 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1594 passed its retry time.
1595 You can run several queue runners at once.
1597 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1598 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1599 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1600 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1601 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1606 .subsection "Temporary delivery failure" SECID20
1607 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1608 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1609 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1610 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1611 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1612 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1613 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1614 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1617 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1618 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1619 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1621 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1622 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1623 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1624 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1625 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1630 .subsection "Permanent delivery failure" SECID21
1631 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1632 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1633 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1634 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1635 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1636 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1637 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1638 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1639 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1640 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1642 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1643 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1644 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1647 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1648 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1649 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1650 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1651 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1652 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1653 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1658 .subsection "Failures to deliver bounce messages" SECID22
1659 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1660 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1661 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1662 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1663 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1664 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1665 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1671 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1672 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1674 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1675 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1677 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1678 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1679 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1680 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1683 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1684 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1686 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1687 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1688 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1689 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1693 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1694 following subdirectories are created:
1697 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1698 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1699 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1700 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1701 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1702 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1703 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1706 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1707 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1708 that may be useful to some sites.
1711 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1712 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1713 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1714 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1715 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1716 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1718 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1719 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1720 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1721 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1722 overridden if necessary.
1723 .cindex compiler requirements
1724 .cindex compiler version
1725 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1728 .section "PCRE2 library" "SECTpcre"
1729 .cindex "PCRE2 library"
1730 Exim no longer has an embedded regular-expression library as the vast majority of
1731 modern systems include PCRE2 as a system library, although you may need to
1732 install the PCRE2 package or the PCRE2 development package for your operating
1733 system. If your system has a normal PCRE2 installation the Exim build
1734 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1735 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE2_LIBS
1736 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1737 or set PCRE2_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1738 If your operating system has no
1739 PCRE2 support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE2
1740 from &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
1741 More information on PCRE2 is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1743 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1744 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1745 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1746 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1747 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1748 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1749 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1751 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1752 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1753 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1754 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1755 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1756 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1757 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1758 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1760 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1761 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1762 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1763 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1764 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1765 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1766 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1767 Berkeley DB library.
1770 Ownership of the Berkeley DB library has moved to a major corporation;
1771 development seems to have stalled and documentation is not freely available.
1772 This is probably not tenable for the long term use by Exim.
1775 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1776 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1780 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1781 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1783 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1784 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1785 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1786 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1787 filename is used unmodified.
1789 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1790 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1791 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1792 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1794 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1795 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1796 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1798 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1799 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1800 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while,
1801 but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 5.&'x'&.
1802 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased,
1803 and Exim no longer supports versions before 3.&'x'&.
1804 All versions of Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1805 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1806 page with far newer versions listed.
1807 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1808 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1809 suited to Exim's usage model.
1811 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1812 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1813 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1814 operates on a single file.
1816 It is possible to use &url(https://www.sqlite.org/index.html,sqlite3)
1817 for the DBM library.
1821 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1822 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1823 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1824 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1825 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1829 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, for tdb you set USE_TDB,
1830 and for sqlite3 you set USE_SQLITE.
1831 An error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1832 You can set USE_NDBM if needed to override an operating system default.
1834 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1835 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1836 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1837 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1838 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1839 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1841 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1842 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1843 in one of these lines:
1848 DBMLIB = -lgdbm -lgdbm_compat
1850 The last of those was for a Linux having GDBM provide emulated NDBM facilities.
1851 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1852 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1853 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1854 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1857 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1858 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1860 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1861 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1864 When moving from one DBM library to another,
1865 for the hints databases it suffices to just remove all the files in the
1866 directory named &"db/"& under the spool directory.
1867 This is because hints are only for optimisation and will be rebuilt
1868 during normal operations.
1869 Non-hints DBM databases (used by &"dbm"& lookups in the configuration)
1870 will need individual rebuilds for the new DBM library.
1871 This is not done automatically
1876 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1877 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1878 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1879 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1880 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1881 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1882 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1883 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1884 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1885 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1886 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1887 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1889 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1890 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1891 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1892 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1893 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1894 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1896 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1897 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1898 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1899 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1900 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1901 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1904 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1905 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1906 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1907 facilities, you need to set
1909 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1911 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1912 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1915 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1916 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1917 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1918 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1919 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1920 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1921 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1923 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1924 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1925 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1926 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1927 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1932 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1933 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1935 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1936 described in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047).
1937 This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1938 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1939 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1940 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1941 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1942 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1944 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1945 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1946 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1947 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1948 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1952 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1956 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1957 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1958 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1959 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1960 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1961 Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1962 command as per &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2487,RFC 2487).
1963 It can also support clients that expect to
1964 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1965 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1968 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1969 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1972 If you do not want TLS support you should set
1976 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1978 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1981 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1983 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1984 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1987 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1988 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1990 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1991 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1994 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1996 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1997 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
2000 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
2002 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
2003 library and include files. For example:
2006 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
2007 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
2009 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
2010 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
2013 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
2016 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
2017 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
2018 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
2023 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
2025 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
2026 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
2027 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
2028 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
2029 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
2030 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
2031 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
2032 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
2033 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
2034 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
2035 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
2036 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
2039 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
2040 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
2041 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
2043 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
2044 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
2046 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
2048 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
2049 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
2050 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
2051 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
2052 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
2053 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
2057 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
2058 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
2059 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
2060 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
2061 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
2062 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
2065 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2066 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2067 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2068 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2069 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2071 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2076 .section "Dynamically loaded module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2077 .cindex "lookup modules"
2078 .cindex "router modules"
2079 .cindex "transport modules"
2080 .cindex "authenticator modules"
2081 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2082 .cindex ".so building"
2083 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2084 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2086 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2087 library dependencies without requiring all systems to install all of those
2090 Any combination of lookup types can be built this way.
2091 Lookup types that provide several variants will be loaded as
2093 Types that provide only one method are not loaded until used by
2094 the runtime configuration.
2098 set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2099 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2100 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2101 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2102 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2103 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2105 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2106 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2107 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2108 only if each is installed:
2114 Set also &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&>&` INCLUDE`& and
2115 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&>`_LIBS if needed for each lookup type,
2116 ensuring that duplicates are not present in more global values.
2119 Similarly, authenticator, router and transport drivers can be built
2120 as external modules.
2121 Modules will be searched for as demanded by the runtime configuration,
2122 permitting a smaller Exim binary.
2124 For building, as above but using
2125 &`AUTH_*`&, &`ROUTER_*`& and &`TRANSPORT_*`& instead of &`LOOKUP_*`&,
2129 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2130 .cindex "build directory"
2131 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2132 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2133 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2134 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2135 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2136 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2137 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2139 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2140 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2141 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2142 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2143 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2144 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2145 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2146 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2148 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2149 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2150 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2154 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2155 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2156 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2157 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2158 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2159 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2160 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2164 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2165 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2166 given in addition to the short output.
2170 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2171 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2172 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2173 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2174 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2175 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2176 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2179 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2180 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2182 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2183 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2184 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2185 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2187 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2188 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2189 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2190 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2191 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2192 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2193 and are often not needed.
2195 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2196 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2197 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2198 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2199 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2200 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2201 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2202 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2203 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2206 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2207 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2208 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2209 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2213 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2214 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2215 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2216 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2217 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2218 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2219 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2220 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2221 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2222 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2223 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2224 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2225 containing the lines
2230 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2231 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2233 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2234 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2235 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2238 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2239 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2240 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2241 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2242 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2243 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2244 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2245 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2246 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2247 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2253 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2254 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2255 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2256 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2257 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2258 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2259 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2260 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2263 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2264 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2265 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2266 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2267 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2268 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2269 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2270 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2271 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2272 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2273 syntax. For instance:
2276 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2278 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2279 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2280 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2283 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2284 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2285 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2289 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2290 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2292 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2293 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2294 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2295 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2296 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2297 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2300 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2301 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2303 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2304 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2307 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2308 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2310 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2311 definition of all three of these variables into your
2312 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2315 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2316 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2317 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2318 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2320 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2321 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2322 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2323 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2324 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2327 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2328 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2329 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2330 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2331 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2334 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2336 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2337 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2338 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2339 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2340 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2341 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2345 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2346 .cindex "building Eximon"
2347 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2348 where the files that are involved are
2350 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2351 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2352 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2353 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2354 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2355 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2357 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2358 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2359 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2360 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2361 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2362 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2363 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2367 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2368 .cindex "installing Exim"
2369 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2370 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2371 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2372 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2373 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2374 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2375 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2376 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2377 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2378 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2379 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2380 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2382 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2383 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2384 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2385 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2386 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2387 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2388 alternative files, no default is installed.
2390 .cindex "system aliases file"
2391 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2392 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2393 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2394 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2395 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2396 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2397 and outputs a comment to the user.
2399 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2400 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2401 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2402 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2403 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2405 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2406 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2407 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2408 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2409 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2412 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2413 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2416 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2418 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2419 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2420 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2421 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2422 but this usage is deprecated.
2424 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2425 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2426 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2427 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2428 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2429 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2431 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2432 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2433 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2434 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2435 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2436 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2437 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2439 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2440 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2441 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2444 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2446 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2447 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2448 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2449 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2452 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2454 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2455 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2458 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2459 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2461 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2465 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2467 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2469 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2470 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2471 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2473 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2478 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2479 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2480 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2481 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2482 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2485 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2486 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2487 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2491 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2492 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2493 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2494 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2495 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2501 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2502 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2503 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2504 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2505 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2509 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2510 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2511 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2512 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2513 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2516 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2518 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2520 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2522 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2523 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2524 user agent. For example:
2526 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2527 From: user@your.domain.example
2528 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2529 Subject: Testing Exim
2531 This is a test message.
2534 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2535 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2536 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2538 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2539 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2540 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2541 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2542 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2543 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2545 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2547 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2548 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2549 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2550 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2551 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2553 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2554 .cindex "lock files"
2555 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2556 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2557 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2558 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2559 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2560 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2561 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2562 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2563 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2564 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2565 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2566 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2568 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2569 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2570 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2571 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2572 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2575 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2576 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2577 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2578 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2582 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2583 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2584 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2585 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2586 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2587 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2588 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2589 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2590 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2591 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2592 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2593 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2594 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2596 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2597 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2598 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2599 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2600 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2601 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2604 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2605 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2606 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2607 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2609 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2610 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2611 favourite user agent.
2613 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2614 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2615 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2616 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2617 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2618 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2622 .section "Running the daemon" SECTdaemonLaunch
2623 The most common command line for launching the Exim daemon looks like
2627 This starts a daemon which
2629 listens for incoming smtp connections, launching handler processes for
2632 starts a queue-runner process every five minutes, to inspect queued messages
2633 and run delivery attempts on any that have arrived at their retry time
2635 Should a queue run take longer than the time between queue-runner starts,
2636 they will run in parallel.
2637 Numbers of jobs of the various types are subject to policy controls
2638 defined in the configuration.
2641 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2642 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2643 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2644 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2645 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2646 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2647 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2648 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2649 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2650 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2656 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2657 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2658 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2660 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2662 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2663 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2664 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2665 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2666 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2668 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2670 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2672 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2673 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2674 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2682 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2683 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2684 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2685 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2686 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2687 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2688 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2689 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2690 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2693 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2695 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2696 were present before any other options.
2697 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2699 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2700 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2701 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2704 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2705 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2706 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2710 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2711 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2712 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2715 .cindex "queue runner"
2716 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2717 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2718 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2720 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2721 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2722 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2723 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2724 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2725 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2726 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2727 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2730 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2731 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2732 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2733 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2734 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2735 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2738 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2739 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2740 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2741 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2742 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2743 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2745 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2746 .cindex "envelope from"
2747 .cindex "envelope sender"
2748 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2749 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2750 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2751 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2752 users to set envelope senders.
2756 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2757 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2758 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2760 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2761 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2762 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2763 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2764 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2765 that are available to trusted users.
2767 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2768 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2769 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2770 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2771 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2773 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2774 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2775 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2776 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2778 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2779 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2780 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2781 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2783 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2784 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2789 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2790 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2791 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2797 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2798 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2799 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2800 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2801 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2802 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2803 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2804 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2806 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2807 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2808 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2809 . creates a man page for the options.
2810 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2813 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2819 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2820 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2821 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2822 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2825 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2826 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2830 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2837 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2840 .cmdopt -B <&'type'&>
2842 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2843 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2844 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2845 clean; it ignores this option.
2849 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2850 .cindex "queue runner"
2851 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2852 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2853 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2855 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2856 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2857 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2858 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2860 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2861 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2862 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2863 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2865 When a listening daemon
2866 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2867 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2868 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2869 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2870 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2871 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2874 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2875 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2876 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2880 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2881 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2882 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2883 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2884 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2885 .cindex reload configuration
2886 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2887 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2888 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2889 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2890 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2891 because these are reread each time they are used.
2893 Either a SIGTERM or a SIGINT signal should be used to cause the daemon
2894 to cleanly shut down.
2895 Subprocesses handling recceiving or delivering messages,
2896 or for scanning the queue,
2897 will not be affected by the termination of the daemon process.
2900 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2901 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2904 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2905 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2906 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2907 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2908 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2909 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2911 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2912 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2913 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2914 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2915 test data. A line history is supported.
2917 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2918 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2919 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2920 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2921 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2922 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2923 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2925 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2926 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2927 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2928 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2930 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2931 defined and macros will be expanded.
2932 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2933 available to admin users.
2935 The word &"set"& at the start of a line, followed by a single space,
2936 is recognised specially as defining a value for a variable.
2937 .cindex "tainted data" "expansion testing"
2938 If the sequence &",t"& is inserted before the space,
2939 the value is marked as tainted.
2940 The syntax is otherwise the same as the ACL modifier &"set ="&.
2942 .cmdopt -bem <&'filename'&>
2943 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2944 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2945 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2946 of a file. For example:
2948 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2950 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2951 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2952 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2953 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2954 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2955 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2956 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2959 .cmdopt -bF <&'filename'&>
2960 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2961 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2962 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2963 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2964 system filters are recognized.
2966 .cmdopt -bf <&'filename'&>
2967 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2968 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2969 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2970 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2971 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2972 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2973 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2974 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2977 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2978 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2979 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2981 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2983 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2984 variables that are used by the user filter.
2986 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2991 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2992 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2993 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2996 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2997 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2998 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2999 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
3001 When testing a filter file,
3002 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3003 .cindex "envelope from"
3004 .cindex "envelope sender"
3005 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
3006 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
3007 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
3008 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
3009 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
3012 .cmdopt -bfd <&'domain'&>
3013 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
3014 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
3015 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
3018 .cmdopt -bfl <&'local&~part'&>
3019 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
3020 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
3021 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
3022 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
3023 actually being delivered.
3025 .cmdopt -bfp <&'prefix'&>
3026 .cindex affix "filter testing"
3027 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
3028 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
3031 .cmdopt -bfs <&'suffix'&>
3032 .cindex affix "filter testing"
3033 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
3034 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
3037 .cmdopt -bh <&'IP&~address'&>
3038 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
3039 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
3040 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
3041 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
3042 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
3043 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
3044 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
3045 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
3046 after a full stop. For example:
3048 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
3049 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
3051 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
3052 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
3053 conversion to the canonical form is
3054 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
3056 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
3057 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
3058 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
3059 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
3060 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
3064 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident
3065 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2487,RFC 1413))
3066 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
3067 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
3070 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
3071 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
3072 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
3074 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
3075 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
3076 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
3077 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
3078 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
3079 session were authenticated.
3081 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
3082 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
3083 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
3085 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
3086 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
3087 specialized SMTP test program such as
3088 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks,swaks).
3090 .cmdopt -bhc <&'IP&~address'&>
3091 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
3092 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
3093 updating the callout cache database.
3096 .cindex "alias file" "building"
3097 .cindex "building alias file"
3098 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
3099 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
3100 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
3101 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
3102 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
3105 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
3106 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3107 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3108 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3109 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3110 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3113 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3115 .cindex "querying exim information"
3116 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3117 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3118 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3119 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3120 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3123 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3124 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3125 recognised DSCP names.
3128 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3129 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3130 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3131 useful for ManageSieve
3132 (&url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc5804.html,RFC 5804))
3133 implementations, in providing that protocol's
3134 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3135 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3136 way to guarantee a correct response.
3139 .cindex "local message reception"
3140 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3141 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3142 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3143 argument can be a comma-separated list of
3144 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822) addresses.
3146 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3147 if no other conflicting option is present.
3149 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3150 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3151 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3152 suppressing this for special cases.
3154 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3155 the non-SMTP ACL. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for details.
3157 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3158 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3159 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3162 .cindex "message" "format"
3163 .cindex "format" "message"
3164 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3165 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3166 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3167 of the message must be as defined in
3168 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822),
3170 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3172 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3173 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3175 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3176 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3177 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3178 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3179 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3181 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3182 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3183 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3184 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3185 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3187 .cmdopt -bmalware <&'filename'&>
3188 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3189 .cindex "malware scan test"
3190 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3191 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3192 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3193 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3194 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3195 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3196 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3198 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3199 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3200 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3201 This option requires admin privileges.
3203 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3204 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3205 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3208 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3209 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3210 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3211 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3212 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3213 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3214 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3216 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3217 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3218 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3219 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3220 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3222 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3223 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3224 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3225 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3229 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3230 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3231 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3232 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3233 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3234 arguments, for example:
3236 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3238 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3239 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3240 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3241 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3242 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3243 users, the output is as in this example:
3245 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3247 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3248 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3250 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3251 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3252 backward compatibility.)
3253 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3254 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3256 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3257 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3258 name will not be output.
3260 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3261 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3262 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3263 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3264 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3265 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3266 written directly into the spool directory.
3268 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3270 exim -bP +local_domains
3272 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3273 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3275 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3276 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3277 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3278 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3279 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3280 that driver are output. For example:
3282 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3284 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3285 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3286 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3287 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3288 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3291 .cindex "environment"
3292 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3293 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3296 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3297 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3298 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3299 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3300 The output format is one item per line.
3301 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3302 the exit status will be nonzero.
3305 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3306 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3307 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3308 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3309 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3310 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3311 to allow any user to see the queue.
3313 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3315 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3316 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3319 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3320 .cindex "size" "of message"
3321 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3322 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3323 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3324 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3325 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3326 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3327 before the sender address.
3329 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3330 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3331 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3333 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3334 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3335 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3336 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3337 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3342 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3343 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3344 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3349 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3350 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3351 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3352 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3356 .cindex queue "list of message IDs"
3357 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but only outputs message ids
3362 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3363 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3364 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3365 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3368 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3371 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpi%&.
3374 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3378 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3379 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3380 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3381 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3385 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3386 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3387 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3388 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3389 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3391 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3392 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3394 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3395 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3396 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3397 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3398 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3399 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3400 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3401 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3402 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3404 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3405 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3409 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3410 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3411 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3412 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3413 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3414 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3415 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3418 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3419 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3420 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3421 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3422 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3423 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3424 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3425 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3426 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3428 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3429 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3430 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3432 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3433 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see section &<<SECnonSMTP>>&).
3434 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3435 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3437 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3438 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3439 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3441 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3442 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3443 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3444 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3445 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3447 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3448 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3451 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3452 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3453 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3454 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3455 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3456 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3457 messages to the MTA.
3460 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3461 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3462 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3463 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3464 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3465 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3466 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3470 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3471 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3472 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3473 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3474 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3475 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3476 the listening daemon.
3479 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3480 .cindex "address" "testing"
3481 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3482 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3483 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3484 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3485 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3487 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3488 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3490 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3491 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3494 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3495 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3496 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3497 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3498 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3501 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3502 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3503 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3504 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3506 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3507 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3508 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3509 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3512 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3513 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3515 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3516 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3517 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3518 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3519 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3520 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3524 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3525 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3526 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3527 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3528 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3529 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3531 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3532 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3533 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3534 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3535 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3536 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3537 dynamic testing facilities.
3540 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3541 .cindex "address" "verification"
3542 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3543 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3544 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3545 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3546 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3547 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3549 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3550 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3551 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3553 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3554 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3556 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3557 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3560 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3561 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3562 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3563 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3564 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3566 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3567 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3568 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3569 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3570 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3571 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3574 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3575 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3576 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3579 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3580 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3581 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3582 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3584 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3585 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3586 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3587 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3590 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3591 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3597 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3598 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3599 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3600 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3602 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3603 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3604 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3605 each port only when the first connection is received.
3607 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3608 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3610 .cmdopt -C <&'filelist'&>
3611 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3612 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3613 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3614 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3615 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3616 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3617 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3618 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3619 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3621 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3622 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3623 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3624 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3625 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3626 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3627 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3628 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3629 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3631 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3632 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3633 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3634 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3635 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3636 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3637 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3639 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3640 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3641 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3642 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3643 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3644 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3645 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3647 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3648 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3649 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3652 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3653 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3654 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3655 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3656 specified by this option.
3659 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3661 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3662 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3663 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3664 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3665 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3666 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3668 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3669 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3670 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3671 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3672 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3673 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3674 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3676 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3677 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3678 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3684 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3685 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3688 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3690 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3691 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3694 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3696 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3697 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3698 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3699 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3700 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3701 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3702 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3705 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3706 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3707 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3708 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3709 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3710 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3711 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3713 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
3714 .irow acl "ACL interpretation"
3715 .irow auth "authenticators"
3716 .irow deliver "general delivery logic"
3717 .irow dns "DNS lookups (see also resolver)"
3718 .irow dnsbl "DNS black list (aka RBL) code"
3719 .irow exec "arguments for &[execv()]& calls"
3720 .irow expand "detailed debugging for string expansions"
3721 .irow filter "filter handling"
3722 .irow hints_lookup "hints data lookups"
3723 .irow host_lookup "all types of name-to-IP address handling"
3724 .irow ident "ident lookup"
3725 .irow interface "lists of local interfaces"
3726 .irow lists "matching things in lists"
3727 .irow load "system load checks"
3728 .irow local_scan "can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3729 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)"
3730 .irow lookup "general lookup code and all lookups"
3731 .irow memory "memory handling"
3732 .irow noutf8 "modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing"
3733 .irow pid "modifier: add pid to debug output lines"
3734 .irow process_info "setting info for the process log"
3735 .irow queue_run "queue runs"
3736 .irow receive "general message reception logic"
3737 .irow resolver "turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output"
3738 .irow retry "retry handling"
3739 .irow rewrite "address rewriting""
3740 .irow route "address routing"
3741 .irow timestamp "modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines"
3742 .irow tls "TLS logic"
3743 .irow transport "transports"
3744 .irow uid "changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid"
3745 .irow verify "address verification logic"
3746 .irow all "almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&"
3748 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3749 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3750 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3751 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3752 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3753 turn everything off.
3755 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3756 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3757 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3758 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3759 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3762 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3763 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3764 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3765 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3766 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3769 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3770 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3773 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3774 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3775 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3776 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3777 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3778 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3780 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3781 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3783 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3785 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3786 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3787 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3788 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3791 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3792 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3793 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3796 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3797 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3798 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3799 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3800 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3801 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3802 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3803 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3806 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3807 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3808 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3809 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3810 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3812 .cmdopt -F <&'string'&>
3813 .cindex "sender" "name"
3814 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3815 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3816 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3817 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3818 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3819 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3821 .cmdopt -f <&'address'&>
3822 .cindex "sender" "address"
3823 .cindex "address" "sender"
3824 .cindex "trusted users"
3825 .cindex "envelope from"
3826 .cindex "envelope sender"
3827 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3828 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3829 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3830 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3833 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3834 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3835 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3836 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3839 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3840 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3841 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3842 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3843 examples of shell commands:
3845 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3846 exim -f "" user@domain
3848 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3849 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3852 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3853 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3854 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3855 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3858 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3859 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3860 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3861 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3862 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3863 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3866 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3867 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3869 control = suppress_local_fixups
3871 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3872 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3875 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3878 .cmdopt -h <&'number'&>
3879 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3880 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3881 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3885 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3886 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3887 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3888 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message.
3889 Solaris 2.4 (SunOS 5.4) Sendmail has a similar &%-i%& processing option
3890 &url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf),
3891 p. 1M-529), and therefore a &%-oi%& command line option, which both are used
3892 by its &'mailx'& command.
3894 .cmdopt -L <&'tag'&>
3895 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3896 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3897 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3898 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3899 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3900 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3902 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3904 .cmdopt -M <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3905 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3906 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3907 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3908 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3909 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3910 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3911 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3914 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3915 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3916 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3917 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3918 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3919 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3921 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3922 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3923 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3924 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3926 .cmdopt -Mar <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3927 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3928 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3929 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3930 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3931 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3932 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3933 can be used only by an admin user.
3935 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&&&
3937 &~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3938 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3940 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3941 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3942 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3943 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3944 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3945 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3946 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3947 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3950 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3951 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3952 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3955 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3956 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3957 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3960 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3961 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-d%& option
3962 to pass on an information string on the purpose of the process.
3964 .cmdopt -MCG <&'queue&~name'&>
3965 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3966 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3967 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3970 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3971 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3972 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3975 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3976 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3977 which Exim is connected advertised limits on numbers of mails, recipients or
3979 The limits are given by the following three arguments.
3982 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3983 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3984 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3987 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3988 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the connection
3989 t a remote server is via a SOCKS proxy, using addresses and ports given by
3990 the following four arguments.
3992 .cmdopt -MCQ <&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3993 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3994 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3995 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3996 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3997 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3998 messages through the same SMTP connection.
4000 .cmdopt -MCq <&'recipient&~address'&>&~<&'size'&>
4001 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4002 by Exim to implement quota checking for local users.
4005 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4006 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
4007 ESMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
4011 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4012 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
4013 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
4015 .vitem &%-MCr%&&~<&'SNI'&> &&&
4019 These options are not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4020 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MCt%& option, and passes on the fact that
4021 a TLS Server Name Indication was sent as part of the channel establishment.
4022 The argument gives the SNI string.
4023 The "r" variant indicates a DANE-verified connection.
4025 .cmdopt -MCt <&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
4026 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4027 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
4028 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
4029 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
4031 .cmdopt -Mc <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4032 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
4033 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
4034 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
4035 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
4036 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
4037 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
4038 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
4039 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
4040 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
4041 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
4042 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
4043 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
4044 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
4046 .cmdopt -Mes <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
4047 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
4048 .cindex "sender" "changing"
4049 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
4050 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
4051 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
4052 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
4053 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
4054 This option can be used only by an admin user.
4056 .cmdopt -Mf <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4057 .cindex "freezing messages"
4058 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
4059 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
4060 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
4061 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
4062 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
4063 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
4066 .cmdopt -Mg <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4067 .cindex "giving up on messages"
4068 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
4069 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
4070 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
4071 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
4072 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
4073 is sent to the sender.
4074 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
4077 .cmdopt -MG <&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4079 .cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
4080 .cindex "queue" "moving messages"
4081 This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
4082 queue to the given named queue.
4083 The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
4084 string to define the default queue.
4085 If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
4086 a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
4088 .cmdopt -Mmad <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4089 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
4090 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
4091 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
4092 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
4093 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4095 .cmdopt -Mmd <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
4096 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
4097 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
4098 .cindex "removing recipients"
4099 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
4100 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
4101 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
4102 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
4103 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
4104 can be used only by an admin user.
4106 .cmdopt -Mrm <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4107 .cindex "removing messages"
4108 .cindex "abandoning mail"
4109 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4110 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4111 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4112 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4113 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4114 placed in the queue.
4119 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
4120 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4121 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4125 .cmdopt -Mset <&'message&~id'&>
4126 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4127 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4128 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4129 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4130 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4131 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4132 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4133 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4134 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4136 .cmdopt -Mt <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4137 .cindex "thawing messages"
4138 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4139 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4140 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4141 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4142 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4143 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4146 .cmdopt -Mvb <&'message&~id'&>
4147 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4148 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4149 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4150 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4152 .cmdopt -Mvc <&'message&~id'&>
4153 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4154 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4155 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4156 be written to the standard output in
4157 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
4158 format. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4160 .cmdopt -Mvh <&'message&~id'&>
4161 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4162 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4163 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4164 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4165 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4167 .cmdopt -Mvl <&'message&~id'&>
4168 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4169 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4170 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4171 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4174 This is a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail
4175 (&url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf)
4176 p. 1M-258), so Exim treats it that way too.
4179 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4180 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4181 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4182 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4183 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4184 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4185 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4188 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4189 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4190 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4191 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4192 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4193 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4194 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4198 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4199 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4200 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4201 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4203 .cmdopt -O <&'data'&>
4204 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4207 .cmdopt -oA <&'file&~name'&>
4208 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4209 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4210 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4214 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4215 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4216 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4217 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4218 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4219 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4222 .cindex "background delivery"
4223 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4224 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4225 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4226 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4227 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4228 processes to finish.
4230 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4231 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4232 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4233 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4235 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4236 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4237 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4238 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4241 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4242 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4243 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4244 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4245 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4246 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4248 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4249 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4252 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4253 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4255 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4256 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4257 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4258 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4262 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4266 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4267 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4268 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4269 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4270 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4271 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4272 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4273 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4274 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4275 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4279 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4280 .cindex "first pass routing"
4281 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4282 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4283 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4284 configuration file is in effect.
4286 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4287 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4288 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4289 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4290 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4291 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4292 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4293 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4294 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4298 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4299 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4300 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4303 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4305 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4306 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4307 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4308 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4311 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4312 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4313 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4314 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4315 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4318 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4319 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4320 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4321 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4322 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4325 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4326 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4330 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4331 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4335 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4336 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4337 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4338 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4339 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4340 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4343 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4345 .cmdopt -oMa <&'host&~address'&>
4346 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4347 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4348 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4349 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4350 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4351 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4353 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4354 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4356 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4358 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4359 followed by a colon and the port number:
4361 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4363 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4364 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4365 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4366 whichever one is last.
4368 .cmdopt -oMaa <&'name'&>
4369 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4370 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4371 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4372 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4373 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4374 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4376 .cmdopt -oMai <&'string'&>
4377 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4378 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4379 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4380 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4381 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4382 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4384 .cmdopt -oMas <&'address'&>
4385 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4386 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4387 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4388 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4389 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4390 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4391 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4392 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4394 .cmdopt -oMi <&'interface&~address'&>
4395 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4396 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4397 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4398 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4399 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4401 .cmdopt -oMm <&'message&~reference'&>
4402 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4403 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4404 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4405 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4406 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4407 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4408 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4410 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4411 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4412 is sending the bounce.
4414 .cmdopt -oMr <&'protocol&~name'&>
4415 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4416 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4417 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4418 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4419 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4420 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4421 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4422 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4423 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4424 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4426 .cmdopt -oMs <&'host&~name'&>
4427 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4428 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4429 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4430 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4431 uses the name it is given.
4433 .cmdopt -oMt <&'ident&~string'&>
4434 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4435 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4436 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4437 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4438 used, when there is no default.
4441 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4442 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4443 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4444 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4447 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4448 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4449 whatever that means.
4451 .cmdopt -oP <&'path'&>
4452 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4453 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4454 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4455 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4456 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4457 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4458 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4461 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4462 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4463 This option is not intended for general use.
4464 The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4465 combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4466 It causes the pid file to be removed.
4468 .cmdopt -or <&'time'&>
4469 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4470 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4471 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4472 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4473 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4475 .cmdopt -os <&'time'&>
4476 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4477 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4478 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4479 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4480 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4481 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4484 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4486 .cmdopt -oX <&'number&~or&~string'&>
4487 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4488 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4489 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4490 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4491 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4492 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4493 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4494 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4497 .cindex "daemon notifier socket"
4498 This option controls the creation of an inter-process communications endpoint
4500 It is only relevant when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option is also
4502 Normally the daemon creates this socket, unless a &%-oX%& and &*no*& &%-oP%&
4503 option is also present.
4504 If this option is given then the socket will not be created. This is required
4505 if the system is running multiple daemons, in which case it should
4507 The features supported by the socket will not be available in such cases.
4509 The socket is currently used for
4511 fast ramp-up of queue runner processes
4513 caching compiled regexes
4515 obtaining a current queue size
4519 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4520 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4521 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4522 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4526 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4527 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4528 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4529 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4532 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4534 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4536 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4538 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4539 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4540 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4541 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4542 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4543 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4546 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4547 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4548 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4549 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4550 and &%-S%& options).
4552 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4553 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4554 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4555 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4556 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4557 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4558 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4561 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4562 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4563 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4564 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4565 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4568 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4569 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4570 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4571 this to be repeated periodically.
4573 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4574 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4575 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4576 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4578 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4579 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4580 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4582 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4583 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4584 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4585 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4589 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4590 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4591 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4592 .cindex "first pass routing"
4593 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
4594 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4595 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4596 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4599 Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4601 the &%queue_fast_ramp%& option is true
4602 and a daemon-notifier socket is available
4603 then in the first phase of the run,
4604 once a threshold number of messages are routed for a given host,
4605 a delivery process is forked in parallel with the rest of the scan.
4607 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4608 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4609 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred.
4611 After the first queue scan complete,
4612 a second, normal queue scan is done, with routing and delivery taking
4614 Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4615 delivered down a single SMTP
4616 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4617 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4618 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4619 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4621 Two-phase queue runs should be used on systems which, even intermittently,
4622 have a large queue (such as mailing-list operators).
4623 They may also be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4626 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4628 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4629 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4630 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4631 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4632 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4634 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4636 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4637 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4638 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4639 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4640 their retry times are tried.
4642 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4644 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4645 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4648 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4650 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4651 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4652 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4655 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4658 .cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4659 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4660 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4661 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4662 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4663 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4664 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4666 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4667 will specify a queue to operate on.
4670 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4672 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4675 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4676 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4677 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4678 starting message id. For example:
4680 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4682 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4683 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4684 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4686 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4688 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4689 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4690 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4691 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4692 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4693 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4695 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4696 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4697 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4698 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4699 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4700 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4701 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4702 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4703 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4705 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4707 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4708 process every 30 minutes.
4710 .cindex "named queues" "queue runners"
4711 It is possible to set up runners for multiple named queues within one daemon,
4714 exim -qGhipri/2m -q10m -qqGmailinglist/1h
4717 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4718 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4720 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4722 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4725 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4727 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4729 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4731 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4732 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4733 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4734 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4735 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4736 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4737 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4739 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4740 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4741 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4742 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4743 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4744 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4746 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4747 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4749 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4751 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4752 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4753 applied to each queue run.
4755 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4756 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4757 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4758 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4759 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4760 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4761 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4762 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4763 address will be skipped.
4765 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4766 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4767 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4770 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4771 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4772 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&), its default
4773 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4774 an arbitrary command instead.
4777 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4779 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4781 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4782 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4783 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4784 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4785 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4786 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4788 .cmdopt -Tqt <&'times'&>
4789 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4790 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4791 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4794 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4798 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4799 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4800 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4801 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4802 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4804 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4805 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4806 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4807 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4808 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4809 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4810 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4811 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4812 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4813 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4814 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4816 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4817 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4818 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4819 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4820 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4821 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4823 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
4824 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4825 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4826 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4827 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4828 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4829 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4830 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4831 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4832 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4835 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4836 compatibility with Sendmail.
4838 .cmdopt -tls-on-connect
4839 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4840 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4841 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4842 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4843 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4844 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4848 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4849 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4850 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4851 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4852 set. Exim ignores this option.
4855 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4856 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4857 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4858 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4859 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4860 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4864 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4865 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4866 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4869 .cmdopt -X <&'logfile'&>
4870 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4871 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4873 .cmdopt -z <&'log-line'&>
4874 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4875 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4876 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4884 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4885 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4886 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4887 . creates a man page for the options.
4888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4891 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4898 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4899 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4902 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4903 "The runtime configuration file"
4905 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4906 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4907 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4908 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4909 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4910 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4911 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4912 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4913 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4916 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4917 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4918 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4919 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4920 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4921 actually alter the string.
4923 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4924 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4925 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4926 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4927 existing file in the list.
4930 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4931 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4932 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4933 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4934 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4935 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4936 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4937 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4938 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4939 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4941 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4942 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4943 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4944 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4945 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4947 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4948 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4949 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4950 compromise the Exim user account.
4952 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4953 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4954 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4955 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4956 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4957 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4962 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4963 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4964 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4965 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4966 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4967 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4968 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4969 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4970 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4971 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4972 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4974 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4975 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4976 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4977 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4978 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4979 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4980 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4981 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4982 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4985 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4986 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4987 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4988 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4989 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4991 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4992 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4993 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4994 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4995 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4996 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4998 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4999 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
5000 necessarily be discarded.
5001 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
5002 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
5003 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
5004 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
5005 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
5006 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
5008 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
5009 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
5010 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
5011 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
5012 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
5013 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
5014 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
5016 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
5017 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
5018 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
5022 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
5023 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
5024 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
5025 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
5026 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
5027 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
5028 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
5029 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
5032 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
5035 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5036 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
5037 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
5039 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
5040 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
5041 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
5043 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
5044 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
5045 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
5047 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
5048 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
5049 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
5050 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
5053 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
5054 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
5055 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
5057 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
5058 want to use this feature, you must set
5060 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
5062 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
5063 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
5066 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
5067 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
5068 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
5069 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
5071 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
5072 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
5073 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
5074 and does not introduce a comment.
5076 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
5077 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
5078 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
5079 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
5080 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
5082 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
5083 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
5084 change settings as required.
5086 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
5087 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
5088 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
5089 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
5090 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
5095 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
5096 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
5097 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
5098 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
5099 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5100 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5103 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5104 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5106 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5107 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5108 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5109 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5110 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5113 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5114 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5115 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5116 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5118 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5119 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5122 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5125 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5126 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5131 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5132 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5133 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5134 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5135 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5136 definition, and must be of the form
5138 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5140 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5141 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5142 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5143 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5144 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5146 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5147 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5148 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5150 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5151 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5152 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5153 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5154 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5155 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5156 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5159 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5160 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5162 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5163 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5164 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5165 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5166 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5167 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5170 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5171 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5172 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5177 MAC == updated value
5179 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5180 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5181 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5182 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5186 MAC == MAC and something added
5188 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5189 from a number of other files.
5191 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5192 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5193 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5194 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5195 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5200 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5201 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5202 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5203 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5205 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5206 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5208 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5210 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5212 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5213 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5214 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5217 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5218 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5219 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5220 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5221 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5224 The following classes of macros are defined:
5226 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5227 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5228 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5229 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5230 &` _EXP_COND_* `& expansion conditions
5231 &` _EXP_ITEM_* `& expansion items
5232 &` _EXP_OP_* `& expansion operators
5233 &` _EXP_VAR_* `& expansion variables
5234 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5235 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5236 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5237 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5238 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5239 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5240 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5241 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5244 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5247 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5248 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5249 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5250 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5251 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5252 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5253 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5255 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5256 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5257 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5261 message_size_limit = 50M
5263 message_size_limit = 100M
5266 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5267 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5268 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5269 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5270 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5272 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5273 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5274 in this line"& will always be true.
5276 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5277 to clarify complicated nestings.
5281 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5282 .cindex "common option syntax"
5283 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5284 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5285 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5286 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5287 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5288 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5289 space) and then the value. For example:
5291 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5293 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5294 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5295 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5296 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5297 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5298 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5299 word &"hide"&. For example:
5301 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5303 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5305 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5307 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5308 all instances of the same driver.
5310 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5311 that are found in option settings.
5314 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5315 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5316 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5317 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5318 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5319 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5320 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5321 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5322 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5323 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5324 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5325 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5330 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5335 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5340 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5341 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5342 .cindex "format" "integer"
5343 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5344 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5345 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5346 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5349 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5350 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5351 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5353 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5354 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5355 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5359 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5360 .cindex "integer format"
5361 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5362 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5363 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5364 Such options are always output in octal.
5367 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5368 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5369 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5370 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5371 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5375 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5376 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5377 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5378 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5379 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5389 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5390 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5391 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5395 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5396 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5397 .cindex "format" "string"
5398 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5399 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5400 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5401 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5402 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5403 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5404 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5405 therefore equivalent:
5407 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5408 trusted_users = uucp:\
5409 # This comment line is ignored
5412 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5413 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5414 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5415 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5416 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5419 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5420 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5421 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5423 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5424 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5428 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5429 character, that character replaces the pair.
5431 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5432 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5433 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5434 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5435 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5436 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5439 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5440 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5441 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5442 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5443 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5444 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5445 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5446 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5447 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5448 within a quoted configuration string.
5451 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5452 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5453 .cindex "format" "user name"
5454 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5455 .cindex "format" "group name"
5456 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5457 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5458 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5459 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5462 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5463 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5464 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5465 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5466 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5467 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5468 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5469 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5470 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5471 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5472 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5474 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5475 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5476 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5477 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5478 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5479 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5482 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5484 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5486 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5487 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The spaces around the first
5488 colon in the example above are necessary. If they were not there, the list would
5489 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5491 .subsection "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5492 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5493 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5494 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5495 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5496 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5497 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5498 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5500 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5502 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5503 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5504 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5506 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5507 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5508 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5509 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5510 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5511 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5512 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5513 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5514 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5516 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5518 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5519 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5520 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5521 the value in quotes. For example:
5523 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5525 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5526 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5527 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5528 enclosing an empty list item.
5532 .subsection "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5533 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5534 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5535 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5537 senders = user@domain :
5539 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5540 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5541 items, the second of which is empty:
5543 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5545 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5546 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5547 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5548 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5552 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5553 is at the end of the list.
5558 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5559 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5560 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5561 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5562 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5563 a sequence of lines like this:
5565 <&'instance name'&>:
5570 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5571 followed by three options settings:
5576 transport = local_delivery
5578 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5579 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5580 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5581 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5582 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5583 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5585 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5586 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5588 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5589 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5590 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5591 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5592 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5595 .cindex "generic options"
5596 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5597 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5598 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5599 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5600 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5601 .cindex "private options"
5602 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5603 they all have default values.
5605 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5606 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5607 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5609 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5610 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5611 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5612 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5613 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5614 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5615 configuration lines:
5620 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5621 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5622 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5623 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5629 command_timeout = 10s
5631 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5632 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5635 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5636 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5637 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5645 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5646 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5648 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5649 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5650 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5651 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5652 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5653 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5654 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5655 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5656 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5657 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5658 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5662 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5663 All macros should be defined before any options.
5665 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5667 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5669 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5670 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5671 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5672 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5674 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5675 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5676 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5679 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5680 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5681 in the file, after the macros.
5682 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5684 # primary_hostname =
5686 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5687 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5688 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5689 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5691 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5693 domainlist local_domains = @
5694 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5695 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5697 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5698 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5699 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5700 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5702 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5703 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5706 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5707 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5708 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5709 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5710 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5711 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5713 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5714 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5715 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5716 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5717 domain is permitted.
5719 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5720 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5721 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5722 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5723 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5724 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5726 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5727 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5728 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5730 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5732 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5733 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5735 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5736 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5737 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5738 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5739 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5740 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5741 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5742 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5743 contents of a message to be checked.
5745 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5747 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5748 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5750 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5751 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5752 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5753 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5755 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5757 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5758 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5759 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5761 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5762 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5763 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5764 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5765 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5766 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5767 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5769 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5771 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5772 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5774 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5775 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5776 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5777 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5778 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5779 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5780 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5781 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5782 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5783 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5784 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5785 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5786 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5787 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5788 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5789 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5791 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6409,RFC 6409) (previously 4409)
5792 specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5793 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5794 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314)
5795 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5796 which should be used in preference to 587.
5797 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5799 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5801 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5804 # qualify_recipient =
5806 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5807 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5808 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5809 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5810 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5811 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5813 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5814 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5815 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5816 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5818 # allow_domain_literals
5820 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5821 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5822 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5823 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5824 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5825 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5827 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5831 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5832 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5833 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5834 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5835 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5836 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5837 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5838 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5840 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5841 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5846 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5847 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5848 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5849 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5850 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5851 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5854 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by
5855 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1413,RFC 1413)
5856 (hence their names):
5859 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5861 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5862 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5863 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5864 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5865 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5866 information, you can change this.
5868 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5869 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5874 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5875 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5876 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5877 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5879 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5880 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5882 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5883 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5885 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5888 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5889 +tls_certificate_verified
5892 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5894 # percent_hack_domains =
5896 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5897 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5898 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5900 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5901 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5902 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5903 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5904 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5905 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5906 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5907 always bounce messages.
5909 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5910 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5912 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5913 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5914 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5915 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5916 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5918 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5919 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5920 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5921 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5922 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5925 # split_spool_directory = true
5928 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5929 messages &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2048,RFC 2047)
5930 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5931 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5932 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5933 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5934 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5935 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5937 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5940 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5941 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5942 that are not 8-bit clean.
5944 # accept_8bitmime = false
5947 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5948 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5949 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5950 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5951 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the &%timezone%& runtime
5952 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5954 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5955 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5959 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5960 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5961 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5962 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5963 It starts with the line
5967 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5968 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5969 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5971 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5972 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5973 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5974 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5975 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5976 result of the ACL processing.
5980 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5985 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5986 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5987 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5988 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5989 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5990 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5992 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5993 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5994 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5997 deny domains = +local_domains
5998 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5999 message = Restricted characters in address
6001 deny domains = !+local_domains
6002 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
6003 message = Restricted characters in address
6005 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
6006 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
6007 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
6008 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
6009 in Internet mail addresses.
6011 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
6012 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
6013 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
6014 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
6015 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
6016 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
6017 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
6018 policy of being as safe as possible.
6020 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
6021 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
6022 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
6023 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
6024 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
6025 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
6027 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
6028 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
6029 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
6030 have to modify this rule.
6032 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in
6033 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822),
6035 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
6036 common convention of local parts constructed as
6037 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
6038 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
6039 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
6040 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
6041 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
6042 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
6044 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
6045 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
6046 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
6047 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
6048 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
6049 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
6050 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
6052 accept local_parts = postmaster
6053 domains = +local_domains
6055 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
6056 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
6057 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
6058 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
6059 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
6061 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
6062 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
6063 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
6065 require verify = sender
6067 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
6068 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
6069 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
6070 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
6071 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
6072 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
6073 discusses the details of address verification.
6075 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
6076 control = submission
6078 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
6079 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
6080 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
6081 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
6082 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
6083 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
6084 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
6085 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
6086 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
6088 accept authenticated = *
6089 control = submission
6091 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
6092 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
6093 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
6094 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
6095 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
6096 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
6098 require message = relay not permitted
6099 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
6101 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
6102 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
6104 require verify = recipient
6106 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
6107 fails, the address is rejected.
6109 # deny dnslists = black.list.example
6110 # message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6111 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6114 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
6115 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6116 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
6117 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6119 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6120 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6121 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6124 # require verify = csa
6126 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6127 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6132 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6133 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6137 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6138 of this ACL are commented out:
6141 # message = This message contains a virus \
6144 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6145 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6146 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6147 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6149 # warn spam = nobody
6150 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6151 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6152 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6153 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6155 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6156 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6157 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6158 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6159 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6160 whatever the spam score.
6164 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6167 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6168 .cindex "default" "routers"
6169 .cindex "routers" "default"
6170 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6175 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6176 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6177 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6178 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6179 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6182 # driver = ipliteral
6183 # domains = !+local_domains
6184 # transport = remote_smtp
6186 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6187 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6188 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6189 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6190 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6192 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6193 macro has been defined, per
6195 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6204 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6205 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6206 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6207 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6211 driver = manualroute
6212 domains = ! +local_domains
6213 transport = smarthost_smtp
6214 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6215 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6218 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6219 specified by the line
6221 domains = ! +local_domains
6223 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6224 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6225 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6226 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6227 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6228 passed on to the following routers.
6230 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6231 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6232 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6233 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6235 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6236 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6237 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6238 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6239 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6240 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6241 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6246 domains = ! +local_domains
6247 transport = remote_smtp
6248 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6251 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6253 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6254 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6255 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6256 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6257 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6259 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6260 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6261 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6262 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6263 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6264 the address fails and is bounced.
6266 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6267 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6268 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6269 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6270 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6271 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6272 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6279 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6281 file_transport = address_file
6282 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6284 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6285 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6286 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6287 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6288 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6291 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6292 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6293 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6294 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6299 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6300 # local_part_suffix_optional
6301 file = $home/.forward
6306 file_transport = address_file
6307 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6308 reply_transport = address_reply
6310 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6311 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6312 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6313 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6314 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6317 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6318 # local_part_suffix_optional
6320 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6321 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6322 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6323 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6324 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6325 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6326 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6328 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6329 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6330 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6331 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6333 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6334 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6335 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6336 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6337 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6338 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6339 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6341 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6342 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6343 There are two reasons for doing this:
6346 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6347 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6350 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6351 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6352 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6353 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6357 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6358 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6359 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6360 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6362 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6363 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6364 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6366 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6368 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6374 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6375 # local_part_suffix_optional
6376 transport = local_delivery
6378 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6379 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6380 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6381 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6382 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6385 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6386 .cindex "default" "transports"
6387 .cindex "transports" "default"
6388 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6389 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6390 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6394 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6398 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6403 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6404 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6405 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6406 with over-long lines.
6408 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6409 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6410 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6411 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6413 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6414 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6415 usual federated system.
6420 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6424 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6425 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6426 hosts_require_tls = *
6427 tls_verify_hosts = *
6428 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this this will have no effect,
6429 # but if you have to comment it out then this will at least log whether
6430 # you succeed or not:
6431 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6433 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6434 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6435 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6436 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6437 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6438 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6440 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6441 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6444 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6451 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6452 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6453 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6454 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6455 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6456 then no other options are defined.
6457 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6458 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6459 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6460 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6461 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6462 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6463 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6464 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6465 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6466 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6467 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6469 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6471 All other options are defaulted.
6475 file = /var/mail/$local_part_data
6482 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6483 traditional BSD mailbox format.
6485 We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6486 as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6487 Instead we use &$local_part_data$&,
6488 the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6489 (done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6491 By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6492 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6493 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6494 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6495 show how this can be done.
6497 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6498 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6499 similarly-named options above.
6505 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6506 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6507 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6508 be returned to the sender.
6516 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6517 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6518 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6523 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6528 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6529 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6530 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6531 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6532 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6533 introduced by the line
6537 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6540 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6542 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6543 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6544 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6545 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6546 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6548 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6549 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6550 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6553 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6554 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6558 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6559 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6563 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6564 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6565 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6567 begin authenticators
6569 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6570 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6571 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6572 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6573 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6574 to support most MUA software.
6576 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6579 # driver = plaintext
6580 # server_set_id = $auth2
6581 # server_prompts = :
6582 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6583 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6585 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6588 # driver = plaintext
6589 # server_set_id = $auth1
6590 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6591 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6592 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6595 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6596 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6597 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6598 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6599 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6600 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6601 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6602 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6604 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6605 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6606 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6607 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6609 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6610 usercode and password are in different positions.
6611 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6613 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6617 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6620 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6622 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6624 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6625 uses the PCRE2 regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6626 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6627 regular expressions is discussed in
6628 online Perl manpages, in
6629 many Perl reference books, and also in
6630 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6631 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6632 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6633 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6634 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6636 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6637 are supported by PCRE2 is included in the PCRE2 distribution, and no further
6638 description is included here. The PCRE2 functions are called from Exim using
6639 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE2 options set), except that
6640 the PCRE2_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6643 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6644 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6645 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6646 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6648 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6650 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6651 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6652 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6653 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6654 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6655 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6658 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6659 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6660 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6661 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6662 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6663 match anywhere in the subject string.
6665 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6666 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6668 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6670 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6673 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6675 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6676 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6681 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6683 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6684 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6685 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6686 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6687 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6688 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6691 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6692 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6693 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6694 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6695 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6696 The key for the lookup is &*specified*& as part of the string to be expanded.
6698 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6699 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6700 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6701 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6702 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6703 Depending on the lookup type (see below)
6704 the key for the lookup may need to be &*specified*& as above
6705 or may be &*implicit*&,
6706 given by the context in which the list is being checked.
6709 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6710 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6711 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6712 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6713 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6714 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6716 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6717 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6718 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6719 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6720 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6722 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6723 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6726 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6727 The key for an expansion-style lookup must be given explicitly.
6728 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6729 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6730 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6731 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6733 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6734 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6736 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6737 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6738 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6739 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a lookup expansion"
6740 The result of the expansion is not tainted.
6743 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6744 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6746 The file could contains lines like this:
6751 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6752 matches the list item.
6754 The key for a list-style lookup is implicit, from the lookup context, if
6755 the lookup is a single-key type (see below).
6756 For query-style lookup types the query must be given explicitly.
6759 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6760 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6762 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6764 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6765 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6766 causes a second lookup to occur.
6768 The lookup type may optionally be followed by a comma
6769 and a comma-separated list of options.
6770 Each option is a &"name=value"& pair.
6771 Whether an option is meaningful depends on the lookup type.
6773 All lookups support the option &"cache=no_rd"&.
6774 If this is given then the cache that Exim manages for lookup results
6775 is not checked before doing the lookup.
6776 The result of the lookup is still written to the cache.
6778 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6779 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6780 lookup is permitted.
6783 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6784 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6785 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6786 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6789 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6790 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6791 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6792 .cindex "tainted data" "single-key lookups"
6793 The file string may not be tainted.
6795 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6796 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a single-key lookup"
6797 All single-key lookups support the option &"ret=key"&.
6798 If this is given and the lookup
6799 (either underlying implementation or cached value)
6800 returns data, the result is replaced with a non-tainted
6801 version of the lookup key.
6804 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6805 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6806 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6807 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6809 For the string-expansion kind of lookups, the query is given in the first
6810 bracketed argument of the &${lookup ...}$& expansion.
6811 For the list-argument kind of lookup the query is given by the remainder of the
6812 list item after the first semicolon.
6814 .cindex "tainted data" "quoting for lookups"
6815 If tainted data is used in the query then it should be quoted by
6816 using the &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& expansion operator
6817 appropriate for the lookup.
6820 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6821 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6822 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6827 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6828 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6829 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6834 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6835 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6836 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6837 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6840 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6841 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6842 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6843 The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6844 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6845 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6846 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6847 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6848 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6850 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6851 &url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6852 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6853 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6855 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6856 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6857 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6858 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6861 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6862 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6863 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6864 Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6865 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6866 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6867 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6869 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6870 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6871 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6872 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6873 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6874 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6875 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6878 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6879 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6881 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6882 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6883 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6884 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6885 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6886 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6887 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6890 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6891 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6892 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6894 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6895 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6896 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6897 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6898 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6899 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6900 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6901 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6902 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6903 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6906 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6907 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6908 The given file must be an absolute directory path; this is searched for an entry
6909 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function.
6910 Unless the options (below) permit a path,
6911 the key may not contain any forward slash characters.
6912 If &[lstat()]& succeeds then so does the lookup.
6913 .cindex "tainted data" "dsearch result"
6914 The result is regarded as untainted.
6916 Options for the lookup can be given by appending them after the word "dsearch",
6917 separated by a comma. Options, if present, are a comma-separated list having
6918 each element starting with a tag name and an equals.
6920 Three options are supported, for the return value and for filtering match
6922 The "ret" option requests an alternate result value of
6923 the entire path for the entry. Example:
6925 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,ret=full {/etc}}
6927 The default result is just the requested entry.
6929 The "filter" option requests that only directory entries of a given type
6930 are matched. The match value is one of "file", "dir" or "subdir" (the latter
6931 not matching "." or ".."). Example:
6933 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,filter=file {/etc}}
6935 The default matching is for any entry type, including directories
6938 The "key" option relaxes the restriction that only a simple path component can
6939 be searched for, to permit a sequence of path components. Example:
6941 ${lookup {foo/bar} dsearch,key=path {/etc}}
6943 If this option is used, a ".." component in the key is specifically disallowed.
6944 The default operation is that the key may only be a single path component.
6946 An example of how this
6947 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6948 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6950 .subsection iplsearch
6951 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6952 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6953 The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6954 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6955 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6956 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6957 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6959 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6960 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6961 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6962 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6964 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6965 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6966 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6967 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6968 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6970 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6971 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6972 lookup types support only literal keys.
6974 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6975 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name
6976 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6978 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6979 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6980 notation before executing the lookup.)
6982 One option is supported, "ret=full", to request the return of the entire line
6983 rather than omitting the key portion.
6984 Note however that the key portion will have been de-quoted.
6988 .cindex json "lookup type"
6989 .cindex JSON expansions
6990 The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6991 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6992 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6993 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6994 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6995 of the JSON structure.
6996 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6997 nunbered array element is selected.
6998 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6999 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
7000 or array; for the latter two a string-representation of the JSON
7002 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
7008 .cindex database lmdb
7009 The given file is an LMDB database.
7010 LMDB is a memory-mapped key-value store,
7011 with API modeled loosely on that of BerkeleyDB.
7012 See &url(https://symas.com/products/lightning-memory-mapped-database/,LMDB)
7013 for the feature set and operation modes.
7015 Exim provides read-only access via the LMDB C library.
7016 The library can be obtained from &url(https://github.com/LMDB/lmdb)
7017 or your operating system package repository.
7018 To enable LMDB support in Exim set LOOKUP_LMDB=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
7020 You will need to separately create the LMDB database file,
7021 possibly using the &"mdb_load"& utility.
7025 .cindex "linear search"
7026 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
7027 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
7028 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
7029 The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
7030 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
7031 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
7032 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
7033 in the file is used.
7035 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
7036 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
7037 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
7038 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
7039 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
7044 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
7045 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
7046 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
7047 wildcarding of any kind.
7049 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
7050 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
7051 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
7052 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
7053 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
7054 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
7055 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
7056 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
7057 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
7060 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
7061 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
7062 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
7063 The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
7064 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
7065 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
7066 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
7067 aliases; the full map names must be used.
7069 .subsection (n)wildlsearch
7070 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
7071 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
7072 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
7073 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
7074 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
7075 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
7076 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
7077 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
7078 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
7080 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
7081 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
7082 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
7083 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
7086 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
7088 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
7089 *fish data for anythingfish
7092 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
7093 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
7095 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
7097 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
7098 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
7099 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
7101 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7103 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
7104 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
7105 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
7107 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7110 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
7111 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
7112 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
7113 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
7114 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
7116 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
7117 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
7118 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
7119 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
7120 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
7123 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
7124 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
7125 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
7128 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
7130 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
7133 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
7134 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
7135 be followed by optional colons.
7137 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
7138 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
7139 lookup types support only literal keys.
7142 .cindex "spf lookup type"
7143 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
7144 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
7145 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method).
7146 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
7149 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
7150 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
7151 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
7152 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
7153 many of them are given in later sections.
7156 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7157 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
7158 This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
7159 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
7160 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
7163 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7164 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7165 This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
7168 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
7169 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7170 This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
7171 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
7172 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
7173 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
7174 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
7177 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7178 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7179 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7180 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7183 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7184 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7185 This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
7186 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
7189 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7190 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7191 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
7192 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7195 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
7196 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
7197 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
7198 This is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
7199 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
7200 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
7201 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
7202 password value. For example:
7204 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
7208 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7209 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7210 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7211 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7214 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7215 .cindex lookup Redis
7216 The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7217 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7220 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7221 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7222 The format of the query is
7223 an SQL statement that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7226 This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7227 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7230 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
7231 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7232 &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7233 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7234 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7235 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7236 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7237 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7238 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7240 require condition = \
7241 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7243 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7244 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7245 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7246 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7250 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7251 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7252 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7253 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7254 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7255 options such as a list of local domains.
7257 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7258 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7259 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7260 or may give up altogether.
7264 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7265 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7266 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7267 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7268 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7269 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7270 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7271 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7273 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7274 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7275 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7277 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7278 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7279 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7281 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7282 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7283 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7284 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7285 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7286 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7287 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7288 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7289 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7290 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7292 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7294 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7295 looks up these keys, in this order:
7301 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7302 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7303 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7304 Exim move on to try the next key.
7308 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7309 .cindex "partial matching"
7310 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7311 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7312 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7313 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7314 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7315 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7316 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7317 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7318 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7319 a key in a DBM file is
7321 *.dates.fict.example
7323 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7324 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7325 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7328 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7329 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7330 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7332 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7333 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7334 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7335 partial matching keys
7336 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7337 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7338 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7340 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7341 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7342 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7343 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7344 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7345 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7348 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7349 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7350 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7351 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7352 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7353 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7355 2250.dates.fict.example
7356 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7357 *.dates.fict.example
7360 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7363 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7364 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7365 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7366 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7367 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7368 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7370 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7372 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7373 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7374 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7375 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7377 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7379 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7380 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7382 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7383 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7384 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7387 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7389 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7390 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7392 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7393 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7394 for &"*"& on its own.
7396 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7400 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7401 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7402 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7403 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7404 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7405 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7406 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7408 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7409 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7410 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7411 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7412 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7414 When the lookup is done from a string-expansion,
7415 the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild and non-wild parts of the key
7416 during the expansion of the replacement text.
7417 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
7422 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7423 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7424 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7425 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7426 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7427 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7428 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7430 If an option &"cache=no_rd"& is used on the lookup then
7431 the cache is only written to, cached data is not used for the operation
7432 and a real lookup is done.
7434 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7435 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7436 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7437 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7438 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7439 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7441 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7442 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7448 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7449 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7450 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7451 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7452 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7453 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7457 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7458 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7460 [name="$local_part"]
7462 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7463 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7464 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7465 of the following form is provided:
7467 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7469 For example, the way to write the NIS+ query is
7471 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7473 .cindex "tainted data" "in lookups"
7474 &*All*& tainted data used in a query-style lookup must be quoted
7475 using a mechanism appropriate for the lookup type.
7476 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7477 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7478 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7483 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7484 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7485 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7486 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7487 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7488 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7489 an expansion string could contain:
7491 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7493 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7494 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7495 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7496 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7498 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7499 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7500 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7502 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7503 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7504 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7505 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7506 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7508 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7510 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7511 white space is ignored.
7512 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7513 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7514 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7516 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7517 When the type is PTR,
7518 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7519 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7521 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7523 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7524 altered and nothing is added.
7526 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7527 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7528 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7529 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7530 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7531 The field separator can be modified as above.
7533 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7534 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7535 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7536 unless a field separator is specified.
7537 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7539 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7541 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7542 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7543 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7545 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7546 white space is ignored.
7548 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7549 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7550 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7551 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7554 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7557 .subsection "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" SECTdnsdb_mod
7558 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7559 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7560 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7561 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7562 each followed by a comma,
7563 that may appear before the record type.
7565 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7566 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7567 a defer-option modifier.
7568 The possible keywords are
7569 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7570 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7571 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7572 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7573 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7574 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7575 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7577 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7578 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7580 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7581 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7583 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7584 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7585 The possible keywords are
7586 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7587 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7589 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7590 is not labelled as authenticated data
7591 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7592 The default is &"lax"&.
7594 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7596 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7597 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7598 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7599 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7601 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7603 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7604 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7605 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7607 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7608 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7610 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7611 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7612 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7615 .subsection "Pseudo dnsdb record types" SECID66
7616 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7617 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7618 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7619 the pseudo-type MXH:
7621 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7623 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7626 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7627 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7628 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7629 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7630 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7631 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7632 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7633 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7635 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7636 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7638 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7639 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7640 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7642 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7643 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7644 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7645 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7646 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7649 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7650 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7651 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7652 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7653 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7654 result of a successful lookup such as:
7656 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7658 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7659 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7660 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7662 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7663 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7664 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7665 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7667 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7671 .subsection "Multiple dnsdb lookups" SECID67
7672 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7673 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7674 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7675 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7677 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7678 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7679 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7681 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7682 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7683 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7684 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7686 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7687 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7688 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7693 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7694 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7695 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7696 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7697 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7698 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7699 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7700 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7701 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7702 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7703 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7704 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7706 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7707 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7708 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7709 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7710 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7712 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7713 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7715 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7716 the way they handle the results of a query:
7719 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7722 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7723 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7725 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7726 from all of them are returned.
7730 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7731 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7732 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7733 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7736 .subsection "Format of LDAP queries" SECTforldaque
7737 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7738 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in
7739 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2255,RFC 2255). For example, in
7740 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7742 data = ${lookup ldap \
7743 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7744 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7746 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7747 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7748 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7749 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7751 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7752 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7753 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7755 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7756 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7757 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7758 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7759 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7760 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7761 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7762 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7766 .subsection "LDAP quoting" SECID68
7767 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7768 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7769 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7770 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7771 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7773 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7774 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7783 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2254,RFC 2254).
7784 The resulting string is then quoted according
7785 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7789 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7791 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7795 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7797 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7799 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7801 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7802 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7803 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7807 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7808 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in
7809 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2255,RFC 2253).)
7810 The resulting string is then quoted according to the rules for URLs.
7813 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7817 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7819 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7821 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7823 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7824 authentication below.
7827 .subsection "LDAP connections" SECID69
7828 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7829 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7830 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7831 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7834 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7836 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7837 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7838 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7839 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7840 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7841 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7842 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7843 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7844 failures, and timeouts.
7846 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7847 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator
7848 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1738,RFC 1738)). Because
7849 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7850 doubled. For example
7852 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7854 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7855 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7856 the local host) is used.
7858 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7859 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7860 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7861 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7864 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7865 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7866 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7867 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7869 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7871 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7872 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7874 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7876 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7877 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7878 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7879 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7880 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7881 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7882 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7885 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7886 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7887 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7890 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7893 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7897 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7898 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7902 .subsection "LDAP authentication and control information" SECID70
7903 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7904 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7905 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7906 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7907 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7908 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7909 them. The following names are recognized:
7910 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
7911 .irow DEREFERENCE "set the dereferencing parameter"
7912 .irow NETTIME "set a timeout for a network operation"
7913 .irow USER "set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind"
7914 .irow PASS "set the password, likewise"
7915 .irow REFERRALS "set the referrals parameter"
7916 .irow SERVERS "set alternate server list for this query only"
7917 .irow SIZE "set the limit for the number of entries returned"
7918 .irow TIME "set the maximum waiting time for a query"
7920 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7921 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7922 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7923 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7925 .cindex LDAP timeout
7926 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7927 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7928 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7929 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7930 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7931 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7932 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7933 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7934 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7935 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7937 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7938 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7940 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7941 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7942 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7943 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7944 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7945 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7946 alternate list (colon-separated).
7948 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7949 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7952 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7953 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7956 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7957 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7958 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7959 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7961 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7962 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7963 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7965 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7966 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it to the LDAP library.
7968 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7969 quoting has two advantages:
7972 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7973 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7975 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7978 For example, a setting such as
7980 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7982 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7984 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7985 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7986 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7987 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7991 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7992 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7997 .subsection "Format of data returned by LDAP" SECID71
7998 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7999 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
8000 as a sequence of values, for example
8002 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
8004 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
8005 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
8006 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
8007 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
8008 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
8011 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
8012 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
8013 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
8014 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
8016 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
8017 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
8018 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
8019 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
8020 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
8021 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
8022 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
8023 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
8024 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
8026 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
8027 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
8028 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
8029 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
8030 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
8033 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
8036 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
8039 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
8040 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
8042 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
8043 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
8045 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
8046 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
8049 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
8050 results of LDAP lookups.
8051 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
8052 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
8053 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
8054 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
8055 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
8056 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
8061 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
8062 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
8063 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
8064 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
8065 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
8066 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
8067 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
8068 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
8070 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
8072 might return the string
8074 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
8075 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
8077 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
8079 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
8085 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
8086 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
8087 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
8091 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
8092 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
8093 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8094 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8095 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8096 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8097 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8098 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8099 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8100 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8101 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8102 .cindex lookup Redis
8103 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
8105 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
8108 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
8111 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
8112 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
8114 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
8119 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
8121 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
8122 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
8123 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
8127 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
8128 with a newline between the data for each row.
8131 .subsection "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" SECID72
8132 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8133 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8134 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8135 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8136 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8137 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8138 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8139 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8140 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8141 .cindex lookup Redis
8142 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
8143 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
8144 or &%redis_servers%&
8145 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8147 .oindex &%mysql_servers%&
8148 .oindex &%pgsql_servers%&
8149 .oindex &%oracle_servers%&
8150 .oindex &%ibase_servers%&
8151 .oindex &%redis_servers%&
8152 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
8153 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
8154 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
8156 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
8157 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
8158 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
8159 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
8161 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
8163 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
8164 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
8165 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
8167 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
8168 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
8170 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
8171 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
8172 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
8173 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
8174 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
8175 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
8177 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
8178 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
8179 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8181 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
8182 host, database number, and password.
8184 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
8185 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
8186 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
8188 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
8190 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
8193 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
8194 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
8195 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
8196 itself are escaped with backslashes.
8198 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
8199 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
8201 .subsection "Specifying the server in the query" SECTspeserque
8202 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
8203 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
8204 done by appending a comma-separated option to the query type:
8206 &`,servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&
8208 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
8210 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
8211 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
8212 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
8215 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
8217 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
8218 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
8219 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
8221 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
8222 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
8223 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
8226 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
8230 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
8232 ${lookup mysql,servers=master {UPDATE ...} }
8234 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
8235 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
8236 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
8238 ${lookup pgsql,servers=master/db/name/pw {UPDATE ...} }
8241 A now-deprecated syntax places the servers specification before the query,
8242 semicolon separated:
8244 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
8246 The new version avoids issues with tainted
8247 arguments explicitly expanded as part of the query.
8248 The entire string within the braces becomes tainted,
8249 including the server specification - which is not permissible.
8250 If the older sytax is used, a warning message will be logged.
8251 This syntax will be removed in a future release.
8253 &*Note*&: server specifications in list-style lookups are still problematic.
8256 .subsection "Special MySQL features" SECID73
8257 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8258 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8259 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8260 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8261 the default value is &"exim"&.
8262 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8264 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8265 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8267 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8268 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8270 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8273 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8274 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8276 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8277 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8278 is zero because no rows are affected.
8280 To get an encryted connection, use a Mysql option file with the required
8281 parameters for the connection.
8284 .subsection "Special PostgreSQL features" SECID74
8285 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8286 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8287 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8288 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8291 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8293 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8294 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8295 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8297 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8298 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8301 .subsection "More about SQLite" SECTsqlite
8302 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8303 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8304 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8305 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8306 daemon as in the other SQL databases.
8308 .oindex &%sqlite_dbfile%&
8309 There are two ways of
8310 specifying the file.
8311 The first is by using the &%sqlite_dbfile%& main option.
8312 The second, which allows separate files for each query,
8313 is to use an option appended, comma-separated, to the &"sqlite"&
8314 lookup type word. The option is the word &"file"&, then an equals,
8316 The filename in this case cannot contain whitespace or open-brace charachters.
8318 A deprecated method is available, prefixing the query with the filename
8319 separated by white space.
8321 .cindex "tainted data" "sqlite file"
8322 the query cannot use any tainted values, as that taints
8323 the entire query including the filename - resulting in a refusal to open
8326 In all the above cases the filename must be an absolute path.
8328 Here is a lookup expansion example:
8330 sqlite_dbfile = /some/thing/sqlitedb
8332 ${lookup sqlite {select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8334 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8336 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;\
8337 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8339 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8340 quote, which it doubles.
8342 .cindex timeout SQLite
8343 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8344 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8345 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8346 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8347 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8348 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8349 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8352 .subsection "More about Redis" SECTredis
8353 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8354 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8355 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8358 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8359 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8362 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8363 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8364 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8365 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8368 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8369 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8370 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8377 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8378 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8380 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8381 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8382 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8383 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8384 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8385 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8386 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8387 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8388 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8390 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8391 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8392 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8393 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8395 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8396 support all the complexity available in
8397 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8401 .section "Results of list checking" SECTlistresults
8402 The primary result of doing a list check is a truth value.
8403 In some contexts additional information is stored
8404 about the list element that matched:
8407 A &%hosts%& ACL condition
8408 will store a result in the &$host_data$& variable.
8410 A &%local_parts%& router option or &%local_parts%& ACL condition
8411 will store a result in the &$local_part_data$& variable.
8413 A &%domains%& router option or &%domains%& ACL condition
8414 will store a result in the &$domain_data$& variable.
8416 A &%senders%& router option or &%senders%& ACL condition
8417 will store a result in the &$sender_data$& variable.
8419 A &%recipients%& ACL condition
8420 will store a result in the &$recipient_data$& variable.
8423 The detail of the additional information depends on the
8424 type of match and is given below as the &*value*& information.
8429 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8430 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8431 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8432 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
8433 &*Note*&: As a result, if any componend was tainted then the
8434 entire result string becomes tainted.
8436 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8437 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8440 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8441 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8442 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8443 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8444 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8447 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8448 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8449 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8451 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8452 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8453 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8454 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8455 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8457 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8458 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8460 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8461 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8462 senders based on the receiving domain.
8467 .subsection "Negated items in lists" SECID76
8468 .cindex "list" "negation"
8469 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8470 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8471 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8472 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8473 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8474 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8476 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8477 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8478 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8479 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8480 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8482 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8484 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8485 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8486 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8488 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8490 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8491 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8492 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8494 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8495 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8500 .subsection "File names in lists" SECTfilnamlis
8501 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8502 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8503 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8504 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8505 filenames are not allowed,
8506 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8507 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8511 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8512 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8514 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8515 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8516 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8518 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8522 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8523 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8524 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8525 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8527 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8528 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8530 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8532 and the file contains the lines
8537 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8538 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8542 .subsection "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" SECID77
8543 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8544 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8545 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8546 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8547 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8548 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8549 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8551 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8552 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8553 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8554 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8559 .subsection "Named lists" SECTnamedlists
8560 .cindex "named lists"
8561 .cindex "list" "named"
8562 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8563 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8564 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8565 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8566 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8567 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8568 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8570 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8572 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8573 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8574 configured with the line
8576 domains = +local_domains
8578 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8579 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8583 domains = ! +local_domains
8584 transport = remote_smtp
8587 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8588 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8589 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8590 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8592 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8593 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8595 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8597 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8598 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8599 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8601 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8602 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8603 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8605 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8606 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8608 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8609 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8610 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8612 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8614 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8615 referenced lists if you can.
8617 .cindex "hiding named list values"
8618 .cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8619 Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8620 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8621 line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8622 word &"hide"&. For example:
8624 hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8628 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8629 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8630 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8632 domains = +local_domains
8634 on several of your routers
8635 or in several ACL statements,
8636 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8637 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8638 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8639 the same each time they are referenced.
8641 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8642 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8643 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8644 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8648 .subsection "Named lists compared with macros" SECID78
8649 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8650 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8651 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8652 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8655 ALIST = host1 : host2
8656 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8658 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8660 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8662 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8665 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8666 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8668 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8670 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8674 .subsection "Named list caching" SECID79
8675 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8676 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8677 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8678 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8679 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8680 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8681 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8682 message. For example:
8684 domainlist special_domains = \
8685 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8687 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8688 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8689 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8690 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8691 same list each time.
8693 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8694 cache the result anyway. For example:
8696 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8698 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8699 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8703 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8704 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8705 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8706 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8707 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8710 .cindex "primary host name"
8711 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8712 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8713 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8714 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8715 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8716 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8717 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8718 differ only in their names.
8720 The value for a match will be the primary host name.
8724 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8725 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8726 .cindex "domain literal"
8727 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8728 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8729 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8730 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8731 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8732 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial;
8733 see the &%allow_domain_literals%& main option.
8735 The value for a match will be the string &`@[]`&.
8740 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8741 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8742 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8743 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8744 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8745 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8746 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8747 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8748 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8749 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8750 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8752 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8753 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8754 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8755 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8756 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8758 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8759 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8760 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8761 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8762 on a router). For example:
8764 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8766 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8767 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8769 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8770 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8771 contain negative items.
8773 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8774 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8775 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8777 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8778 an.other.domain : ...
8780 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8781 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8783 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8784 an.other.domain ? ...
8786 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting &`@mx_`&).
8790 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8791 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8792 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8793 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8794 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8795 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8796 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8797 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8798 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8801 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the asterisk).
8802 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the matched string
8803 and &$1$& to the variable portion which the asterisk matched.
8806 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8807 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8808 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8809 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8810 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8811 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8812 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8813 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8814 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8816 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8817 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8818 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8819 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8820 expression by expansion, of course).
8822 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the circumflex).
8823 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the string matching the regular expression,
8824 and &$1$& (onwards) to any submatches identified by parentheses.
8829 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8830 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8831 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8832 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8833 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8834 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8836 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8838 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8839 key. In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used; Exim is interested
8840 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8841 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8842 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the value is preserved in the
8843 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8844 other statements in the same ACL.
8845 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8846 .cindex "de-tainting" "using ACL domains condition"
8847 The value will be untainted.
8849 &*Note*&: If the data result of the lookup (as opposed to the key)
8850 is empty, then this empty value is stored in &$domain_data$&.
8851 The option to return the key for the lookup, as the value,
8852 may be what is wanted.
8856 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8857 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8859 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8861 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8862 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8865 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8866 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8867 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8868 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8869 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8870 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8874 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8875 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8876 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8877 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8879 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8880 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8882 In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8883 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8884 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8885 &%domains%& option on a router, the value is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8886 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8887 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8888 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
8889 The value will be untainted.
8892 If the pattern starts with the name of a lookup type
8893 of either kind (single-key or query-style) it may be
8894 followed by a comma and options,
8895 The options are lookup-type specific and consist of a comma-separated list.
8896 Each item starts with a tag and and equals "=" sign.
8899 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8900 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8901 between the pattern and the domain.
8903 The value for a match will be the list element string.
8904 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8905 Note that this is commonly untainted
8906 (depending on the way the list was created).
8907 Specifically, explicit text in the configuration file in not tainted.
8908 This is a useful way of obtaining an untainted equivalent to
8909 the domain, for later operations.
8911 However if the list (including one-element lists)
8912 is created by expanding a variable containing tainted data,
8913 it is tainted and so will the match value be.
8917 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8919 domainlist funny_domains = \
8922 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8923 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8924 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8925 nis;domains.byname : \
8926 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8928 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8929 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8930 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8931 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8932 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8937 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8938 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8939 .cindex "list" "host list"
8940 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8941 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8942 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8943 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8944 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8945 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8946 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8949 .subsection "Special host list patterns" SECID80
8950 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8951 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8952 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8953 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8954 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8957 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8958 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8959 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8963 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by IP address" SECThoslispatip
8964 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8965 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8966 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8967 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8968 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8969 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8972 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8973 inspecting its IP address:
8976 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8977 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8978 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8979 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8980 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8981 with the IP address of the subject host.
8983 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8984 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8985 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8986 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8987 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8990 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8991 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8992 domain name, as just described.
8995 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8996 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8997 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8998 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8999 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
9000 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
9001 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
9002 that can never match a client host.
9005 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
9006 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
9007 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
9008 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
9010 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
9014 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9015 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length, for
9020 , it is matched against the IP address of the subject
9021 host under the given mask. This allows an entire network of hosts to be
9022 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
9023 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
9024 significant end of the address.
9026 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
9027 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
9028 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
9029 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
9033 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
9034 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
9037 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
9039 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
9040 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
9042 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
9043 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
9046 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
9048 could make use of a file containing
9053 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
9054 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
9055 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
9057 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
9060 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
9066 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
9068 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
9069 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
9070 address, the pattern takes this form:
9072 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9076 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
9078 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
9079 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
9080 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
9081 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
9082 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
9083 returned by the lookup is not used.
9085 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9086 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
9087 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
9088 patterns of this form:
9090 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9094 net24-dbm;/networks.db
9096 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
9097 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
9098 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
9099 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
9100 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
9102 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
9103 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
9104 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
9105 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
9106 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
9107 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
9108 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
9109 converted using colons and not dots.
9110 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
9111 addresses are always used.
9112 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
9114 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
9115 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
9116 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
9119 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
9120 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
9121 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
9122 case the IP address is used on its own.
9126 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by host name" SECThoslispatnam
9127 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
9128 .cindex "unknown host name"
9129 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9130 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
9131 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
9132 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
9133 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
9136 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
9137 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
9138 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
9139 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
9140 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
9141 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
9142 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
9144 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
9145 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
9147 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
9148 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
9149 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
9150 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
9151 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
9152 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
9153 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
9154 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
9155 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
9157 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
9158 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
9160 .cindex "host" "alias for"
9161 .cindex "alias for host"
9162 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
9163 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
9166 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
9167 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
9168 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
9169 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
9170 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
9173 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
9174 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
9175 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
9176 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
9177 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
9178 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
9179 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
9184 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
9185 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
9186 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
9187 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
9188 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9190 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
9192 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
9193 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
9194 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
9201 .subsection "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" SECTbehipnot
9202 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
9203 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
9204 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
9205 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
9206 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
9208 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
9209 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
9211 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
9212 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
9213 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
9214 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
9215 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
9216 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
9217 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
9218 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
9219 not recognized in an indirected file).
9222 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
9223 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
9225 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
9227 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
9228 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
9231 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
9232 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
9235 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
9238 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
9239 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
9240 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
9243 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
9244 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
9247 .subsection "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
9249 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
9251 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
9252 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
9253 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
9256 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
9257 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
9258 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
9260 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
9262 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
9263 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
9264 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
9265 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
9266 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
9267 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
9268 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
9271 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
9272 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
9274 accept hosts = *.friend.example
9275 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
9277 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
9278 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
9279 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
9284 .subsection "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
9286 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
9287 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
9288 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
9289 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
9290 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
9291 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
9292 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
9293 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
9294 host lists such as whitelists.
9298 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
9300 .cindex "unknown host name"
9301 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9302 If a pattern is of the form
9304 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
9308 dbm;/host/accept/list
9310 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
9311 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
9314 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
9315 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
9316 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"&
9317 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
9318 There is, however, no reason why you could not use
9319 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
9320 lookup, both using the same file.
9324 .subsection "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" SECID81
9325 If a pattern is of the form
9327 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
9329 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
9330 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
9331 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
9333 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
9334 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
9336 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
9337 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
9338 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
9341 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
9342 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
9343 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
9345 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
9346 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
9347 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
9348 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
9349 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
9350 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
9356 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
9357 .cindex "list" "address list"
9358 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
9359 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
9360 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
9361 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
9362 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
9363 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
9364 using this option setting:
9368 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9369 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9370 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9371 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9373 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9376 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9378 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9379 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9380 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9381 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9382 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9383 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9384 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9386 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9387 *@+hostile_domains:\
9388 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9389 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9391 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9392 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9393 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9394 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9395 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9397 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9398 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9399 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9400 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9401 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9403 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9406 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9407 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9411 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9412 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9413 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9414 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9415 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9416 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9417 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9419 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9420 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9422 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9423 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9426 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9427 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9428 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9431 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9432 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9433 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9435 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9436 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9437 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9438 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9440 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9441 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9443 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9444 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9445 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9446 default. For example, with this lookup:
9448 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9450 the file could contains lines like this:
9452 user1@domain1.example
9455 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9458 nimrod@jaeger.example
9462 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9463 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9465 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9467 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9468 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9470 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9471 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9472 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9476 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9477 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9482 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9483 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9484 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9485 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9486 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9487 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9488 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9489 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9490 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9492 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9493 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9494 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9495 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9496 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9499 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9501 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9503 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9505 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9507 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9508 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9509 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9510 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9511 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9512 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9514 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9517 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9520 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9521 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9522 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9523 might have entries like
9525 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9526 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9529 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9530 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9531 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9532 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9534 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9535 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9536 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9539 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9540 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9541 can only return a single list of local parts.
9544 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9545 in these two examples:
9548 senders = *@+my_list
9550 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9551 example it is a named domain list.
9556 .subsection "Case of letters in address lists" SECTcasletadd
9557 .cindex "case of local parts"
9558 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9559 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9560 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9561 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9562 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However,
9563 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2505,RFC 2505) (&'Anti-Spam
9564 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9565 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9566 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9569 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9570 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9571 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9572 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9573 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9574 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9575 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9578 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9579 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9580 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9581 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9582 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9583 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9584 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9585 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9589 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9590 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9591 .cindex "local part" "list"
9592 These behave in the same way as domain and host lists, with the following
9595 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9596 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9597 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9598 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9599 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9600 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9601 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9602 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9604 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9605 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9606 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9607 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9608 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9609 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9610 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9612 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9617 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9620 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9621 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9622 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9623 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9625 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9626 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9627 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9628 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9629 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9630 escape character, as described in the following section.
9632 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
9633 If any porttion of the result string is tainted, the entire result is.
9635 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9636 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9637 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9638 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9639 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9641 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9642 .cindex "tainted data" definition
9643 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9644 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9645 is not permitted (including acessing a file using a tainted name).
9647 Common ways of obtaining untainted equivalents of variables with
9649 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
9650 come down to using the tainted value as a lookup key in a trusted database.
9651 This database could be the filesystem structure,
9652 or the password file,
9653 or accessed via a DBMS.
9654 Specific methods are indexed under &"de-tainting"&.
9658 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9659 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9660 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9661 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9662 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9663 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9664 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9665 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9667 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9668 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9669 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9670 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9672 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9674 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9675 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9680 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9681 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9682 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9683 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9684 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9685 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9686 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9689 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9690 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9691 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9694 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9695 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9696 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9698 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9699 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9700 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9701 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9702 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9703 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9704 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9707 When reading lines from the standard input,
9708 macros can be defined and ACL variables can be set.
9712 set acl_m_myvar = bar
9714 Such macros and variables can then be used in later input lines.
9716 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9717 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9718 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9721 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9722 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9723 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9724 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9726 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9728 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9729 Exim message identifier. For example:
9731 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9733 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9734 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9737 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9738 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9739 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9740 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9741 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9742 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9743 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9744 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9745 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9746 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9747 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9748 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9754 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9755 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9756 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9757 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9758 white space is significant.
9761 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9762 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9763 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9768 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9769 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9770 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9771 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9772 given, the expansion fails.
9774 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9775 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9776 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9777 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9781 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9782 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9783 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9784 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9785 string easier to understand.
9787 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9788 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9789 expansion item below.
9792 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9793 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9794 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9795 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9796 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9797 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9798 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9799 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9800 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9801 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9802 the result of the expansion.
9803 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9804 the expansion result is an empty string.
9805 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9808 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9809 .cindex authentication "results header"
9810 .chindex Authentication-Results:
9811 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9812 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9813 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9815 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9816 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9817 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9826 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9828 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9830 This is safe even if no authentication results are available
9831 and would generally be placed in the DATA ACL.
9834 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9835 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9836 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9837 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9838 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9839 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9840 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9841 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9845 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9846 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9851 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9855 If the field is found,
9856 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9857 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9858 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9859 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9861 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9862 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9865 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9867 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9868 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9870 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9871 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9872 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9873 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9874 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9875 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9876 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9877 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9879 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9880 take an optional modifier of "int"
9881 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9882 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9883 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9885 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9886 newline-separated by default,
9887 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9888 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9889 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9891 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9892 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9893 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9894 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9895 if so the element tags are omitted.
9897 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9899 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9900 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9902 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9903 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9907 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9908 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9909 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9911 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9914 a local function that is to be called in this way,
9915 first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9916 and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9917 The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9918 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9919 must have the following type:
9921 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9923 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9924 function should return one of the following values:
9926 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9927 into the expanded string that is being built.
9929 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9930 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9932 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9933 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9935 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9937 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9938 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9939 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9942 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9943 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9944 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9945 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9947 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9948 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9949 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9951 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9952 appear, for example:
9954 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9956 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9957 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9959 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9961 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9964 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9965 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9968 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9969 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9970 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9971 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9972 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9973 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9974 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9975 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9977 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9980 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9981 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9982 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9983 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9984 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9985 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9986 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9987 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9988 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9990 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9991 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9992 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9995 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9996 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9998 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9999 appear, for example:
10001 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
10003 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
10004 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
10006 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
10007 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10008 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
10009 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10010 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
10011 .cindex JSON expansions
10012 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
10013 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
10014 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
10015 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
10017 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
10019 .vindex "&$value$&"
10020 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
10021 the spaces are optional.
10022 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
10023 For the &"json"& variant,
10024 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
10026 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
10027 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
10028 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
10030 The results of matching are handled as above.
10033 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
10034 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10035 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
10036 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
10037 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10038 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
10039 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
10040 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
10041 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
10042 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
10043 <&'string3'&> as before.
10045 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
10046 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
10047 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
10048 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
10049 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
10050 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
10051 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
10052 provided. For example:
10054 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
10058 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
10060 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
10061 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
10064 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
10065 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10066 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
10067 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10068 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
10069 .cindex JSON expansions
10070 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10071 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
10073 Field selection and result handling is as above;
10074 there is no choice of field separator.
10075 For the &"json"& variant,
10076 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
10078 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
10079 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
10082 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
10083 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
10084 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
10086 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10087 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10089 in this list, its value is placed in &$item$&, and then the condition is
10091 Any modification of &$value$& by this evaluation is discarded.
10092 If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
10093 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
10094 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
10095 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
10097 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
10099 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
10100 to what it was before.
10101 See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10104 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10105 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10106 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10107 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
10108 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
10109 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
10111 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
10112 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
10113 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
10114 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10116 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10118 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
10119 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
10120 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
10121 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
10122 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
10124 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
10126 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
10127 letters appear. For example:
10129 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
10130 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
10131 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
10134 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10135 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10136 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10137 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10138 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10139 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10140 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10141 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10142 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
10143 .vindex "&$header_$&"
10144 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
10145 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
10146 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
10147 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
10148 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
10149 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
10150 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
10154 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
10155 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
10156 lines) may be present.
10158 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
10159 the data in the header line is interpreted.
10162 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
10163 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
10164 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
10167 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
10168 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
10169 are multiple headers with a given name.
10170 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
10171 list-processing facilities can be used.
10172 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
10173 the content is &"raw"&.
10176 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
10177 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
10178 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
10179 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
10180 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
10181 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
10182 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
10183 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
10186 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
10187 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
10188 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
10189 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
10190 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
10191 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
10194 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
10195 command of the following form:
10197 headers charset "UTF-8"
10199 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
10200 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
10201 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
10202 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
10203 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
10206 Header names follow the syntax of
10207 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822),
10208 which states that they may contain
10209 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
10210 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
10211 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
10213 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
10214 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
10215 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
10216 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
10217 router or transport are not accessible.
10219 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
10220 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
10221 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
10222 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
10223 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
10224 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
10225 point they are added.
10226 When any of the above ACLs are
10227 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
10229 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
10230 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
10231 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
10232 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
10233 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
10234 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
10235 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
10238 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
10239 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
10240 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
10241 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
10242 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
10243 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
10244 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
10245 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
10247 .cindex "tainted data" "message headers"
10248 When the headers are from an incoming message,
10249 the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
10252 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10253 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
10255 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
10256 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
10257 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2104.RFC 2104).
10258 This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
10259 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
10260 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
10261 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
10262 present. For example:
10264 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
10266 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
10269 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
10271 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
10272 an Exim configuration:
10274 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
10276 In a router or a transport you could then have:
10279 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
10280 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
10281 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
10283 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
10284 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
10285 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
10286 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
10287 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
10288 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
10291 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10292 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
10293 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
10294 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
10295 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
10296 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
10298 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
10300 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
10301 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
10302 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
10303 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
10304 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
10306 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
10307 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
10308 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
10310 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
10314 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
10319 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
10320 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
10321 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
10322 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
10323 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
10324 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
10328 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10329 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10330 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10331 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
10332 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
10333 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
10334 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
10335 some of the braces:
10337 ${length_<n>:<string>}
10339 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
10340 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
10341 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
10342 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10345 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
10346 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10347 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
10348 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
10349 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
10350 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10351 apart from an optional leading minus,
10352 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
10354 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10355 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10357 The first field of the list is numbered one.
10358 If the number is negative, the fields are
10359 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
10360 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
10361 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
10363 If the modulus of the
10364 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
10365 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
10369 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
10373 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
10375 yields &"result: 42"&.
10377 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
10378 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10380 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
10383 .vitem &*${listquote{*&<&'separator'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10384 .cindex quoting "for list"
10385 .cindex list quoting
10386 This item doubles any occurrence of the separator character
10387 in the given string.
10388 An empty string is replaced with a single space.
10389 This converts the string into a safe form for use as a list element,
10390 in a list using the given separator.
10393 .vitem "&*${lookup&~{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
10394 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10395 "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
10396 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10397 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
10398 .cindex "file" "lookups"
10399 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
10400 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
10401 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
10402 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
10403 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
10405 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10406 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10407 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10408 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10409 out by the system administrator.
10411 .vindex "&$value$&"
10412 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10413 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10414 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10415 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10416 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10417 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10418 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10419 original lookup fails.
10421 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10422 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10423 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10424 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10425 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10426 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10427 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10428 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10430 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10431 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10432 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10433 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10435 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10436 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10437 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10438 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10440 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10442 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10444 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10445 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10447 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10452 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10453 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10455 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10456 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10458 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10459 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10460 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10461 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10463 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10465 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10466 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10467 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10469 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10470 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10471 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10472 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10473 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10474 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10475 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10477 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10479 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10480 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10481 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10482 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10485 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10487 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10491 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10492 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10493 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10494 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10495 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10496 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10497 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10498 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10500 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10501 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the entire expansion is
10502 forced to fail, in the same way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item
10503 does (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). Whatever you return is evaluated
10504 in a scalar context, thus the return value is a scalar. For example, if you
10505 return a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10508 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10509 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10510 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10512 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10513 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10516 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10517 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10518 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10519 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10520 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10521 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10522 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10523 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10525 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10526 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10527 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10528 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10529 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10530 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10531 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10532 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10533 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10534 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10536 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10537 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10538 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10539 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10541 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10542 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10543 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10544 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10545 is the expansion of the third argument.
10547 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10548 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10549 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10551 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10552 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10553 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10554 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10555 The filename and end-of-line (eol) string are first expanded separately. The file is
10556 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10557 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10558 newlines are left in the string.
10559 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10560 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10561 the string expansion fails.
10563 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10564 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10568 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10569 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10570 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10571 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10572 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10573 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10574 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10577 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10578 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10580 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10581 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10582 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10583 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10584 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10587 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10589 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10590 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10591 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10592 (unless it is an empty string; no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10593 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10594 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10595 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10597 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10600 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10601 and must be present if any options are given.
10602 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10605 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10608 The following option names are recognised:
10611 Defines if the result data can be cached for use by a later identical
10612 request in the same process.
10613 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10614 If not, all cached results for this connection specification
10615 will be invalidated.
10619 Defines whether or not a write-shutdown is done on the connection after
10620 sending the request. Values are &"yes"& (the default) or &"no"&
10621 (preferred, eg. by some webservers).
10625 Controls the use of Server Name Identification on the connection.
10626 Any nonempty value will be the SNI sent; TLS will be forced.
10630 Controls the use of TLS on the connection.
10631 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10632 If it is enabled, a shutdown as described above is never done.
10636 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10637 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10638 turns them into spaces:
10640 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10642 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10643 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10644 addition, the following errors can occur:
10647 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10649 Failure to connect the socket;
10651 Failure to write the request string;
10653 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10656 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10657 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10658 errors occurs. For example:
10660 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10663 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10664 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10665 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10666 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10667 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10669 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10670 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10673 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10674 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10675 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10676 .vindex "&$value$&"
10678 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10679 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10680 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10681 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10682 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10683 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10684 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10685 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10686 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10687 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10689 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10691 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10694 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10696 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10697 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10700 . A bit of a special-case logic error in writing an expansion;
10701 . probably not worth including in the mainline of documentation.
10702 . If only we had footnotes (the html output variant is the problem).
10705 . &*Note*&: if an &'expansion condition'& is used in <&'string3'&>
10706 . and that condition modifies &$value$&,
10707 . then the string expansions dependent on the condition cannot use
10708 . the &$value$& of the reduce iteration.
10711 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10712 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10713 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10715 .vitem "&*${run<&'options'&> {*&<&'command&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10716 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10717 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10718 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10719 This item runs an external command, as a subprocess.
10720 One option is supported after the word &'run'&, comma-separated
10721 and without whitespace.
10723 If the option &'preexpand'& is not used,
10724 the command string before expansion is split into individual arguments by spaces
10725 and then each argument is separately expanded.
10726 Then the command is run
10727 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10728 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10729 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10730 The command name may not be tainted, but the remaining arguments can be.
10732 &*Note*&: if tainted arguments are used, they are supplied by a
10733 potential attacker;
10734 a careful assessment for security vulnerabilities should be done.
10736 If the option &'preexpand'& is used,
10737 the command string is first expanded as a whole.
10738 The expansion result is split apart into individual arguments by spaces,
10739 and then the command is run as above.
10740 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10741 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10742 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10743 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10744 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10745 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10746 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10747 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10748 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10750 Neither the command nor any argument may be tainted.
10752 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10753 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10754 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10755 .vindex "&$value$&"
10756 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10757 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10758 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10759 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10760 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10763 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10764 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10765 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10766 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10768 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10769 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10770 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10773 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10774 log_message = Output of id: $value
10776 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10777 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10779 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10781 Note that &$value$& will not persist beyond the reception of a single message.
10783 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10784 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10785 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10787 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10788 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10792 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10793 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10796 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10797 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10798 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10799 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10801 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10802 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10805 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10806 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10807 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10808 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10809 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10810 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10811 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10812 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10814 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10816 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10817 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10818 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10820 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10822 yields &"defabc"&, and
10824 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10826 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10827 the regular expression from string expansion.
10829 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10830 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10833 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10834 .cindex sorting "a list"
10835 .cindex list sorting
10836 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10837 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10838 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10839 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10840 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10841 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10842 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10843 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10844 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10845 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10846 to give values for comparison.
10848 The item result is a sorted list,
10849 with the original list separator,
10850 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10854 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10856 sorts a list of numbers, and
10858 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10860 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10864 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
10865 SRS encoding. See section &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
10869 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'start'&>&*}{*&<&'len'&>&*}{*&<&'subject'&>&*}}*&
10870 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10871 .cindex "substring extraction"
10872 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10873 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10874 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10875 if <&'start'&> and <&'len'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10876 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10878 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<subject>}
10880 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10881 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10884 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10885 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10886 length required. For example
10888 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10890 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10891 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10892 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10893 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10895 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10896 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10897 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10899 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10901 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10902 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10903 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10905 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10907 yields an empty string, but
10909 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10913 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10914 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10915 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10916 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10919 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10921 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10923 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10927 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10928 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10929 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10930 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10931 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10932 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10933 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10934 replacement list. For example
10936 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10938 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10939 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10940 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10943 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10949 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10950 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10951 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10952 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10953 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10954 following operations can be performed:
10957 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10958 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10959 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10960 The string is interpreted as an
10961 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
10962 address, as it might appear in a
10963 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10964 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10966 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10969 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10970 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10971 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10972 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in
10973 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
10974 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10975 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10976 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10977 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10978 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10980 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10981 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10982 character. For example:
10984 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10986 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10987 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10988 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10989 separator explicitly:
10991 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10994 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10995 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10996 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10999 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
11000 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
11001 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
11002 email address separator. For the example header line:
11004 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
11006 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
11007 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
11008 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
11009 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
11010 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
11011 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
11012 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
11014 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
11015 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
11017 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
11018 Last:user@example.com
11019 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
11021 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
11025 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
11026 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
11027 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
11028 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
11029 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
11030 Only lowercase letters are used.
11032 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
11033 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
11034 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
11035 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
11036 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
11038 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
11039 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
11040 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
11041 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
11042 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
11043 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
11044 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
11045 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
11046 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
11048 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
11049 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
11050 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
11051 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
11052 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
11053 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
11056 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11057 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
11058 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
11059 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
11060 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
11061 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
11063 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11064 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
11067 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11068 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
11069 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
11070 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
11071 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
11074 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11075 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
11076 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
11077 The string is interpreted as an
11078 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11079 address and the domain is extracted from it.
11080 If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
11083 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11084 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
11085 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
11086 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
11087 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
11088 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
11089 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
11091 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11092 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
11093 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
11094 If the string contains any characters with the most significant bit set,
11095 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
11096 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
11099 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11100 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
11101 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
11102 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
11103 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
11104 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
11105 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
11106 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
11107 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
11108 C programming language):
11110 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
11111 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
11112 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
11113 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
11114 .irow "" "and (&&)"
11116 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
11118 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
11119 space is permitted before or after operators.
11121 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
11122 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
11123 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
11124 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
11125 times, which often do have leading zeros.
11127 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
11129 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
11130 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
11133 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
11134 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
11135 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
11136 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
11137 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
11138 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
11139 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
11140 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
11141 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
11142 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
11143 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
11146 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
11150 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
11153 {$recipients_count} \
11154 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
11157 message = Too many bad recipients
11159 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
11160 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
11163 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11164 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
11165 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
11168 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
11170 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
11171 and then re-expands what it has found.
11174 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11176 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
11177 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
11178 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
11179 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
11180 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
11181 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
11182 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
11183 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
11184 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
11186 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
11187 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
11188 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
11189 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
11190 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
11191 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
11192 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
11195 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11196 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
11197 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
11198 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
11199 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
11200 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11202 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11204 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
11205 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
11209 .vitem &*${headerwrap_*&<&'cols'&>&*_*&<&'limit'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11210 .cindex header "wrapping operator"
11211 .cindex expansion "header wrapping"
11212 This operator line-wraps its argument in a way useful for headers.
11213 The &'cols'& value gives the column number to wrap after,
11214 the &'limit'& gives a limit number of result characters to truncate at.
11215 Either just the &'limit'& and the preceding underbar, or both, can be omitted;
11216 the defaults are 80 and 998.
11217 Wrapping will be inserted at a space if possible before the
11218 column number is reached.
11219 Whitespace at a chosen wrap point is removed.
11220 A line-wrap consists of a newline followed by a tab,
11221 and the tab is counted as 8 columns.
11225 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
11226 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
11227 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
11228 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
11229 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
11230 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
11234 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11235 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
11236 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
11237 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
11238 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
11239 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
11240 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
11243 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11244 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
11245 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11246 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
11247 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
11248 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11249 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11251 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11252 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
11253 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11254 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
11255 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
11256 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
11257 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
11258 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11259 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11262 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11263 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11264 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11265 .cindex "lower casing"
11266 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11267 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
11268 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
11272 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11274 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11275 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
11276 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
11277 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
11278 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
11279 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
11281 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
11283 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
11284 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
11285 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
11286 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11289 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11290 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
11291 .cindex "list" "item count"
11292 .cindex "list" "count of items"
11293 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
11294 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
11297 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
11298 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
11299 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
11300 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
11301 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
11302 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
11303 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
11304 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
11305 matching list is returned.
11306 &*Note*&: Neither string-expansion of lists referenced by named-list syntax elements,
11307 nor expansion of lookup elements, is done by the &%listnamed%& operator.
11310 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11311 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
11312 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
11313 The string is interpreted as an
11314 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11315 address and the local part is extracted from it.
11316 If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
11317 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
11320 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*& &&&
11321 &*${mask_n:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
11322 .cindex "masked IP address"
11323 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
11324 .cindex "CIDR notation"
11325 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
11326 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
11327 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
11328 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
11329 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
11330 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
11331 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
11333 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
11335 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&.
11337 Since this operation is expected to
11338 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the
11341 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
11342 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
11344 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
11348 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
11350 If the optional form &*mask_n*& is used, IPv6 address result are instead
11351 returned in normailsed form, using colons and with zero-compression.
11352 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
11355 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11357 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
11358 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11359 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
11360 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
11361 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
11363 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11364 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11367 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11368 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
11369 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
11370 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
11371 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
11372 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11374 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11376 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
11379 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11380 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
11381 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
11382 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
11383 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
11384 is an empty string or
11385 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
11386 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
11387 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
11388 respectively For example,
11396 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
11397 variable or a message header.
11399 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11400 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
11401 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
11402 required to do so by the rules of
11403 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11404 for quoting local parts. For example,
11405 a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
11406 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
11407 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
11409 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
11410 will likely use the quoting form.
11411 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
11414 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11415 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
11416 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
11417 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
11418 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
11420 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
11426 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
11427 yields an unchanged string.
11430 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
11431 .cindex "random number"
11432 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
11433 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
11434 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
11435 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
11436 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
11437 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
11438 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
11439 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
11443 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
11444 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
11445 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
11446 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
11447 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
11448 for DNS. For example,
11450 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
11451 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
11456 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
11460 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11461 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11462 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
11463 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
11464 This operator encodes text according to the rules of
11465 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047). This is an
11466 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
11467 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
11468 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
11469 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
11472 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
11474 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
11475 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
11479 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11480 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11481 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
11482 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
11483 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per
11484 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047).
11486 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
11487 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
11488 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
11490 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
11491 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
11492 to use this operator as well.
11496 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11497 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11498 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11499 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11500 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11501 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11502 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11505 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11506 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11507 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11508 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11509 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11510 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11511 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11513 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11514 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11517 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11518 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11519 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11520 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11521 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11522 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11523 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11524 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11525 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11526 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11528 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11530 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11531 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11533 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11534 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
11535 Finally, if an underbar
11536 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11537 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11538 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11541 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11542 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11543 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11544 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11545 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11546 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11548 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11550 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11551 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11552 with 256 being the default.
11554 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11555 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11556 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11557 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11560 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11561 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11562 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11563 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11564 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11565 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11566 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11567 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11568 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11569 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11570 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11571 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11572 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11574 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11575 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11576 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11578 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11579 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11580 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11584 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11585 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11586 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11587 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11588 The item is replaced by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11589 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11590 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11593 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11594 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11595 .cindex "substring extraction"
11596 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11597 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11598 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11599 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11601 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11603 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11604 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11605 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11607 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11608 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11609 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11610 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11613 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11614 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11615 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11616 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11617 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11618 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11621 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11622 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11623 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11624 .cindex "upper casing"
11625 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11626 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11627 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11628 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11630 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11631 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11632 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11633 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11634 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11635 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11636 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11637 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11638 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11639 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11640 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11641 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11642 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11643 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11645 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11647 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11648 literal question mark).
11650 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11651 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11652 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11653 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11654 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11655 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11657 .cindex internationalisation
11658 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11659 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11660 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11661 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11662 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11663 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11666 .vitem &*${xtextd:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11667 .cindex "text forcing in strings"
11668 .cindex "string" "xtext decoding"
11670 .cindex "&%xtextd%& expansion item"
11671 This performs xtext decoding of the string (per
11672 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461) section 4).
11683 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11684 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11685 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11686 while expanding strings:
11689 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11690 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11691 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11692 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11695 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11696 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11697 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11698 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11700 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
11702 .irow "== " "equal"
11703 .irow "> " "greater"
11704 .irow ">= " "greater or equal"
11706 .irow "<= " "less or equal"
11710 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11712 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11713 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11714 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11715 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11716 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11719 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11720 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11721 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11724 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11725 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11726 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11727 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11728 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11729 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11730 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11731 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11732 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11733 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11734 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11735 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11736 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11737 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11739 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11740 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11741 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11742 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11743 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11744 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11746 An empty string is treated as false.
11747 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11748 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11749 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11751 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11752 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11755 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11759 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11760 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11761 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11762 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11763 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11764 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11765 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11766 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11768 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11770 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11771 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11772 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11773 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11774 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11775 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11776 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11777 included in the binary.
11779 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11780 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11781 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11782 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11783 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11784 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11785 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11786 string in LDAP form is:
11788 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11790 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11791 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11793 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11795 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11800 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11801 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11802 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11803 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11804 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11805 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11809 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11810 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11811 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11812 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11813 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11814 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11817 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11818 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11819 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11820 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11821 whatever its length.
11824 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11825 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11826 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11827 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11829 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11830 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11831 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11832 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11833 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11834 support &[crypt16()]&.
11836 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11837 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11838 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11839 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11840 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11842 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11843 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11844 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11846 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11847 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11848 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11849 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11850 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11852 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11853 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11854 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11855 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11856 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11857 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11859 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11861 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11862 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11864 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11865 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11866 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11867 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11868 exists in the message. For example,
11870 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11872 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11873 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11875 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11876 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11877 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11878 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11879 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11880 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11881 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11882 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11883 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11884 case is defined per the system C locale.
11886 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11887 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11888 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11889 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11890 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11891 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11892 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11893 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11895 &*Note:*& Testing a path using this condition is not a sufficient way of
11897 Consider using a dsearch lookup.
11899 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11900 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11901 .cindex "first delivery"
11902 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11903 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11904 .cindex retry condition
11905 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11906 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11909 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11910 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11911 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11912 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11913 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11915 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11916 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11917 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11918 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11919 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11920 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11922 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11923 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11924 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11926 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11927 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11928 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11930 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11931 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11932 that the condition must be false for at least one item.
11936 ${if forany{$recipients_list}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11938 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11939 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11941 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11943 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11944 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11945 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11946 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11947 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11948 .cindex JSON expansions
11949 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11950 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11951 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11952 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11953 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11955 The array separator is not changeable.
11956 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11957 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11961 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11962 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11963 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11964 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11965 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11966 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11967 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11968 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11969 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11971 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11973 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11974 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11975 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11976 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11977 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11978 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11979 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11980 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11981 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11983 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11986 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
11987 SRS decode. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
11990 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*& &&&
11991 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*&
11992 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11993 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11994 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11995 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11997 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11999 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
12000 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
12002 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
12003 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
12004 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
12005 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
12008 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12009 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12010 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
12011 .cindex "de-tainting" "using an inlist expansion condition"
12012 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
12014 ${if inlist {$h_mycode:} {0 : 1 : 42} {$value}}
12016 can be used for de-tainting.
12017 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12020 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
12021 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
12022 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
12023 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
12024 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
12025 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
12026 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
12027 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
12028 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
12029 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
12030 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
12032 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
12033 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
12034 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
12035 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
12036 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
12038 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
12039 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
12041 This is no longer the case.
12043 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
12044 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
12046 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
12048 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
12050 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
12051 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
12052 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
12053 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
12054 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
12055 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
12056 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
12057 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
12058 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
12059 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
12060 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
12061 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
12062 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
12066 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12067 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12068 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12069 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12070 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
12071 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
12072 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12073 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
12074 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
12076 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12078 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12079 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12080 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12081 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12082 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
12083 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
12084 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12085 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
12086 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
12088 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12091 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12092 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
12093 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
12094 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
12095 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
12096 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
12097 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
12098 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
12099 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
12100 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
12101 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
12104 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
12106 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
12107 backslashes is also required.
12109 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
12110 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
12111 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
12112 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
12113 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
12114 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
12115 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
12116 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
12118 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
12119 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
12120 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
12121 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
12122 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
12123 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
12124 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
12125 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
12127 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12128 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
12129 See &*match_local_part*&.
12131 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12132 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
12133 See &*match_local_part*&.
12135 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12136 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
12137 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
12138 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
12139 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
12140 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
12142 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
12144 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
12147 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
12149 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
12151 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
12152 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
12153 in a single test such as
12154 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12155 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
12156 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
12157 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
12159 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
12161 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
12163 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
12165 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists
12166 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&),
12167 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
12168 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
12169 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
12170 masks. For example:
12172 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
12174 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
12175 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
12176 address mask, for example:
12178 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
12180 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
12181 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
12183 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
12187 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12188 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12190 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
12192 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12193 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12194 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12196 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12197 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
12198 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
12199 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
12200 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
12201 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
12202 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
12203 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
12206 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
12208 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
12209 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
12210 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
12211 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
12213 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
12215 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
12216 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
12217 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
12218 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
12221 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12222 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12223 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
12224 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a match_local_part expansion condition"
12225 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
12227 ${if match_local_part {$local_part} {alice : bill : charlotte : dave} {$value}}
12229 can be used for de-tainting.
12230 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12232 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12233 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12235 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
12236 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
12237 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
12238 matched using &%match_ip%&.
12240 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
12241 .cindex "PAM authentication"
12242 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
12243 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
12244 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
12245 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
12246 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
12247 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
12248 available in Solaris
12249 and in some GNU/Linux distributions.
12250 The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
12251 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
12255 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
12256 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
12258 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
12259 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
12260 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
12261 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
12262 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
12263 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
12264 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
12266 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
12267 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
12269 The &%listquote%& expansion item can be used for this.
12270 For example, the configuration
12271 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
12273 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${listquote{:}{$auth2}}}}
12275 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
12276 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
12277 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
12278 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
12281 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12282 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
12284 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
12285 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
12286 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
12287 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
12288 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
12289 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
12291 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12292 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12293 building Exim. For example:
12295 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
12297 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12298 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12299 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
12300 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
12302 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
12303 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
12304 configuration, you might have this:
12306 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
12308 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
12310 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
12312 .vitem &*queue_running*&
12313 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
12314 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
12315 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
12316 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
12317 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
12320 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
12322 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
12323 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
12324 Radius authentication
12325 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2865,RFC 2865))
12326 is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
12327 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
12328 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
12331 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
12332 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
12333 this library, you need to set
12335 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
12337 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
12338 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
12340 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
12342 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
12343 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
12344 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
12346 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
12347 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
12348 the authentication is successful. For example:
12350 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
12354 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
12355 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
12356 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
12358 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
12359 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
12360 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
12361 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
12362 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
12363 by a process that is not running as root.
12365 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12366 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12367 building Exim. For example:
12369 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
12371 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12372 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12373 from the Cyrus SASL library.
12375 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
12376 two are mandatory. For example:
12378 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
12380 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
12381 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
12382 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
12387 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
12388 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
12389 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
12390 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
12391 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
12392 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
12393 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
12397 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12398 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
12399 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
12400 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12401 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
12404 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
12406 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
12407 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
12408 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
12410 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12411 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
12412 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
12413 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12414 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
12415 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
12416 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
12417 parsed but not evaluated.
12419 .ecindex IIDexpcond
12424 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
12425 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
12426 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
12427 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
12428 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
12429 .cindex "tainted data"
12430 Variables marked as &'tainted'& are likely to carry data supplied by
12431 a potential attacker.
12432 Variables without such marking may also, depending on how their
12433 values are created.
12434 Such variables should not be further expanded,
12436 or used as command-line arguments for external commands.
12439 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
12440 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
12441 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
12442 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
12443 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
12444 In the expansion condition case
12445 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
12446 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
12447 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
12448 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
12449 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
12450 matching condition.
12451 If the subject string was tainted then any captured substring will also be.
12453 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
12454 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12455 any arguments are copied to these variables,
12456 any unused variables being made empty.
12458 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
12459 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
12460 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
12461 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
12462 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
12463 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
12464 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
12465 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
12466 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
12467 during subsequent delivery.
12469 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
12470 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
12471 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
12472 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
12473 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
12474 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
12475 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
12476 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
12479 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
12480 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12481 this variable has the number of arguments.
12483 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
12484 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
12485 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
12486 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers of the verb.
12487 The message can be preserved by coding like this:
12489 warn !verify = sender
12490 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
12492 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
12493 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
12495 &*Note*&: The variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
12497 .vitem &$address_data$&
12498 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12499 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
12500 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
12501 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
12502 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
12503 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
12506 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
12507 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
12508 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
12509 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
12510 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
12511 from the child's routing.
12513 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12514 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
12515 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
12518 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
12519 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
12520 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
12522 .vitem &$address_file$&
12523 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
12524 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
12525 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
12526 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
12527 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
12529 /home/r2d2/savemail
12531 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
12532 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
12533 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
12534 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
12535 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
12536 to the relevant file.
12538 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
12539 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
12540 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
12541 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
12543 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth4$&"
12544 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
12545 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
12546 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
12548 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
12549 .cindex "authentication" "id"
12550 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
12551 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
12552 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
12553 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
12554 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
12555 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
12556 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12558 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12559 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12560 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12561 command line option.
12562 This second case also sets up information used by the
12563 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12565 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12566 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12567 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12568 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12569 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12570 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12571 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12572 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12573 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12577 .tvar &$authenticated_sender$&
12578 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12579 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
12580 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12581 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12582 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12583 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12584 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12585 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12586 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12588 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12589 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12590 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12591 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12592 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12595 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12596 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12597 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12598 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12599 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12600 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12601 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12602 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12603 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&).
12604 Failure includes cancellation of a authentication attempt,
12605 and any negative response to an AUTH command,
12606 (including, for example, an attempt to use an undefined mechanism).
12608 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12609 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12610 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12611 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12612 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12613 the ACL malware condition.
12615 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12616 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12617 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12618 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12619 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12620 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12622 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12623 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12624 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12625 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12626 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12627 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12628 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12630 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12631 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12632 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12633 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12634 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12636 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12637 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12638 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12639 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12640 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12642 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12643 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12644 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12645 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12646 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12647 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12648 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12650 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12651 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12652 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12653 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12654 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12655 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12656 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12658 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12659 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12660 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12661 address that was connected to.
12663 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12664 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12665 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12666 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12667 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12669 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12670 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12671 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12672 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12673 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12674 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12676 .vitem &$config_file$&
12677 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12678 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12680 .vitem &$connection_id$&
12681 .vindex "&$connection_id$&"
12682 .cindex connection "identifier logging"
12683 An identifier for the accepted connection, for use in custom logging.
12685 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12686 Results of DKIM verification.
12687 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12689 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12690 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12691 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12692 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12693 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12695 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12696 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12697 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12698 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12699 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12700 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12701 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12702 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12703 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12704 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12705 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12706 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12707 &$dkim_key_length$&
12708 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12709 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12711 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12712 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12713 When a message has been received this variable contains
12714 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12715 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12717 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12718 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12719 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12720 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12721 Results of DMARC verification.
12722 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12724 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12725 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12726 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12728 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12729 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12730 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12731 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12732 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12733 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12734 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12735 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12736 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12739 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12740 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12741 case for &$domain$&.
12743 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12744 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12745 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12746 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12748 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12749 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12750 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12751 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12752 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12753 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12755 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12756 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12757 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12759 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12762 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12763 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12764 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12765 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12766 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12767 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12768 the &(smtp)& transport.
12771 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12772 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12773 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12774 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12777 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12778 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12779 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12780 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12781 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12782 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12785 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12786 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12787 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12788 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12791 .cindex "tainted data"
12792 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12793 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and may not
12794 be further expanded or used as a filename.
12795 When an untainted version is needed, one should be obtained from
12796 looking up the value in a local (therefore trusted) database.
12797 Often &$domain_data$& is usable in this role.
12800 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12801 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12802 When the &%domains%& condition on a router
12805 against a list, the match value is copied to &$domain_data$&.
12806 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12807 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12808 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12810 If the router routes the
12811 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12812 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12815 &$domain_data$& set in an ACL is available during
12816 the rest of the ACL statement.
12818 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12819 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12820 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12822 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12823 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12824 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12826 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12827 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12828 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12830 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12831 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12832 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12833 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12834 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12835 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12836 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12838 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12840 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12841 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12842 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12843 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12844 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12846 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12847 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12848 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12849 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12850 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12854 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12855 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12856 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12857 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12858 by a setting on the transport itself.
12860 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12861 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12862 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12866 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12867 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12868 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12869 to local and remote transports.
12871 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12872 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12873 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12874 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12875 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12876 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12877 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12880 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12881 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12882 client is connected.
12885 .vitem &$host_address$&
12886 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12887 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12888 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12889 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12891 .vitem &$host_data$&
12892 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12893 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12894 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12895 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12897 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12898 message = $host_data
12901 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12902 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12903 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12904 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12905 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12906 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12907 variables is set to &"1"&.
12910 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12911 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12914 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12915 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12916 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12919 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12920 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12921 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12922 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12923 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12924 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12925 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12926 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12927 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12928 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12930 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12931 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12932 &%authresults%& expansion item.
12935 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12936 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12937 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12939 .vitem &$host_port$&
12940 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12941 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12942 for an outbound connection.
12944 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12945 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12946 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12947 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12948 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12949 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12952 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12953 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12954 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12955 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12956 a unique name for the file.
12958 .vitem &$interface_address$& &&&
12960 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12961 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12962 These are obsolete names for &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12966 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12967 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12968 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12972 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12973 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12974 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12977 .vitem &$load_average$&
12978 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12979 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12980 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12981 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12983 .tvar &$local_part$&
12984 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12985 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12986 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12987 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12989 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12990 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12991 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12992 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12995 .cindex "tainted data"
12996 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12997 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and
12998 may not be further expanded or used as a filename.
13000 &*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
13002 Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
13004 This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
13005 For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
13006 &$local_part_data$& variable rather than this one.
13007 For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
13008 which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
13009 rather than this variable.
13010 Often &$local_part_data$& is usable in this role.
13011 If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
13012 the retrieved data.
13014 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
13015 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
13016 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
13019 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
13020 local part of the recipient address.
13022 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
13023 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
13024 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
13026 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
13029 "abc:xyz"@test.example
13030 abc\:xyz@test.example
13032 the value of &$local_part$& is
13036 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
13037 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
13040 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
13042 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
13043 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
13044 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
13046 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
13047 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
13048 When the &%local_parts%& condition on a router or ACL
13049 matches a local part list
13050 the match value is copied to &$local_part_data$&.
13051 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
13052 applied to the data read by a lookup.
13053 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
13055 The &%check_local_user%& router option also sets this variable.
13057 .vindex &$local_part_prefix$& &&&
13058 &$local_part_prefix_v$& &&&
13059 &$local_part_suffix$& &&&
13060 &$local_part_suffix_v$&
13061 .cindex affix variables
13062 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
13063 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
13064 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
13065 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
13066 .cindex "tainted data"
13067 If the specification did not include a wildcard then
13068 the affix variable value is not tainted.
13070 If the affix specification included a wildcard then the portion of
13071 the affix matched by the wildcard is in
13072 &$local_part_prefix_v$& or &$local_part_suffix_v$& as appropriate,
13073 and both the whole and varying values are tainted.
13075 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
13076 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
13077 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
13078 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
13080 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
13081 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
13082 See &$local_user_uid$&.
13084 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
13085 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
13086 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
13087 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
13088 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
13089 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
13090 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
13091 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
13093 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
13094 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13095 This contains the expanded value of the
13096 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
13099 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
13100 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13101 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
13102 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
13103 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
13104 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
13106 .vitem &$log_space$&
13107 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13108 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
13109 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
13110 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
13111 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
13112 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
13115 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
13116 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
13117 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
13118 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
13119 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13120 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
13121 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
13122 and &"yes"& if it was.
13123 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
13124 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
13125 as authenticated data.
13127 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
13128 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
13129 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
13130 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
13131 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
13132 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
13133 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
13136 .vitem &$malware_name$&
13137 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
13138 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
13139 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
13140 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
13142 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
13143 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
13144 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
13145 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
13146 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
13147 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
13149 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13151 .vitem &$message_age$&
13152 .cindex "message" "age of"
13153 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
13154 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
13155 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
13158 .tvar &$message_body$&
13159 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13160 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13161 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
13162 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
13163 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
13164 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
13165 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
13166 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
13168 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
13169 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
13170 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
13171 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
13172 zeros are always converted into spaces.
13174 .tvar &$message_body_end$&
13175 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13176 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13177 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
13178 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
13181 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
13182 .cindex "body of message" "size"
13183 .cindex "message body" "size"
13184 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
13185 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
13186 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
13187 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
13188 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13190 If the spool file is wireformat
13191 (see the &%spool_wireformat%& main option)
13192 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
13194 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
13195 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
13196 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
13197 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
13198 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
13199 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
13200 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
13201 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
13203 .tvar &$message_headers$&
13204 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
13205 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
13206 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
13207 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
13209 .tvar &$message_headers_raw$&
13210 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
13211 contents of header lines is done.
13213 .vitem &$message_id$&
13214 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
13216 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
13217 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
13218 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
13219 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
13220 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
13221 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
13222 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
13223 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
13224 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
13225 from the body is not counted.
13227 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
13228 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
13229 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
13230 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
13231 header and the body).
13233 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
13236 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
13237 message = Too many lines in message header
13239 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
13240 message has not yet been received.
13242 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13244 .vitem &$message_size$&
13245 .cindex "size" "of message"
13246 .cindex "message" "size"
13247 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
13248 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
13249 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
13250 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
13251 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
13252 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
13253 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
13254 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
13255 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13257 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
13258 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
13259 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
13260 value may not, of course, be truthful.
13262 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
13263 &$mime_anomaly_text$& &&&
13264 &$mime_boundary$& &&&
13265 &$mime_charset$& &&&
13266 &$mime_content_description$& &&&
13267 &$mime_content_disposition$& &&&
13268 &$mime_content_id$& &&&
13269 &$mime_content_size$& &&&
13270 &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$& &&&
13271 &$mime_content_type$& &&&
13272 &$mime_decoded_filename$& &&&
13273 &$mime_filename$& &&&
13274 &$mime_is_coverletter$& &&&
13275 &$mime_is_multipart$& &&&
13276 &$mime_is_rfc822$& &&&
13277 &$mime_part_count$&
13278 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
13279 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
13280 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
13282 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
13283 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
13284 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
13286 .tvar &$original_domain$&
13287 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13288 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13289 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
13290 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
13291 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
13292 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
13293 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
13294 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
13296 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13297 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13298 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13300 .tvar &$original_local_part$&
13301 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13302 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13303 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
13304 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
13305 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
13306 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
13307 the original address.
13309 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
13310 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
13311 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
13312 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
13313 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
13315 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13316 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13317 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13319 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
13320 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
13321 .cindex "sender" "gid"
13322 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
13323 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
13324 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
13325 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
13326 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
13327 normally the gid of the Exim user.
13329 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
13330 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
13331 .cindex "sender" "uid"
13332 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
13333 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
13334 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
13335 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
13336 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
13339 .tvar &$parent_domain$&
13340 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
13341 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13343 .tvar &$parent_local_part$&
13344 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
13345 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13348 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
13350 This variable contains the current process id.
13352 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
13353 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
13354 .cindex "transport" "filter"
13355 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
13356 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
13357 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
13358 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
13359 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
13360 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
13361 variable"& error if encountered.
13362 &*Note*&: This value permits data supplied by a potential attacker to
13363 be used in the command for a &(pipe)& transport.
13364 Such configurations should be carefully assessed for security vulnerbilities.
13366 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
13367 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
13368 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
13369 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
13370 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
13371 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
13372 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
13375 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
13376 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
13377 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
13378 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
13380 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
13382 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
13384 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
13385 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
13386 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
13387 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
13389 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$& &&&
13390 &$prvscheck_keynum$& &&&
13391 &$prvscheck_result$&
13392 These variables are used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13393 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13394 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13396 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
13397 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
13398 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
13400 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
13401 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
13402 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
13403 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
13405 .vitem &$queue_name$&
13406 .vindex &$queue_name$&
13407 .cindex "named queues" variable
13408 .cindex queues named
13409 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
13411 .vitem &$queue_size$&
13412 .vindex "&$queue_size$&"
13413 .cindex "queue" "size of"
13414 .cindex "spool" "number of messages"
13415 This variable contains the number of messages queued.
13416 It is evaluated on demand, but no more often than once every minute.
13417 If there is no daemon notifier socket open, the value will be
13422 .cindex router variables
13423 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
13424 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
13425 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
13426 and the eventual transport.
13428 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
13429 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
13430 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13431 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
13432 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
13434 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
13435 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
13436 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
13437 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13438 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13439 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
13441 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
13442 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
13443 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13444 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13445 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
13447 .vitem &$received_count$&
13448 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
13449 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
13450 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
13451 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
13454 .tvar &$received_for$&
13455 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
13456 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
13457 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
13458 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
13460 .vitem &$received_ip_address$& &&&
13462 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
13463 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
13464 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, these
13465 variables are set to the address and port on the local IP interface.
13466 (The remote IP address and port are in
13467 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
13468 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
13471 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
13472 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
13473 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
13474 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
13475 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
13477 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
13479 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
13480 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
13481 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
13482 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
13483 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
13484 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
13485 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
13486 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
13487 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
13489 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
13490 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
13491 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
13492 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
13493 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
13494 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
13496 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
13497 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
13498 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
13500 .vitem &$received_time$&
13501 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
13502 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
13503 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13505 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
13506 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
13507 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
13508 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
13509 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
13511 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13512 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
13514 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13515 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13516 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13517 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13519 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
13520 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
13521 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
13522 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
13525 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
13526 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
13529 &"route"&: Routing failed.
13532 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
13533 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
13537 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
13540 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
13543 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
13544 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
13546 .tvar &$recipients$&
13547 .tvar &$recipients_list$&
13548 These variables both contain the envelope recipients for a message.
13550 The first uses a comma and a space separate the addresses in the replacement text.
13551 &*Note*&: an address can legitimately contain a comma;
13552 this variable is not intended for further processing.
13554 The second is a proper Exim list; colon-separated.
13556 However, the variables
13557 are not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
13558 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use either of them only in these
13562 In a system filter file.
13564 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
13565 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
13566 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13567 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13569 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13573 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
13574 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13575 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13576 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13577 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13578 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13581 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13582 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13583 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13584 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13586 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13587 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13588 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13589 these variables contain the
13590 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13591 If the subject string was tainted then so will any captured substring.
13594 .tvar &$reply_address$&
13595 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13596 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13597 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13598 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13599 decoding or character code translation takes place.
13601 .vitem &$return_path$&
13602 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
13603 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13604 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13605 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13606 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13607 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13608 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13609 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13610 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13611 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13614 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13615 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13616 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13618 .vitem &$router_name$&
13619 .cindex "router" "name"
13620 .cindex "name" "of router"
13621 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
13622 During the running of a router, or a transport called,
13623 this variable contains the router name.
13626 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13627 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
13628 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13629 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13630 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13631 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13632 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13635 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
13636 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13637 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13638 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13639 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13640 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13641 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13642 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13644 .tvar &$sender_address$&
13645 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13646 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13647 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13648 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13650 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13651 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13652 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13653 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13654 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13655 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13656 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13657 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13659 .tvar &$sender_address_domain$&
13660 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13662 .tvar &$sender_address_local_part$&
13663 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13665 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13666 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13667 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13668 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13669 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13672 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13673 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13675 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13676 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13677 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13678 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13680 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13681 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13682 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13683 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13684 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13685 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13686 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13687 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13688 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13689 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13690 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13691 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13692 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13694 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13695 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13696 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13697 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13698 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13700 .tvar &$sender_helo_name$&
13701 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13702 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13703 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13704 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13706 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13707 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13708 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13709 this variable contains that
13710 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13712 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13713 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13714 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13715 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13716 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13717 &$authenticated_id$&.
13719 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13720 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13721 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13722 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13723 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13724 resolver library states that both
13725 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13726 other times, this variable is false.
13728 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13729 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13730 library, by setting:
13735 In addition, on Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer the resolver library will
13736 default to stripping out a successful validation status.
13737 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
13738 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
13739 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
13740 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
13745 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13746 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13748 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13749 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13751 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13752 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13753 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13754 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13757 .tvar &$sender_host_name$&
13758 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13759 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13760 other means, this variable is empty.
13762 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13763 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13764 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13765 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13766 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13767 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13768 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13770 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13771 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13772 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13773 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13775 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13776 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13777 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13780 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13781 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13782 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13783 following are true:
13786 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13788 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13789 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13790 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13792 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13793 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13794 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13796 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13797 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13798 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13800 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13801 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13802 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13803 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13805 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13807 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13808 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13812 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13813 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13814 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13815 number that was used on the remote host.
13817 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13818 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13819 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13820 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13821 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13824 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13825 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13826 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13827 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13829 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13830 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13831 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13832 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13833 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13834 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13835 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13836 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13837 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13838 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13839 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13842 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13843 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13844 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13845 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13846 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13848 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13849 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13850 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13851 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13852 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13854 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13855 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13856 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13857 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13858 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13859 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13860 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13862 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13863 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13864 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13865 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13866 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13868 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13869 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13870 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13871 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13872 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13873 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13875 .tvar &$smtp_command$&
13876 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13877 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13878 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13883 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13884 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13885 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13886 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13888 .tvar &$smtp_command_argument$&
13889 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13890 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13891 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13892 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13893 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13895 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13896 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13897 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13898 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13899 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13902 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13903 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13904 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13905 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13906 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13907 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13908 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13909 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13910 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13911 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13912 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13914 .vitem &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
13915 .vindex "&$smtp_notquit_reason$&"
13916 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, this variable is set to a string
13917 that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP connection.
13919 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13920 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13921 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13922 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13923 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13924 message is junk mail.
13926 .vitem &$spam_score$& &&&
13927 &$spam_score_int$& &&&
13929 &$spam_report$& &&&
13931 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13932 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13933 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13935 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13936 &$spf_received$& &&&
13938 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13939 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13940 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13941 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13943 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13944 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13945 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13947 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13948 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13949 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13950 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13951 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13952 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13954 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13955 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13956 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13957 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13958 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13959 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13960 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13961 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13963 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13965 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13968 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13969 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13970 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13971 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13972 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13973 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13975 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13976 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13977 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13978 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13979 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13980 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13981 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13982 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13984 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13985 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13988 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13989 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13990 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13991 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13992 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13993 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13995 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13996 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13997 .cindex certificate variables
13998 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13999 inbound connection when the message was received.
14000 It is only useful as the argument of a
14001 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14002 or a &%def%& condition.
14004 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
14005 when a list of more than one
14006 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
14007 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
14009 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
14010 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
14011 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
14012 inbound connection when the message was received.
14013 It is only useful as the argument of a
14014 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14015 or a &%def%& condition.
14016 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14017 which is not the leaf.
14019 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
14020 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
14021 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
14022 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
14023 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14024 or a &%def%& condition.
14026 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
14027 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
14028 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
14029 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
14030 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14031 or a &%def%& condition.
14032 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14033 which is not the leaf.
14035 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
14036 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
14037 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
14038 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
14040 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
14041 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14044 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
14045 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
14046 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
14047 outbound SMTP connection was made,
14048 and &"0"& otherwise.
14050 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
14051 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14052 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
14053 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14054 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
14055 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
14056 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
14057 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
14058 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
14060 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
14061 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
14062 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
14064 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
14065 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
14066 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
14068 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
14069 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
14071 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
14072 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
14073 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
14074 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
14076 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
14077 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
14078 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
14080 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
14081 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
14082 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
14084 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
14085 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
14086 When a message is received from a remote client connection
14087 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
14089 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
14090 1 No response to request
14091 2 Response not verified
14092 3 Verification failed
14093 4 Verification succeeded
14096 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
14097 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
14098 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
14099 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
14100 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
14102 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
14103 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
14104 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
14105 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
14106 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14107 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
14108 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
14109 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
14110 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14111 which is not the leaf.
14113 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
14114 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14117 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
14118 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
14119 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14120 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
14121 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
14122 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
14123 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14124 which is not the leaf.
14127 .vitem &$tls_in_resumption$& &&&
14128 &$tls_out_resumption$&
14129 .vindex &$tls_in_resumption$&
14130 .vindex &$tls_out_resumption$&
14131 .cindex TLS resumption
14132 Observability for TLS session resumption. See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
14135 .tvar &$tls_in_sni$&
14136 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
14137 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14139 .cindex SNI "observability on server"
14140 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
14141 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
14142 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
14143 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
14144 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
14145 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
14146 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
14148 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
14149 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14152 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
14153 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
14154 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14156 .cindex SNI "observability in client"
14158 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
14161 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14162 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14163 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
14165 .vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
14166 .vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
14167 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14168 this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
14170 .vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
14171 .vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
14172 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14173 this variable is set to the protocol version.
14176 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
14177 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
14178 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
14179 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
14181 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
14182 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
14183 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14185 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
14186 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
14187 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14189 .vitem &$tod_full$&
14190 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
14191 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
14192 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
14193 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
14194 values for those that are behind (west).
14197 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14198 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
14199 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
14201 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
14202 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
14203 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
14204 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
14207 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
14208 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14209 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
14212 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
14213 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
14214 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
14215 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
14217 .vitem &$transport_name$&
14218 .cindex "transport" "name"
14219 .cindex "name" "of transport"
14220 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
14221 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
14224 .vindex "&$value$&"
14225 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
14226 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
14227 &*reduce*& expansion.
14229 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
14230 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
14231 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
14232 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
14235 .vitem &$version_number$&
14236 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
14237 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
14238 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
14240 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
14241 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
14242 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14243 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14245 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
14246 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
14247 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14248 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14254 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14255 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14257 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
14258 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
14259 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
14260 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
14261 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
14262 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
14267 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
14270 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
14271 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
14272 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
14273 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
14274 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
14275 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
14276 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
14277 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
14278 a newly created Perl interpreter.
14280 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
14281 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
14282 should usually be something like
14284 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
14286 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
14287 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
14288 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
14289 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
14290 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
14291 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
14292 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
14293 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
14297 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
14298 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
14299 a startup when Exim is entered.
14301 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
14302 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
14305 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
14306 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
14309 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
14310 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
14311 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
14312 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
14313 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
14314 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
14317 &*Note*&: This is entirely separate from Exim's tainted-data tracking.
14320 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
14321 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
14322 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
14323 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
14327 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
14328 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
14330 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
14331 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
14332 with an error message of the form
14334 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
14336 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
14337 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
14338 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
14339 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
14340 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
14341 that was passed to &%die%&.
14344 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
14345 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
14346 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
14349 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
14351 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
14352 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
14353 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
14355 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
14356 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
14357 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
14358 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
14360 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
14361 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
14362 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
14363 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
14364 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
14365 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
14366 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
14369 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
14370 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
14371 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
14372 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
14373 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
14374 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
14375 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
14376 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
14377 avoided, but the output is lost.
14379 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
14380 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
14381 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
14382 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
14383 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
14384 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
14385 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
14387 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
14389 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
14390 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
14391 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
14392 as the first subroutine argument.
14396 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14397 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14399 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
14400 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
14401 "Starting the daemon"
14402 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
14403 .cindex "interface" "listening"
14404 .cindex "network interface"
14405 .cindex "interface" "network"
14406 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
14407 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
14408 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
14409 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14410 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
14411 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
14412 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
14413 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
14414 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
14415 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
14416 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
14419 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
14420 and ports to listen on.
14422 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
14423 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
14424 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
14425 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
14426 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
14427 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
14428 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
14429 as an error situation.
14431 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
14432 for the outgoing connection.
14436 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
14437 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
14438 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
14439 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
14440 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
14442 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
14443 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
14444 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
14445 chapter describes how they operate.
14447 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
14448 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
14452 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
14453 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
14454 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
14458 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
14460 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
14462 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
14463 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
14466 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
14467 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
14468 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
14469 colons. For example:
14471 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
14474 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
14476 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
14477 in &%local_interfaces%&:
14480 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
14481 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
14483 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
14484 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
14487 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
14488 with a colon separator, for example:
14490 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
14491 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
14495 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
14496 default setting contains just one port:
14498 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14500 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
14501 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
14502 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
14503 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
14504 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
14508 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
14509 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
14510 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
14511 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
14512 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
14513 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14515 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14517 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
14519 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14521 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
14525 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
14526 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
14527 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
14528 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
14529 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
14530 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
14533 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
14534 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
14535 If there are any items that do not
14536 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
14537 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
14538 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14539 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
14543 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
14546 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
14548 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
14549 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
14550 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
14554 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
14555 .cindex "submissions protocol"
14556 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
14557 .cindex "smtps protocol"
14558 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
14559 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
14560 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
14561 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
14562 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
14563 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
14564 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
14565 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
14566 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
14569 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
14570 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
14571 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
14573 The common use of this option is expected to be
14575 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
14577 per &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314).
14578 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
14579 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
14581 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
14582 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
14583 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
14584 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
14585 connections via the daemon.)
14590 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
14591 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
14592 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
14593 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14594 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14595 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14596 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14597 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14599 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14601 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14602 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14603 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14604 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14605 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14606 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14608 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14610 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14611 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14612 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14613 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14614 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14616 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14617 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14618 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14619 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14620 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14621 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14622 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14623 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14624 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14625 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14626 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14627 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14629 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14630 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14631 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14632 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14633 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14637 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14638 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14640 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14641 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14643 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14644 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14645 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14646 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14648 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14650 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14652 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14654 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14655 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14657 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14658 IPv4 loopback address only:
14660 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14662 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14664 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14666 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14670 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14671 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14672 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14673 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14676 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14677 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14678 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14679 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14681 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14682 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14683 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14684 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14685 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14686 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14687 used for listening. Consider this example:
14689 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14691 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14693 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14695 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14696 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14699 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14700 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14701 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14702 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14703 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14704 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14705 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14706 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14710 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14711 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14712 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14713 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14714 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14715 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14721 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14722 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14724 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14725 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14726 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14727 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14730 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14731 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14733 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14734 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14735 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14737 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14738 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14739 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14740 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14744 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14745 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14746 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14747 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14748 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14749 listed in more than one group.
14751 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14753 .row &%add_environment%& "environment variables"
14754 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14755 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14756 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14757 .row &%keep_environment%& "environment variables"
14758 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14759 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14760 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14761 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14762 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14763 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14764 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14765 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14769 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14771 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14772 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14773 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14774 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14775 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14776 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14781 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14783 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14784 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14785 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14786 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14787 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14788 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14789 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14790 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14791 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14792 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14793 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14794 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14799 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14801 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14802 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14803 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14804 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14805 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14806 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14807 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14808 .row &%panic_coredump%& "request coredump on fatal errors"
14809 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14810 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14811 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14812 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14813 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14814 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14815 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14816 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14821 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14823 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14824 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14825 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14826 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14831 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14833 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14834 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14835 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14836 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14837 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14838 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14839 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14840 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14841 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14842 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14843 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14844 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14845 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14846 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14847 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14852 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14854 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14855 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14860 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14862 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14863 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14864 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14869 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14871 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14872 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14873 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14874 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14875 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14876 .row &%notifier_socket%& "override compiled-in value"
14877 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14878 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14879 .row &%smtp_backlog_monitor%& "level to log listen backlog"
14884 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14886 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14887 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14888 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14889 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14890 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14891 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14892 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14893 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14894 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14895 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14896 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14897 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14898 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14899 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14900 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14901 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14903 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14904 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14905 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14906 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14907 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14912 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14914 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14915 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14916 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14917 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14918 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14919 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14920 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14921 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14922 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14923 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14924 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14925 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14926 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14927 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14928 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14929 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14930 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14931 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14932 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14933 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14934 .row &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& "ACL for WELLKNOWN"
14935 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14936 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14938 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14939 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14940 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14941 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14942 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14943 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14944 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14945 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14946 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14947 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14948 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14949 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14950 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14951 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14952 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14953 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14954 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14955 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14956 .row &%proxy_protocol_timeout%& "timeout for proxy protocol negotiation"
14957 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14958 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14959 .row &%spf_smtp_comment_template%& "template for &$spf_smtp_comment$&"
14964 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14966 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14968 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14970 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14971 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14972 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14977 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14979 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14980 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14981 .row &%hosts_require_alpn%& "mandatory ALPN"
14982 .row &%hosts_require_helo%& "mandatory HELO/EHLO"
14983 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14984 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14985 .row &%tls_alpn%& "acceptable protocol names"
14986 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14987 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14988 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14989 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14990 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14991 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14992 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14993 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14994 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14995 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14996 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14997 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14998 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
15003 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
15005 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
15006 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
15007 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
15008 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
15009 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
15010 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
15011 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
15012 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
15017 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
15019 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
15020 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
15021 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
15022 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
15023 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
15024 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
15025 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
15026 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
15032 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
15034 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
15041 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
15042 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
15045 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
15046 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
15047 .row &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%& "DKIM key sizes accepted for signatures"
15048 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
15049 .row &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& "DMARC sender for report messages"
15050 .row &%dmarc_history_file%& "DMARC results log"
15051 .row &%dmarc_tld_file%& "DMARC toplevel domains file"
15052 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
15053 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
15054 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
15055 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
15056 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
15057 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
15058 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
15059 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
15060 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
15061 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
15062 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
15063 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
15064 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
15065 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
15067 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
15068 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
15069 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
15070 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
15071 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
15072 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
15073 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
15074 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
15075 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
15076 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
15077 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
15078 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
15079 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
15080 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
15081 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
15082 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
15087 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
15089 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
15090 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
15091 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
15092 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
15093 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
15094 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
15095 .row &%limits_advertise_hosts%& "advertise LIMITS to these hosts"
15096 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
15097 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
15098 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
15099 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
15100 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
15101 .row &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%& "advertise WELLKNOWN to these hosts"
15106 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
15108 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
15109 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
15110 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
15111 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
15113 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15114 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15115 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
15116 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
15117 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
15118 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
15119 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15120 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
15121 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
15122 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
15127 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
15129 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
15130 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
15132 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
15133 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
15134 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
15135 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
15136 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
15141 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
15143 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
15144 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
15145 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
15146 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
15147 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
15148 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
15149 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
15150 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
15151 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
15152 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
15153 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
15154 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
15155 .row &%queue_fast_ramp%& "parallel delivery with 2-phase queue run"
15156 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
15157 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
15158 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
15159 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
15160 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
15161 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
15162 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
15163 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
15164 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
15165 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
15166 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
15167 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
15172 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
15174 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
15175 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
15176 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
15177 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
15178 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
15179 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
15180 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
15181 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
15182 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
15183 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
15184 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
15185 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
15186 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
15187 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
15188 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
15193 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
15194 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
15197 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
15199 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15200 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15201 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
15202 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" 8BITMIME
15203 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
15204 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
15205 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
15206 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
15208 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
15209 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
15210 It now defaults to true.
15211 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
15213 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
15216 To log received 8BITMIME status use
15218 log_selector = +8bitmime
15221 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
15222 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
15223 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15224 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
15225 read and is on the point of being accepted. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for
15228 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15229 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
15230 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
15233 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
15234 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
15235 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15236 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
15237 non-SMTP message. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for further details.
15239 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
15240 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
15241 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
15242 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
15244 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs, and chapter
15245 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15247 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
15248 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
15249 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
15250 See section &<<SECconnectACL>>& for further details.
15252 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
15253 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
15254 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
15255 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
15256 acknowledgment is sent. See section &<<SECdataACLS>>& for further details.
15258 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
15259 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
15260 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
15261 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
15262 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
15263 This option defines the ACL that,
15264 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
15265 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
15266 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
15267 acknowledgment is sent. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>& for further details.
15269 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
15270 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
15271 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
15272 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
15273 of a received message.
15274 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
15276 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
15277 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
15278 .cindex "ETRN" advertisement
15279 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
15281 If no value is set then the ETRN facility is not advertised.
15282 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15284 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
15285 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
15286 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
15287 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15289 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
15290 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
15291 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
15292 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
15293 command is received. See section &<<SECheloACL>>& for further details.
15296 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
15297 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
15298 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
15299 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15301 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
15302 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
15303 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
15305 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs, and chapter
15306 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15308 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15309 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
15310 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
15311 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
15312 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
15314 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
15315 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
15316 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
15317 ends without a QUIT command being received.
15318 See section &<<SECTNOTQUITACL>>& for further details.
15320 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
15321 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
15322 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
15325 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
15326 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
15327 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
15328 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15330 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
15331 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
15332 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
15333 received. See section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& for further details.
15335 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
15336 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
15337 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
15338 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15340 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
15341 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
15342 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
15343 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15345 .option acl_smtp_wellknown main string&!! unset
15346 .cindex "WELLKNOWN, ACL for"
15347 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP WELLKNOWN command is
15348 received. See section &<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>& for further details.
15350 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
15351 .cindex "environment" "set values"
15352 This option adds individual environment variables that the
15353 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
15354 Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
15356 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
15358 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15359 .cindex "admin user"
15360 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
15361 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
15362 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
15363 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
15364 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
15365 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
15366 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
15368 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
15369 .cindex "domain literal"
15370 If this option is set, the
15371 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
15372 domain literal format is permitted in
15373 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
15374 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
15375 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
15377 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
15378 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
15379 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
15380 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
15381 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
15382 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
15383 the local host's IP addresses.
15385 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
15386 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
15387 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
15388 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
15389 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
15390 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
15391 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
15392 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
15393 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
15395 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
15396 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
15397 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
15398 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
15399 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
15400 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
15401 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
15403 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
15404 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
15405 letters, digits, and hyphens.
15407 If Exim is built with internationalization support
15408 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
15409 this option can be left as default.
15411 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
15412 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
15413 suitable setting is:
15415 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
15416 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
15418 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
15420 dns_check_names_pattern =
15422 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
15425 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15426 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
15427 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
15428 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
15429 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
15430 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
15431 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
15432 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
15433 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
15434 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
15435 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
15436 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
15438 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
15439 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
15440 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
15441 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
15442 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
15443 which Exim advertises AUTH.
15445 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
15446 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
15447 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
15448 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
15450 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
15452 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
15453 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
15454 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
15455 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
15458 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
15459 .cindex "thawing messages"
15460 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
15461 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
15462 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
15463 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
15464 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
15465 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
15467 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
15468 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
15469 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
15472 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
15473 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
15474 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
15476 sophie:/var/run/sophie
15478 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
15479 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
15482 .option bi_command main string unset
15484 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
15485 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
15486 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
15487 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
15490 .option bounce_message_file main string&!! unset
15491 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
15492 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
15493 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15494 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
15495 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
15496 .cindex bounce_message_file "tainted data"
15497 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
15498 absolute and untainted.
15499 See also &%warn_message_file%&.
15502 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
15503 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
15504 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
15505 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
15507 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
15508 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
15509 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
15510 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
15511 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
15512 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
15513 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
15514 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
15515 point at which the error was detected are returned.
15516 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
15518 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
15519 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
15520 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
15521 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
15522 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
15523 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
15524 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
15525 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
15526 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
15527 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
15529 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
15530 during reception of a message.
15531 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
15533 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
15536 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
15537 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
15538 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
15539 &%bounce_return_body%&.
15542 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
15543 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
15544 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
15545 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
15546 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
15547 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
15548 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
15549 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
15550 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
15552 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
15553 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
15554 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
15555 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
15556 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
15559 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
15560 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
15561 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
15562 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
15563 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
15564 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
15565 connection. A typical setting might be:
15567 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15569 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
15571 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15573 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
15576 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
15577 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
15578 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
15579 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
15580 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15581 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15584 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
15585 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
15586 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15587 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15590 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
15591 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
15592 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15593 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15596 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
15597 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
15598 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15599 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15602 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
15603 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
15604 callout verification. The default value is
15606 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
15608 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
15611 .options check_log_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15612 check_log_space main integer 10M
15613 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15615 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
15616 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
15617 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
15618 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047)
15619 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
15620 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
15621 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
15622 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
15623 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
15624 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
15625 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
15628 .options check_spool_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15629 check_spool_space main integer 10M
15630 .cindex "checking disk space"
15631 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15632 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15633 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15634 message is accepted.
15636 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15637 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
15638 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15639 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15640 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15641 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15642 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15643 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15646 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15647 either value is greater than zero, for example:
15649 check_spool_space = 100M
15650 check_spool_inodes = 100
15652 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15653 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15656 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15657 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15658 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15660 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15661 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15662 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15663 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15664 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15665 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15667 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15668 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15669 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15671 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15672 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15673 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15675 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15676 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15677 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15678 may wish to deliberately disable them.
15680 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15681 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15682 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15683 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" CHUNKING
15684 The CHUNKING extension
15685 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3030.html,RFC 3030))
15686 will be advertised in the EHLO message to these hosts.
15687 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15689 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15690 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15691 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15692 administrative user.
15693 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15695 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15696 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15697 .cindex memory debugging
15698 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15699 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15700 it should normally be left as default.
15702 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15703 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
15704 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15705 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15706 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15707 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15709 .options daemon_startup_retries main integer 9 &&&
15710 daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15711 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15712 These options control the retrying done by
15713 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15714 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15715 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15716 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15718 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15719 .cindex "warning of delay"
15720 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15721 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15722 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15723 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15724 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15725 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15726 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15727 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15730 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15732 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15733 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15734 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15735 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15739 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15740 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15742 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15744 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15745 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15746 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15748 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15749 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15750 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15751 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15752 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15753 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15754 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15755 not sent. The default is:
15757 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15758 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15759 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15760 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15763 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15764 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15765 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15766 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15768 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15769 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15770 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15771 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15772 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15773 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15774 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15775 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15777 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15778 .cindex "load average"
15779 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15780 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15781 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15782 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15783 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15786 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15787 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15788 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15789 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15790 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15791 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15792 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15793 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15795 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15796 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15797 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15798 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15799 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15800 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15801 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15802 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15804 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15805 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15806 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15807 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15810 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15811 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15812 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15813 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15814 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15815 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15816 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15819 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15820 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15821 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15822 and an order of processing.
15823 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15825 Acceptable values include:
15832 Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates
15833 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301).
15835 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15836 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15837 and an order of processing.
15838 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15841 .option dkim_verify_min_keysizes main "string list" "rsa=1024 ed25519=250"
15842 This option gives a list of key sizes which are acceptable in signatures.
15843 The list is keyed by the algorithm type for the key; the values are in bits.
15844 Signatures with keys smaller than given by this option will fail verification.
15846 The default enforces the
15847 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301)
15848 minimum key size for RSA signatures.
15850 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15851 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15854 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15855 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15856 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15857 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15858 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15859 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15862 .options dmarc_forensic_sender main string&!! unset &&&
15863 dmarc_history_file main string unset &&&
15864 dmarc_tld_file main string unset
15865 .cindex DMARC "main section options"
15866 These options control DMARC processing.
15867 See section &<<SECDMARC>>& for details.
15870 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15871 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15872 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15873 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15874 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15875 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15876 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15877 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15878 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15879 by a setting such as this:
15881 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15883 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does,
15884 except for TLSA lookups (where knowing about such failures
15885 is security-relevant).
15886 It also applies when the
15887 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15888 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15889 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15890 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15891 options are applied after this global option.
15893 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15894 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15895 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15896 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15897 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15898 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15899 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15900 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15901 value of this option. The default pattern is
15903 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15904 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15906 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15907 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15908 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15909 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15910 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15913 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15914 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15915 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15917 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15918 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15919 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15920 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15922 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15923 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15924 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15925 not do it internally.
15926 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15927 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15929 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15930 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15931 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15934 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15935 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15936 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15937 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15938 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15939 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15941 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15943 On Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer this is insufficient, the resolver library
15944 will default to stripping out a successful validation status.
15945 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
15946 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
15947 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
15948 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
15954 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15955 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15956 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15957 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15958 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15959 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15960 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15961 domain matches this list.
15963 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15964 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15965 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15966 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15967 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15968 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15971 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15972 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15973 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15974 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15975 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15976 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15977 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15978 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15979 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15980 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15981 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15982 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15984 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15987 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15988 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15991 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15992 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15993 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15994 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15995 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15996 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15997 match with this expanded domain list.
15999 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
16000 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
16001 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
16002 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
16003 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
16004 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
16006 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
16007 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
16008 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
16010 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
16011 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
16012 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
16013 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
16014 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
16016 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16017 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
16018 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16019 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
16020 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
16021 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
16022 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
16023 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
16026 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
16028 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
16029 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
16030 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
16033 .option drop_cr main boolean false
16034 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
16035 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
16036 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
16038 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16039 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
16040 .cindex "DSN" "success"
16041 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
16042 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" DSN
16043 DSN extensions (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461))
16044 will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
16045 and accepted from, these hosts.
16046 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ORCPT options on RCPT TO commands,
16047 and RET and ENVID options on MAIL FROM commands.
16048 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
16049 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
16051 &*Note*&: Supplying success-DSN messages has been criticised
16052 on privacy grounds; it can leak details of internal forwarding.
16054 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
16055 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
16056 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
16057 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
16058 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
16059 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
16061 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
16063 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
16064 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
16066 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
16067 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
16068 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
16069 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
16070 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
16071 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
16072 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
16073 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
16074 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
16077 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
16078 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
16079 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
16080 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
16081 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
16082 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
16083 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
16084 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
16085 must be enclosed in double quotes.
16087 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
16088 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
16089 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
16090 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
16091 are examined. For example:
16093 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
16094 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
16095 postmaster@mydomain.example
16097 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16098 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16099 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
16100 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
16101 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
16102 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
16103 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
16106 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
16107 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
16108 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
16110 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
16112 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
16113 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
16114 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
16115 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
16116 overrides the default.
16118 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
16119 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
16120 and warning messages. For example:
16122 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
16124 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid
16125 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
16126 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
16127 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
16128 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
16132 .option event_action main string&!! unset
16134 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
16135 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
16138 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
16139 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
16140 .cindex "Exim group"
16141 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16142 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
16143 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
16144 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
16145 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
16149 .option exim_path main string "see below"
16150 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
16151 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
16152 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
16153 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
16154 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
16156 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
16157 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
16158 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
16159 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
16162 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
16163 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
16164 .cindex "Exim user"
16165 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16166 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
16167 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
16168 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
16170 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
16171 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
16172 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
16173 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
16176 .option exim_version main string "current version"
16177 .cindex "Exim version"
16178 .cindex customizing "version number"
16179 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
16180 This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
16181 various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
16184 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
16185 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
16186 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
16187 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
16190 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16191 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16193 . .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments"
16194 . but apparently this results in searchability problems; bug 1197
16196 .option extract_addresses_remove_arguments main boolean true
16198 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
16199 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
16200 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
16201 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
16202 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
16203 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
16204 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
16205 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
16206 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
16207 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
16211 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
16212 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
16213 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
16214 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
16215 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
16216 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
16217 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
16218 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
16221 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
16222 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
16223 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
16224 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
16228 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
16229 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16230 .cindex "frozen messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16231 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
16232 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
16233 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
16234 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
16235 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
16236 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
16237 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
16238 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
16239 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
16240 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
16241 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
16242 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
16243 logging that you require.
16246 .options gecos_name main string&!! unset &&&
16247 gecos_pattern main string unset
16249 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
16250 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
16251 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
16252 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
16253 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
16254 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
16255 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
16256 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
16258 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
16259 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
16260 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
16263 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
16264 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
16265 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
16266 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
16268 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
16273 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
16274 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
16275 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
16276 implementations of TLS.
16279 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
16280 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
16281 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
16284 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
16289 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
16290 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
16291 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
16292 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
16293 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
16294 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
16298 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
16299 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
16300 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
16301 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
16302 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
16303 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
16304 sections are rejected.
16307 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
16308 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
16309 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
16310 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
16311 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
16312 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
16313 zero means &"no limit"&.
16318 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16319 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
16320 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
16321 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
16322 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
16323 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
16324 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
16325 if you want to do semantic checking.
16326 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
16330 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
16331 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
16332 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
16333 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
16334 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
16335 non-ip-literal EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
16336 hyphens, and dots. For example if you really must allow underscores,
16339 helo_allow_chars = _
16341 This option does not apply to names that look like ip-literals.
16342 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
16345 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
16346 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16347 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16348 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
16349 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
16350 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
16351 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
16355 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16356 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
16357 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
16358 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
16359 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
16360 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
16361 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
16362 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
16363 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
16364 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
16365 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
16366 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
16368 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
16369 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
16370 EHLO command either:
16373 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
16375 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
16376 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
16377 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
16378 calling host address, or
16380 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
16383 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
16384 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
16385 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
16387 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
16388 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16389 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
16391 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16392 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
16393 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
16394 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
16395 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
16396 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
16397 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
16398 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
16399 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
16402 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16403 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
16404 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
16405 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
16406 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
16407 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
16408 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
16409 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
16410 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
16412 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
16413 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
16414 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
16415 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
16416 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
16418 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
16419 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
16420 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
16421 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
16424 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
16425 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
16426 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
16427 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
16428 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
16429 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
16430 default configuration file contains
16434 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
16435 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
16437 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
16438 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
16439 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
16441 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
16442 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
16443 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
16444 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
16445 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
16446 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
16449 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
16450 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
16451 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
16452 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
16453 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
16456 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
16457 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
16458 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
16459 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
16463 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
16464 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
16465 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
16466 as soon as the connection is made.
16467 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
16468 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
16469 connections immediately.
16471 If the connection is on a TLS-on-connect port then the TCP connection is
16472 just dropped. Otherwise, an SMTP error is sent first.
16474 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
16475 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
16476 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
16477 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
16478 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
16481 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
16482 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
16483 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
16484 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
16485 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
16486 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
16487 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
16488 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
16489 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
16491 hosts_connection_nolog = :
16493 The hosts affected by this option also do not log "no MAIL in SMTP connection"
16494 lines, as may commonly be produced by a monitoring system.
16497 .option hosts_require_alpn main "host list&!!" unset
16498 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in server"
16500 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
16501 If the TLS library supports ALPN
16502 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any client
16503 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
16504 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
16506 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
16507 managed by this option, and should be done separately.
16510 .option hosts_require_helo main "host list&!!" *
16511 .cindex "HELO/EHLO" requiring
16512 Exim will require an accepted HELO or EHLO command from a host matching
16513 this list, before accepting a MAIL command.
16516 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
16517 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
16518 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
16519 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
16522 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
16523 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
16524 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
16525 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
16526 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
16528 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
16529 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
16531 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
16532 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
16533 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
16534 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
16535 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
16536 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
16537 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
16540 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
16541 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
16542 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
16543 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16544 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
16548 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
16549 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
16550 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
16551 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
16552 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
16553 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
16555 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
16556 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
16557 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
16558 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
16559 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
16560 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
16561 for frozen messages. For example,
16563 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
16565 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
16566 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
16567 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
16568 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
16569 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
16570 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
16573 .options ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
16574 ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
16575 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16576 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16577 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
16578 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
16579 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
16580 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
16581 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
16582 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
16583 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
16587 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
16588 .cindex "environment" "values from"
16589 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
16590 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
16591 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
16592 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
16593 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
16594 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
16595 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
16597 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
16598 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
16600 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
16601 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
16602 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
16603 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
16605 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
16606 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
16607 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
16610 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
16611 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
16612 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
16616 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
16617 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
16618 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
16619 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
16623 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
16624 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
16625 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
16626 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
16627 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16628 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16629 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16630 and constrained to be a directory.
16633 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
16634 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
16635 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16636 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
16637 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16638 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16639 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16640 and constrained to be a file.
16643 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
16644 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
16645 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16646 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
16647 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16648 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
16651 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
16652 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
16653 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
16654 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
16655 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16656 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
16657 identity to be proven.
16660 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
16661 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
16662 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
16663 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
16664 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
16667 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
16668 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
16669 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
16670 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
16671 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
16675 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
16676 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
16677 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
16678 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
16679 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
16680 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
16684 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16685 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16686 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16687 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16688 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16690 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16691 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16692 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16695 .option ldap_version main integer unset
16696 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16697 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16698 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16699 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16700 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16701 has been built with LDAP support.
16705 .option limits_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16706 .cindex LIMITS "suppressing advertising"
16707 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
16708 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16709 LIMITS extension (&url(https://www.ietf.org/rfc/rfc9422.html,RFC 9422))
16711 If permitted, Exim as a server will advertise in the EHLO response
16712 the limit for RCPT commands set by the &%recipients_max%& option (if it is set)
16713 and the limit for MAIL commands set by the &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%&
16716 .option local_from_check main boolean true
16717 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16718 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16719 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16720 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16721 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16722 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16724 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16725 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16726 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16728 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16729 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16730 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16731 and the default qualify domain.
16733 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16734 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16735 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16736 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16738 .cindex "envelope from"
16739 .cindex "envelope sender"
16740 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16741 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16742 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16744 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16745 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16746 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16751 .options local_from_prefix main string unset &&&
16752 local_from_suffix main string unset
16753 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16754 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16755 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16756 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16757 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16758 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16761 local_from_prefix = *-
16763 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16765 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16767 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16768 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16772 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16773 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16774 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16775 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16776 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16777 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16778 &%local_interfaces%& is
16780 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16782 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16784 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16787 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16788 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16789 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16790 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16791 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16792 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16793 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16794 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16798 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16799 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16800 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16801 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16802 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16803 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16804 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16805 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16810 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16811 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16812 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16813 .cindex multiple "systems sharing a spool"
16814 .cindex "multiple hosts" "sharing a spool"
16815 .cindex "shared spool directory"
16816 .cindex "spool directory" sharing
16817 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16818 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16819 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required
16820 (eg. because they share a spool directory),
16821 each host must set a different
16822 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16823 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16824 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16825 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16826 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16827 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number%& is set, the final four
16828 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16829 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16830 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16834 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16835 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16836 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16837 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16838 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16839 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16840 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16841 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16842 A path must start with a slash.
16843 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16844 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16845 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16846 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16847 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16848 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16849 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16850 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16853 .option log_selector main string unset
16854 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16855 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16856 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16857 minus characters. For example:
16859 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16861 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16862 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16865 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16866 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16867 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16868 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16869 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16870 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16871 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16872 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16873 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16874 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16875 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16876 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16877 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16880 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16881 .cindex "too many open files"
16882 .cindex "open files, too many"
16883 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16884 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16885 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16886 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16887 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16888 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16889 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16890 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16891 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16892 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16893 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16894 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16897 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16898 .cindex "length of login name"
16899 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16900 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16901 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16902 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16903 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16904 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16907 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16908 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16909 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16910 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16911 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16912 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16913 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16914 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16917 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16918 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16919 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16920 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16921 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16922 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16923 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16926 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16927 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16928 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16929 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16930 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16931 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16932 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16933 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16934 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16935 empty string, the option is ignored.
16938 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16939 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16940 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16941 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by
16942 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
16943 to take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16944 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16945 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16946 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16947 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16948 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16949 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16950 colons will become hyphens.
16953 .option message_logs main boolean true
16954 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16955 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16956 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16957 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16958 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16959 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16960 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16961 which is not affected by this option.
16964 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16965 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16966 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16967 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16968 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16969 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16970 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16971 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16972 optionally followed by K or M.
16974 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
16975 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
16976 If nonzero the value will be advertised as a parameter to the ESMTP SIZE
16977 service extension keyword.
16979 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16980 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16981 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16982 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16983 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16985 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16986 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16987 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16988 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16989 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16990 message that an individual transport can process.
16992 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16993 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16994 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16995 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16996 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16997 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16998 some problems may result.
17000 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
17001 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
17002 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
17005 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
17006 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
17007 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
17009 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
17011 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
17012 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
17013 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
17014 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
17015 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
17018 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
17019 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
17020 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
17021 contains a full description of this facility.
17025 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
17026 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
17027 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
17028 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
17029 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
17032 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
17033 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
17034 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
17035 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
17036 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
17039 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
17040 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
17041 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
17042 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
17043 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
17045 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
17046 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
17049 never_users = root:daemon:bin
17051 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
17052 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
17056 .option notifier_socket main string "$spool_directory/exim_daemon_notify"
17057 This option gives the name for a unix-domain socket on which the daemon
17058 listens for work and information-requests.
17059 Only installations running multiple daemons sharing a spool directory
17060 should need to modify the default.
17062 The option is expanded before use.
17063 If the platform supports Linux-style abstract socket names, the result
17064 is used with a nul byte prefixed.
17066 it should be a full path name and use a directory accessible
17069 If this option is set as empty,
17070 or the command line &%-oY%& option is used, or
17071 the command line uses a &%-oX%& option and does not use &%-oP%&,
17072 then a notifier socket is not created.
17075 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
17076 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
17077 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
17078 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
17079 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
17081 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
17082 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
17083 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
17084 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
17085 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
17086 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
17087 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
17089 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
17090 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
17091 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
17092 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
17093 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
17095 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
17097 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
17098 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
17099 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
17100 some now infamous attacks.
17104 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
17105 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
17106 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
17108 # Disable older protocol versions:
17109 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
17112 Possible options may include:
17116 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
17118 &`cipher_server_preference`&
17120 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
17124 &`legacy_server_connect`&
17126 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
17128 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
17130 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
17132 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
17134 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
17138 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
17152 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
17156 &`single_ecdh_use`&
17158 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
17160 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
17162 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
17166 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
17169 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
17170 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
17171 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
17172 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
17173 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
17174 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
17177 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
17178 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
17179 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
17180 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
17181 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
17184 .option panic_coredump main boolean false
17185 This option is rarely needed but can help for some debugging investigations.
17186 If set, when an internal error is detected by Exim which is sufficient
17187 to terminate the process
17188 (all such are logged in the paniclog)
17189 then a coredump is requested.
17191 Note that most systems require additional administrative configuration
17192 to permit write a core file for a setuid program, which is Exim's
17193 common installed configuration.
17195 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17196 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
17197 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
17198 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
17199 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
17200 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
17201 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
17203 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
17204 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
17205 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
17206 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
17209 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
17210 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
17211 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
17212 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
17213 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
17214 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
17215 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
17218 .options perl_at_start main boolean false &&&
17219 perl_startup main string unset
17221 These options are available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
17222 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of their use.
17224 .option perl_taintmode main boolean false
17226 This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
17229 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
17230 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
17231 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
17232 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
17233 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
17234 PostgreSQL support.
17237 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
17238 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
17239 .cindex "pid file, path for"
17240 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
17241 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
17244 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
17246 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
17248 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
17249 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
17250 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
17253 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17254 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
17255 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
17256 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
17257 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
17258 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
17259 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
17260 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
17261 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
17262 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
17264 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17265 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
17266 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
17267 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPECONNECT
17268 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
17269 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
17270 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
17271 commands are acceptable.
17272 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
17274 See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
17276 The SMTP service extension keyword advertised is &"PIPECONNECT"&;
17277 it permits the client to pipeline
17278 TCP connection and hello command (cleatext phase),
17279 or TLS-establishment and hello command (encrypted phase),
17280 on later connections to the same host.
17283 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
17284 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
17285 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
17286 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
17287 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
17288 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
17289 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
17290 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
17291 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
17293 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
17294 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
17295 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
17296 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
17297 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
17298 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
17299 volume of mail. Use with care!
17302 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
17303 .cindex "name" "of local host"
17304 .cindex "host" "name of local"
17305 .cindex "local host" "name of"
17306 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17307 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
17308 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
17309 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
17310 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
17311 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
17313 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
17314 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
17315 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
17316 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
17317 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
17318 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
17321 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
17322 .cindex "printing characters"
17323 .cindex "8-bit characters"
17324 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
17325 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
17326 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
17327 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
17328 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
17331 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
17332 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses
17333 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047) encoding of
17334 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
17335 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
17336 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
17340 .option process_log_path main string unset
17341 .cindex "process log path"
17342 .cindex "log" "process log"
17343 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
17344 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
17345 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
17346 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
17347 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
17348 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
17349 different spool directories.
17352 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
17353 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17357 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
17358 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
17359 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17362 .option proxy_protocol_timeout main time 3s
17363 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
17364 This option sets the timeout for proxy protocol negotiation.
17365 For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
17368 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
17369 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
17370 .cindex "address" "qualification"
17371 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
17372 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
17373 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
17374 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
17375 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
17376 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
17378 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
17379 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
17380 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
17381 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
17382 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
17383 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
17384 &%primary_hostname%& value.
17387 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
17388 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
17389 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
17393 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17394 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
17395 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17396 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
17397 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
17398 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
17399 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
17400 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
17403 .option queue_fast_ramp main boolean true
17404 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
17405 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
17406 If set to true, two-phase queue runs, initiated using &%-qq%& on the
17407 command line, may start parallel delivery processes during their first
17408 phase. This will be done when a threshold number of messages have been
17409 routed for a single host.
17412 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
17413 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17415 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
17416 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
17417 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
17418 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17421 .option queue_only main boolean false
17422 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17423 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
17424 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
17425 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
17426 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
17427 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
17429 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
17430 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
17431 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
17432 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
17435 .option queue_only_file main "string list" unset
17436 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17437 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
17438 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
17439 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
17440 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
17441 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
17442 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
17443 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
17445 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
17447 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
17448 &_/some/file_& exists.
17451 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
17452 .cindex "load average"
17453 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17454 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
17455 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
17456 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
17457 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
17458 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
17459 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17462 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
17463 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
17464 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
17465 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17468 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
17469 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
17470 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
17471 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
17472 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
17473 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
17474 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
17475 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
17476 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
17477 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17478 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
17479 re-evaluated for each message.
17482 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
17483 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17484 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
17485 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
17486 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
17487 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
17490 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
17491 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
17492 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
17493 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
17494 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
17495 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
17496 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
17497 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
17498 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
17499 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
17500 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
17501 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
17502 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
17506 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
17507 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
17508 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
17509 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
17510 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
17511 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
17512 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
17513 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
17514 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
17516 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
17517 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
17518 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
17519 the daemon's command line.
17521 .cindex queues named
17522 .cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
17523 To set limits for different named queues use
17524 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
17526 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17527 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17528 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
17529 .cindex "first pass routing"
17530 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
17531 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
17532 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
17533 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
17534 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
17535 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
17536 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
17537 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
17538 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
17539 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
17543 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
17544 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
17545 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
17546 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
17547 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
17548 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
17549 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
17551 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
17552 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
17553 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
17554 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
17555 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
17556 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
17557 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
17558 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
17559 &"Received:"& and conform to the
17560 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
17561 specification for &'Received:'& header lines.
17562 The default setting is:
17565 received_header_text = Received: \
17566 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
17567 {${if def:sender_ident \
17568 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
17569 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
17570 by $primary_hostname \
17571 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
17572 ${if def:tls_in_ver { ($tls_in_ver)}}\
17573 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
17574 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
17575 ${if def:sender_address \
17576 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
17577 id $message_exim_id\
17578 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
17581 The references to the TLS version and cipher are
17582 omitted when Exim is built without TLS
17583 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
17584 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
17585 header lines such as the following:
17587 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
17588 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
17589 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
17590 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
17591 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
17592 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
17593 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
17595 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
17596 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
17597 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
17598 message was accepted.
17601 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
17602 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
17603 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
17604 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
17605 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
17606 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
17607 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
17608 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
17611 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17612 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17613 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17614 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17615 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
17616 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
17617 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
17618 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
17619 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
17620 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
17621 option was not set.
17624 .option recipients_max main integer&!! 50000
17625 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
17626 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
17627 If the value resulting from expanding this option
17628 is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
17629 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
17630 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
17631 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
17632 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
17635 For SMTP message the expansion is done after the connection is
17636 accepted (but before any SMTP conversation) and may depend on
17637 the IP addresses and port numbers of the connection.
17638 &*Note*&: If an expansion is used for the option,
17639 care should be taken that a resonable value results for
17642 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
17643 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
17644 RCPT commands in a single message.
17647 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
17648 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
17649 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
17650 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
17651 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
17652 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
17653 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
17656 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 4
17657 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
17658 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
17659 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
17660 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
17661 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
17662 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
17663 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
17664 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
17665 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
17666 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
17667 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
17668 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
17669 tagged with its process id.
17671 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
17672 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
17673 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
17674 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
17677 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option,
17678 and the &%serialize_hosts%& smtp transport option.
17680 .cindex "number of deliveries"
17681 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
17682 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
17683 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
17684 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
17685 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
17686 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
17687 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
17688 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
17689 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
17690 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
17692 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
17693 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
17694 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
17695 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
17698 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17699 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
17700 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
17701 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
17702 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
17704 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
17706 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
17707 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
17710 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
17711 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
17712 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
17713 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
17714 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
17718 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
17719 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
17720 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
17721 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
17722 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
17723 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
17724 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
17728 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
17729 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
17730 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821), section 4.4,
17731 states that an SMTP server must insert a
17732 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
17733 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
17734 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
17735 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
17736 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
17737 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
17738 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
17741 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
17742 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17745 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
17747 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
17748 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1413,RFC 1413)
17749 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
17750 an item in the list.
17751 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
17754 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
17755 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
17756 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
17757 This sets the timeout on
17758 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1413,RFC 1413)
17759 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
17760 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
17763 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17764 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17765 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17766 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17767 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
17768 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
17769 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
17770 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17771 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17772 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17775 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17776 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17777 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17778 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17779 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17780 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17781 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17785 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17786 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17787 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17788 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17789 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17790 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17791 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17792 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17793 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17794 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17795 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17799 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17800 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17801 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17803 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17804 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17805 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17806 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17807 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17808 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17810 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17811 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17812 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17813 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17816 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17817 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17818 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17819 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17820 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17821 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17822 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17823 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17825 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17826 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17827 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17828 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17829 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17830 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17831 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17832 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17835 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17836 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17837 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17838 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17842 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17843 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17844 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17845 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17846 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17847 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17848 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17849 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17850 . the option name to split.
17852 .option smtp_accept_max_per_connection main integer&!! 1000
17853 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17854 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17855 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17856 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17857 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17858 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17859 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17861 The option is expanded after the HELO or EHLO is received
17862 and may depend on values available at that time.
17863 An empty or zero value after expansion removes the limit.
17866 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17867 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17868 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17869 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17870 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17871 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17872 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17873 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17874 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17875 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17876 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17878 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17879 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17880 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17881 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17882 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17883 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17887 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17888 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17889 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17890 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17891 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17892 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17893 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17894 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17895 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17896 to all messages received in the same connection.
17898 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17899 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17900 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17901 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17904 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17906 .option smtp_accept_queue_per_connection main integer 10
17907 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17908 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17909 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17910 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17911 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17912 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17913 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17914 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17915 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17916 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17917 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17920 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17921 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17922 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17923 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17924 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17925 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17926 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17927 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17928 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17929 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17930 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17933 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17934 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17935 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17936 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17939 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17940 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17941 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17942 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17943 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17944 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17945 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17946 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17947 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17949 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17950 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17951 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17952 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17954 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17955 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17956 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17957 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17958 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17961 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17962 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17965 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17966 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17967 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17968 &%helo_data%& value.
17970 .option smtp_backlog_monitor main integer 0
17971 .cindex "connection backlog" monitoring
17972 If this option is set to greater than zero, and the backlog of available
17973 TCP connections on a socket listening for SMTP is larger than it, a line
17974 is logged giving the value and the socket address and port.
17975 The value is retrived jsut before an accept call.
17976 This facility is only available on Linux.
17978 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17979 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17980 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17981 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17982 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17983 If a connect ACL does not supply a message,
17984 this string (which is expanded every time it is used) is output as the initial
17985 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17987 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17988 $version_number $tod_full
17990 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error;
17991 a forced fail just closes the connection.
17992 If you want to create a
17993 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17994 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17995 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17996 multiline response).
17999 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
18000 .cindex "checking disk space"
18001 .cindex "disk space, checking"
18002 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
18003 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
18004 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
18005 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
18006 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
18007 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
18010 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
18011 .cindex "connection backlog" "set maximum"
18012 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
18013 .cindex "backlog of connections"
18014 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
18015 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
18016 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
18017 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
18018 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
18019 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
18020 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
18021 attacks by SYN flooding.
18024 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
18025 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
18026 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
18027 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
18028 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
18029 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
18030 fewer, but they still exist.
18032 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
18033 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
18034 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
18035 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
18036 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
18037 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
18038 does detect many instances.
18040 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
18041 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
18042 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
18043 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
18047 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
18048 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
18049 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
18050 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18051 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
18052 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
18053 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
18054 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
18055 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
18058 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
18059 $sender_host_address
18061 If the option is not set, the argument for the ETRN command must
18062 be a &'#'& followed by an address string.
18063 In this case an &'exim -R <string>'& command is used;
18064 if the ETRN ACL has set up a named-queue then &'-MCG <queue>'& is appended.
18066 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
18067 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
18068 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
18069 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
18070 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
18074 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
18075 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
18076 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
18077 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
18078 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
18081 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
18082 .cindex "load average"
18083 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
18084 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
18085 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
18086 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
18087 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
18088 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
18092 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
18093 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
18094 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
18095 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
18096 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
18098 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
18100 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
18101 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
18102 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
18103 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
18104 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
18106 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
18107 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
18108 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
18109 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
18110 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
18111 not count towards the limit.
18115 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
18116 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
18117 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
18118 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
18119 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
18122 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
18123 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
18127 .options smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
18128 smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset &&&
18129 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
18130 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
18131 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
18132 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
18133 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
18134 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
18137 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
18138 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
18139 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
18140 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
18142 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
18143 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
18144 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
18145 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
18149 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
18151 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
18152 fractional parts are allowed here.
18154 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
18156 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
18157 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
18160 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
18161 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
18163 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
18164 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
18166 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
18167 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
18168 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
18169 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
18173 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
18174 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
18175 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
18176 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
18177 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
18178 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
18179 the message is abandoned.
18180 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
18182 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
18183 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
18185 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
18186 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
18188 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
18189 expanded before use and may depend on
18190 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
18194 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
18195 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
18196 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
18197 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
18198 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
18201 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18202 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
18203 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
18206 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
18207 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
18208 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
18209 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
18210 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
18211 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
18212 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
18213 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
18214 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
18215 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
18217 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
18218 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
18222 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18223 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
18224 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
18225 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
18226 the availability thereof is advertised in
18227 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18228 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
18231 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
18232 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
18233 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
18234 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
18238 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
18239 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
18240 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
18242 .option spf_smtp_comment_template main string&!! "Please%_see%_http://www.open-spf.org/Why"
18243 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support. It
18244 allows the customisation of the SMTP comment that the SPF library
18245 generates. You are strongly encouraged to link to your own explanative
18246 site. The template must not contain spaces. If you need spaces in the
18247 output, use the proper placeholder. If libspf2 can not parse the
18248 template, it uses a built-in default broken link. The following placeholders
18249 (along with Exim variables (but see below)) are allowed in the template:
18253 &*%{L}*&: Envelope sender's local part.
18255 &*%{S}*&: Envelope sender.
18257 &*%{O}*&: Envelope sender's domain.
18259 &*%{D}*&: Current(?) domain.
18261 &*%{I}*&: SMTP client Ip.
18263 &*%{C}*&: SMTP client pretty IP.
18265 &*%{T}*&: Epoch time (UTC).
18267 &*%{P}*&: SMTP client domain name.
18269 &*%{V}*&: IP version.
18271 &*%{H}*&: EHLO/HELO domain.
18273 &*%{R}*&: Receiving domain.
18275 The capitalized placeholders do proper URL encoding, if you use them
18276 lowercased, no encoding takes place. This list was compiled from the
18279 A note on using Exim variables: As
18280 currently the SPF library is initialized before the SMTP EHLO phase,
18281 the variables useful for expansion are quite limited.
18284 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
18285 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
18286 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
18287 .cindex "directories, multiple"
18288 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
18289 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
18290 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
18291 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
18292 arrival of the message.
18294 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
18295 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
18296 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
18297 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
18298 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
18300 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
18301 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
18302 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
18303 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
18304 automatically deleted.
18306 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
18307 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
18308 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
18309 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
18310 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
18311 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
18312 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
18313 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
18314 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
18317 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
18318 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
18319 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
18320 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
18321 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
18322 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
18323 &$primary_hostname$&.
18325 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
18326 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
18327 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
18328 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
18329 as failures in the configuration file.
18331 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
18332 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
18334 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
18335 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
18336 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
18337 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
18338 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
18339 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
18342 The following variables will not have useful values:
18344 $max_received_linelength
18349 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
18350 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
18351 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
18352 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
18354 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
18355 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
18356 The transmission benefit is maintained.
18358 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
18359 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
18360 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
18361 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
18363 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
18364 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
18365 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
18366 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
18367 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
18368 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
18370 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
18371 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
18372 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
18373 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
18374 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
18375 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
18376 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
18379 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
18380 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
18381 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
18382 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
18383 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
18384 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
18385 domain causes a syntax error.
18386 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
18390 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
18391 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
18392 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
18393 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
18394 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
18395 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
18396 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
18397 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
18398 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
18399 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
18400 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
18401 the LOG_ALERT priority.
18404 .option syslog_facility main string unset
18405 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
18406 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18407 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
18408 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
18409 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18410 details of Exim's logging.
18413 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
18414 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
18415 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
18416 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
18417 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
18418 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
18419 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18423 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
18424 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
18425 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18426 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
18427 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18431 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
18432 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
18433 .cindex timestamps syslog
18434 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
18435 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18436 details of Exim's logging.
18439 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
18440 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
18441 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
18442 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
18443 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
18444 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
18445 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
18446 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
18447 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
18448 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
18449 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
18450 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
18453 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
18454 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18455 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
18456 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
18457 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
18458 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18461 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
18462 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
18463 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
18464 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
18465 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18467 .option system_filter_group main string unset
18468 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
18469 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
18470 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
18471 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
18473 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
18474 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
18475 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18476 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
18477 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
18478 contains the pipe command.
18481 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
18482 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
18483 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
18484 is used in a system filter.
18487 .option system_filter_user main string unset
18488 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
18489 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
18490 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
18491 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
18492 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
18493 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
18494 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
18495 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
18496 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
18498 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
18499 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
18500 transport option overrides.
18503 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
18504 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
18505 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
18506 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
18507 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
18508 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
18509 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
18510 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
18511 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
18512 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
18513 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
18514 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
18518 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
18519 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
18520 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
18521 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
18522 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
18523 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
18524 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
18525 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
18526 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
18527 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
18529 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
18530 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
18531 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
18534 .option timezone main string unset
18535 .cindex "timezone, setting"
18536 .cindex "environment" "values from"
18537 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
18538 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
18539 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
18540 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
18544 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
18545 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
18546 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
18547 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
18548 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
18549 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
18552 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18553 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
18554 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
18555 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
18556 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
18557 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
18558 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
18559 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18560 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
18561 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
18562 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
18563 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
18566 .option tls_alpn main "string list&!!" "smtp : esmtp"
18567 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
18569 .cindex ALPN "set acceptable names for server"
18570 If this option is set,
18571 the TLS library supports ALPN,
18572 and the client offers either more than one
18573 ALPN name or a name which does not match the list,
18574 the TLS connection is declined.
18577 .option tls_certificate main "string list&!!" unset
18578 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
18579 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
18580 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18581 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
18582 Commonly only one file is needed.
18583 The server's private key is also
18584 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
18585 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18587 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
18588 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
18589 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
18590 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
18592 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
18593 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
18595 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
18596 when a list of more than one
18597 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
18598 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
18600 .cindex SNI "selecting server certificate based on"
18601 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
18602 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
18603 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
18604 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
18606 If this option is unset or empty a self-signed certificate will be
18608 Under Linux this is generated at daemon startup; on other platforms it will be
18609 generated fresh for every connection.
18611 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
18612 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
18613 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
18614 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
18615 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
18617 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
18619 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
18620 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
18621 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
18623 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18626 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
18627 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
18628 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
18629 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
18630 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
18631 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
18633 The value must be at least 1024.
18635 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
18636 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
18637 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
18639 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
18642 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
18643 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
18644 larger prime than requested.
18647 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
18648 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
18649 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
18650 to be used by Exim.
18652 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
18653 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
18654 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
18655 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
18657 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
18658 then it names a file from which DH
18659 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
18660 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
18661 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
18662 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
18663 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
18664 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
18666 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
18669 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
18670 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
18671 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
18672 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
18674 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
18675 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
18677 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
18678 2.2 of &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5114,RFC 5114),
18679 "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
18680 in IKE is assigned number 23.
18682 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
18683 of DH primes specified in
18684 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2409,RFC 2409),
18685 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3526,RFC 3526),
18686 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5114,RFC 5114),
18687 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7919,RFC 7919), or from other
18688 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
18689 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
18690 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18692 The available standard primes are:
18693 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
18694 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
18695 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
18696 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
18698 The available additional primes are:
18699 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18701 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
18702 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
18703 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
18704 of the later IKE values, which led into
18705 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7919,RFC 7919)
18706 providing new fixed constants (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
18708 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
18709 they are still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
18710 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
18711 Two of them in particular (&`ike1`& and &`ike22`&) are called out by
18712 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8247,RFC 8247)
18713 as MUST NOT use for IPSEC, and two more (&`ike23`& and &`ike24`&) as
18715 Because of this, Exim regards them as deprecated; if either of the first pair
18716 are used, warnings will be logged in the paniclog, and if any are used then
18717 warnings will be logged in the mainlog.
18718 All four will be removed in a future Exim release.
18720 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
18721 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
18722 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
18723 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
18724 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
18727 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
18728 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
18729 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
18730 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
18731 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
18732 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
18733 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
18736 .option tls_eccurve main string list&!! &`auto`&
18737 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
18738 This option selects EC curves for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
18739 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS
18740 (the equivalent can be done using a priority string for the
18741 &%tls_require_ciphers%& option).
18743 After expansion it must contain
18744 one or (only for OpenSSL versiona 1.1.1 onwards) more
18745 EC curve names, such as &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-521`&.
18746 Consult your OpenSSL manual for valid curve names.
18748 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
18749 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
18750 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
18752 If the option expands to an empty string, the effect is undefined.
18755 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
18756 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
18757 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
18759 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
18760 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
18761 Certificate Authority.
18763 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
18764 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
18766 For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
18767 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
18768 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
18769 The ordering of the two lists must match.
18770 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
18772 The file(s) should be in DER format,
18773 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
18775 when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
18776 The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
18777 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
18778 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
18779 If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
18780 (this only works under TLS1.3)
18781 they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
18783 Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
18784 PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
18785 TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
18786 although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
18788 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
18791 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
18792 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
18793 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
18794 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
18798 .option tls_privatekey main "string list&!!" unset
18799 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
18800 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18801 files which contains the server's private keys.
18802 If this option is unset, or if
18803 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
18804 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
18805 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18807 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18810 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
18811 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
18812 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
18813 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
18814 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
18815 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
18819 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
18820 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
18821 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
18822 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
18823 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
18824 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
18825 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
18826 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
18827 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
18828 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
18829 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
18832 .option tls_resumption_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18833 .cindex TLS resumption
18834 This option controls which connections to offer the TLS resumption feature.
18835 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
18838 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18839 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18840 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18841 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
18844 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
18845 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18846 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18847 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
18849 or the absolute path to
18850 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
18851 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
18853 The "system" value for the option will use a
18854 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
18855 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
18856 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
18859 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18860 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
18862 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
18864 either by file or directory
18865 are added to those given by the system default location.
18867 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
18868 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
18869 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
18870 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
18871 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
18872 use the explicit directory version. (If your peer is Exim up to 4.85,
18873 using GnuTLS, you may need to send the CAs (thus using the file
18874 variant). Otherwise the peer doesn't send its certificate.)
18876 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18878 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
18882 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18883 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18884 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18885 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
18886 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
18887 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
18888 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
18889 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
18891 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
18892 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
18893 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
18895 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
18896 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
18897 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
18898 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
18900 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
18901 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
18902 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
18903 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18904 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18905 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18906 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18909 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18913 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18914 .cindex "trusted groups"
18915 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
18916 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18917 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18918 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18919 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18920 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18921 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18924 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18925 .cindex "trusted users"
18926 .cindex "user" "trusted"
18927 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18928 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18929 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18930 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18931 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18932 Exim user are trusted.
18934 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18935 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18936 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18937 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18938 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18939 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18940 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18941 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18942 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18945 .option unknown_username main string unset
18946 See &%unknown_login%&.
18948 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18949 .cindex "trusted users"
18950 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18951 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18952 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18953 .cindex "envelope from"
18954 .cindex "envelope sender"
18955 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18956 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18957 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18958 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18959 is used) is ignored.
18961 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18962 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18964 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18966 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18967 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18968 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18969 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18970 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18971 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18972 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18973 followed by a hyphen
18974 by a setting like this:
18976 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18978 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18979 restriction, you can use
18981 untrusted_set_sender = *
18983 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18984 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18985 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18986 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18987 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18988 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18989 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18990 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18992 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18993 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18994 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18995 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18999 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
19000 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19001 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
19002 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
19003 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
19004 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
19005 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
19006 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
19007 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
19008 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
19010 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
19011 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
19013 The pattern can be seen by running
19015 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
19017 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
19018 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
19019 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
19020 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
19021 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
19022 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
19025 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
19026 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
19029 .option warn_message_file main string&!! unset
19030 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
19031 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
19032 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
19033 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
19034 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
19035 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
19036 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
19037 .cindex warn_message_file "tainted data"
19038 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
19039 absolute and untainted.
19040 See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
19043 .option wellknown_advertise_hosts main boolean unset
19044 .cindex WELLKNOWN advertisement
19045 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" WELLKNOWN
19046 This option enables the advertising of the SMTP WELLKNOWN extension.
19047 See also the &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& ACL (&<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>&).
19049 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
19050 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
19051 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
19052 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
19053 .ecindex IIDconfima
19054 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
19059 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19060 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19062 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
19063 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
19064 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
19065 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
19066 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
19068 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
19069 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
19070 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
19071 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
19072 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
19074 The name of a router is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
19075 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
19079 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
19080 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
19081 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
19082 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
19083 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
19084 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
19085 delivery of the address to be deferred.
19087 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19088 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
19089 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
19090 routers, and the eventual transport.
19092 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
19093 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
19094 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
19095 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
19096 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
19098 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
19099 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
19100 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
19101 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
19102 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
19104 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
19105 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
19106 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
19108 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
19110 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
19112 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
19114 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
19115 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
19117 See also the &%set%& option below.
19119 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
19120 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19121 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
19122 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
19123 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
19124 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
19125 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
19129 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
19131 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
19132 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
19133 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
19134 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
19135 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
19140 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
19141 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
19142 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
19143 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
19144 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
19145 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
19146 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
19147 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
19148 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
19149 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
19152 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
19154 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
19157 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
19159 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
19160 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
19161 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
19162 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
19165 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
19166 .cindex "case of local parts"
19167 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
19168 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
19169 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
19170 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
19171 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
19172 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
19173 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
19176 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19177 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
19178 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
19179 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
19180 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
19181 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
19182 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
19183 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
19184 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
19186 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
19187 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
19188 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
19189 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
19193 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
19194 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
19195 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
19196 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
19198 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
19199 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
19200 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
19201 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
19202 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
19204 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
19205 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router check_local_user option"
19206 &$local_part_data$& is set to an untainted version of the local part and
19207 &$home$& is set from the password data. The latter can be tested in other
19208 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
19209 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
19210 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
19211 the router is skipped.
19213 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
19214 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
19215 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
19216 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
19217 setting to achieve this. For example:
19219 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
19221 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
19222 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
19223 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
19227 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
19228 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
19229 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
19230 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
19231 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
19232 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
19233 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
19234 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
19236 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
19237 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
19239 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
19240 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
19242 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
19243 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
19244 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
19246 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19248 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
19250 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
19253 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
19255 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19256 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
19260 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
19261 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
19262 be specified using &%condition%&.
19264 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
19265 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
19266 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
19267 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19268 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19269 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
19270 Router rules processing behavior.
19272 This is best illustrated in an example:
19274 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
19275 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
19277 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19280 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19283 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
19284 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
19285 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
19286 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
19287 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
19288 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
19289 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
19290 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
19292 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
19293 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
19294 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
19295 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
19298 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
19299 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
19300 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
19301 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
19302 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
19305 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
19306 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19307 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19308 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
19309 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
19310 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19311 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19312 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19313 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
19314 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
19315 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
19316 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
19317 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
19318 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
19322 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
19323 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
19324 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
19325 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
19326 transport option of the same name.
19328 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
19329 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19330 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19331 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19332 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19333 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
19334 the DNSSEC request bit set.
19335 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19337 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
19338 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19339 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19340 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19341 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19342 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
19343 the DNSSEC request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
19344 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
19345 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19348 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
19349 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
19350 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
19351 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
19353 The data returned by the list check
19354 is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
19355 expansions of the driver's private options and in the transport.
19356 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
19357 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
19359 A complex example, using a file like:
19365 and checking both domain and local_part
19367 domains = ${domain:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19368 local_parts = ${local_part:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19373 .option driver routers string unset
19374 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
19378 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
19379 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19380 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19381 If this option is set true, and extended DSN
19382 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461)) processing is in effect,
19383 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
19384 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
19385 Not effective on redirect routers.
19389 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
19390 .cindex "envelope from"
19391 .cindex "envelope sender"
19392 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
19393 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
19394 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
19395 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
19396 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
19397 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
19398 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
19400 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
19401 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
19402 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
19405 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
19406 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
19407 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
19408 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
19410 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
19411 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
19412 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
19413 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
19419 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
19420 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
19421 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
19422 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
19423 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
19425 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19426 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
19427 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
19428 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
19429 setting &%return_path%&.
19431 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
19432 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
19433 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
19437 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
19438 .cindex "address" "testing"
19439 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
19440 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
19441 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
19442 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
19443 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
19444 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
19445 on for the system alias file.
19446 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19449 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
19450 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
19451 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
19455 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
19456 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
19457 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
19458 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19462 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
19463 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19464 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
19468 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
19469 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19470 verifying a sender, verification fails.
19474 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
19475 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
19476 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
19477 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
19478 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
19479 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
19480 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
19481 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
19482 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
19484 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
19485 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
19486 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
19487 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
19488 transport for further details.
19491 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
19492 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
19493 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19494 .cindex "transport" "local"
19495 .cindex "router" "setting group"
19496 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19497 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
19499 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19500 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19501 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
19502 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
19503 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19507 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
19508 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
19509 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
19510 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19511 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19512 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19513 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
19514 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
19515 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
19516 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
19517 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
19518 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
19519 &"see"& the added header lines.
19521 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
19522 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
19523 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
19524 failures are treated as configuration errors.
19526 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19527 for a router; all listed headers are added.
19529 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19530 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19532 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19533 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
19534 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19535 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
19536 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
19537 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
19538 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
19539 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
19540 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
19541 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19545 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
19546 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19547 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
19548 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19549 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19550 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19551 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
19552 Each list item is separately expanded, at transport time.
19553 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
19555 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
19556 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
19557 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
19558 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
19559 &"see"& the original header lines.
19561 The &%headers_remove%& option is handled after &%errors_to%& and
19562 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
19563 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
19566 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19567 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
19569 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19570 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19572 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19573 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
19574 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
19575 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
19577 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
19578 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
19579 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19583 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
19584 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
19585 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
19586 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
19587 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
19588 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
19589 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
19592 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
19596 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
19598 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
19599 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
19600 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
19601 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
19602 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
19603 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
19605 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
19606 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
19608 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
19609 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
19611 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
19612 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
19614 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
19615 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19616 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
19617 domain that is being routed.
19619 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19620 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
19623 .option initgroups routers boolean false
19624 .cindex "additional groups"
19625 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19626 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19627 .cindex "transport" "local"
19628 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
19629 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
19630 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
19631 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
19632 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19636 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
19637 .cindex affix "router precondition"
19638 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
19639 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
19640 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
19641 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
19642 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
19645 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
19646 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
19647 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
19648 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
19649 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
19650 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
19651 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
19652 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
19653 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
19655 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19656 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
19657 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
19658 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
19659 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
19660 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
19661 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
19662 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
19663 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
19664 the relevant transport.
19666 .vindex &$local_part_prefix_v$&
19667 If wildcarding (above) was used then the part of the prefix matching the
19668 wildcard is available in &$local_part_prefix_v$&.
19670 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
19671 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
19672 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
19675 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
19676 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
19677 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
19678 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
19679 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
19683 local_part_prefix = real-
19685 transport = local_delivery
19687 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19688 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19690 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19691 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19694 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
19695 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
19696 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
19697 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
19700 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
19701 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
19705 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
19706 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
19707 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
19708 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
19709 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
19710 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
19711 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
19712 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
19713 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
19717 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
19718 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
19722 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
19723 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
19724 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
19725 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
19726 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19728 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
19729 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
19732 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain_data
19734 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
19735 the data returned by the list check
19736 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
19737 expansions of the router's private options or in the transport.
19738 You might use this option, for
19739 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
19740 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
19741 each virtual domain:
19745 local_parts = postmaster
19746 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
19750 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
19751 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
19752 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
19753 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
19754 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
19755 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
19756 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
19757 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
19758 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
19759 redirect addresses.
19763 .option more routers boolean&!! true
19764 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19765 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19766 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19767 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
19768 delivery to be deferred.
19770 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
19771 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
19773 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
19774 means of the setting
19778 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
19779 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
19780 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
19782 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
19783 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
19784 controls what happens next.
19787 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
19788 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
19789 .cindex "router" "timeout"
19790 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
19791 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
19792 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
19793 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
19794 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
19796 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
19797 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
19798 applies to all of them.
19802 .option pass_router routers string unset
19803 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
19804 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
19805 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
19806 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
19807 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
19808 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
19809 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
19810 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
19811 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
19812 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
19816 .option redirect_router routers string unset
19817 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
19818 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
19819 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
19820 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
19821 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
19823 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
19824 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
19825 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
19826 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
19830 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
19831 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
19832 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
19833 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
19834 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
19835 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
19836 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
19838 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
19839 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
19840 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19841 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
19842 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
19844 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
19845 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
19846 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
19847 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
19848 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
19851 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
19852 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
19855 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
19856 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
19857 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
19858 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
19859 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
19860 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
19861 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
19862 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
19864 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
19865 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
19866 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
19867 operates as follows:
19869 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
19870 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
19871 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
19872 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
19875 require_files = mail:/some/file
19876 require_files = $local_part_data:$home/.procmailrc
19878 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
19879 &%require_files%& condition fails.
19881 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
19882 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
19883 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
19884 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
19886 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
19887 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
19888 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
19889 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
19890 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
19892 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
19893 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
19894 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
19895 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
19896 check again in that process.
19898 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
19899 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
19900 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
19901 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
19902 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
19903 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
19904 as if the file did not exist. For example:
19906 require_files = +/some/file
19908 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
19909 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
19910 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
19914 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
19915 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19916 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
19917 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
19918 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
19919 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
19920 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
19921 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
19924 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
19925 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
19926 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
19927 &%check_local_user%&,
19930 &%local_part_prefix%&,
19931 &%local_part_suffix%&,
19934 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
19935 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
19938 Failing to set this option when it is needed
19939 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
19940 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
19942 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19943 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19944 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19948 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19949 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
19950 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
19952 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19953 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19954 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19955 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19956 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19957 cause the router to defer.
19959 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19960 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19962 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19964 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19965 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19967 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19968 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19969 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19970 of these values that is set:
19973 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19975 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19977 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19979 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19982 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19983 router, but not for the transport.
19987 .option self routers string freeze
19988 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19989 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19990 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19991 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19992 and &(manualroute)& routers.
19993 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19995 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19996 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19997 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19998 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19999 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
20001 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
20002 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
20003 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
20004 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
20005 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
20010 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
20012 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
20013 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
20014 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
20015 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
20017 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
20018 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
20019 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
20024 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
20025 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
20026 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
20027 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
20028 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
20029 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
20035 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
20036 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
20037 be passed to the next router.
20040 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
20043 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
20044 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
20045 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
20046 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
20047 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
20048 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
20053 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
20054 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
20055 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
20056 address matches something on the list.
20057 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20060 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
20061 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
20062 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
20063 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
20064 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
20065 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
20066 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
20070 .option set routers "string list" unset
20071 .cindex router variables
20072 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
20073 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
20074 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
20077 Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
20078 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
20079 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
20080 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
20081 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
20083 This is done immediately after all the preconditions, before the
20084 evaluation of the &%address_data%& option.
20085 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
20086 The variables can be used by the router options
20087 (not including any preconditions)
20088 and by the transport.
20089 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
20090 Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
20092 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
20093 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
20096 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
20097 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
20098 .cindex "packet radio"
20099 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
20100 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
20101 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
20102 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
20103 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
20104 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
20105 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
20106 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20108 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20109 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
20110 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
20111 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
20112 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
20113 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
20114 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
20115 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
20116 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
20117 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
20119 translate_ip_address = \
20120 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
20123 The file would contain lines like
20125 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
20126 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
20128 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
20133 .option transport routers string&!! unset
20134 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
20135 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
20136 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
20137 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
20138 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
20139 delivery is deferred.
20141 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
20142 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
20143 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
20147 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
20148 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20149 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
20150 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
20151 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
20152 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
20153 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
20154 overridden by a setting on the transport.
20155 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20156 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20157 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
20163 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
20164 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20165 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
20166 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
20167 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
20168 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
20169 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
20170 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
20171 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20172 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20174 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
20175 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
20176 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
20177 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
20178 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
20180 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
20186 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
20187 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
20188 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
20189 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
20190 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
20191 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
20192 delivery to be deferred.
20194 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
20195 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
20196 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
20197 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
20198 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
20199 sometimes true and sometimes false).
20201 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
20202 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
20203 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
20204 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
20205 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
20206 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
20207 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
20208 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
20210 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
20211 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
20212 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
20213 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
20214 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
20215 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
20216 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
20217 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
20218 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
20219 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
20221 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
20222 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
20223 subsequent routers.
20226 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
20227 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20228 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20229 .cindex "transport" "local"
20230 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
20231 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
20232 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
20233 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
20234 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
20235 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
20236 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
20237 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
20238 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
20239 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
20240 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
20241 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
20245 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
20246 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
20247 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
20250 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
20251 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
20253 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
20254 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
20255 delivering in cutthrough mode or
20256 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
20257 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
20258 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
20259 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
20261 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
20262 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
20263 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
20267 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
20268 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
20270 delivering in cutthrough mode
20271 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
20272 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20274 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20277 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
20278 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
20279 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
20280 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20282 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20283 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
20284 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
20291 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20292 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20294 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
20295 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
20296 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
20297 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
20298 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
20299 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
20300 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
20301 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
20302 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
20306 domains = mydomain.example
20308 transport = local_delivery
20310 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
20311 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
20312 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
20313 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
20320 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20321 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20323 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
20324 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
20325 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
20326 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
20327 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
20328 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
20330 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
20331 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
20332 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
20333 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
20336 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
20337 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
20338 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
20339 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
20340 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
20341 generic option, the router declines.
20343 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
20344 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
20345 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
20347 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
20348 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
20349 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
20350 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
20351 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
20352 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
20355 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
20356 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
20357 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
20358 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
20359 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
20360 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
20362 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
20363 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
20364 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
20365 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
20366 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
20367 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
20368 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
20369 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
20370 case routing fails.
20373 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
20374 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
20375 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
20376 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
20377 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
20379 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
20380 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
20382 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
20384 The domain does not exist in DNS
20386 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
20387 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
20388 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
20390 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
20392 MX record points to a non-existent host.
20394 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
20395 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
20397 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
20398 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
20400 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
20401 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
20403 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
20404 not be found in the MX records (see below)
20410 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
20411 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
20412 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
20414 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
20415 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
20416 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
20417 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
20418 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
20419 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
20420 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
20423 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
20424 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
20425 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records
20426 (see &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2782,RFC 2782))
20427 in addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
20428 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
20429 required. For example,
20433 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
20434 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
20435 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
20436 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
20437 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
20440 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
20441 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
20442 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
20443 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
20444 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
20445 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
20447 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
20448 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
20449 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
20450 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
20451 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
20452 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
20453 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
20454 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
20456 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
20457 when there is a DNS lookup error.
20462 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20463 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
20464 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
20465 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
20466 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
20467 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
20468 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
20469 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
20473 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
20474 .cindex IPv6 disabling
20475 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
20476 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20477 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20478 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20479 only A records are used.
20481 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
20482 .cindex IPv4 preference
20483 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
20484 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20485 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20486 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20487 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
20489 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20490 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
20491 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
20492 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
20493 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
20494 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
20495 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
20498 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
20500 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
20501 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
20502 the address record.
20505 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20506 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20507 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
20508 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20513 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
20514 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20515 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
20516 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
20517 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
20518 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
20519 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
20520 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
20521 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
20526 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
20527 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
20528 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
20529 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
20530 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
20531 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
20532 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
20533 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
20534 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
20535 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
20536 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
20538 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
20539 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
20542 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
20543 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
20544 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
20545 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
20546 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
20550 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
20551 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20552 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
20553 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
20554 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20555 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20556 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20557 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20559 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20560 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
20561 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20562 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
20563 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
20564 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
20565 without processing them independently,
20566 provided the following conditions are met:
20569 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
20570 &%headers_remove%&.
20572 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
20579 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
20580 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20581 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
20582 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
20583 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
20584 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
20585 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
20586 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
20587 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
20588 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
20590 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
20591 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
20596 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20597 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20598 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
20599 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20604 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
20605 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
20606 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
20607 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
20610 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
20612 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
20613 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
20614 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
20615 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
20616 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
20617 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
20620 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
20621 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
20622 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
20623 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
20624 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
20626 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
20627 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
20628 such as that implied by
20632 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
20633 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
20634 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
20635 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
20645 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20646 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20648 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
20649 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
20650 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
20651 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
20652 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
20653 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
20654 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
20655 takes the form of an
20656 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
20657 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
20658 router handles the address
20662 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
20663 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
20664 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
20666 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
20668 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
20669 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
20671 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
20672 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
20673 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
20674 &%self%& option determines what happens.
20676 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
20677 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
20678 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
20679 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
20683 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20686 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
20687 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
20688 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
20689 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
20690 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
20691 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
20694 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
20696 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
20698 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
20699 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
20700 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
20701 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
20702 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
20703 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
20704 must not be specified for it.
20706 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
20707 .option hosts iplookup string unset
20708 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
20709 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
20710 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
20711 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
20712 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
20715 .option optional iplookup boolean false
20716 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
20717 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
20718 delivery to the address is deferred.
20721 .option port iplookup integer 0
20722 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
20723 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
20727 .option protocol iplookup string udp
20728 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
20729 protocols is to be used.
20732 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
20733 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
20736 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
20738 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
20739 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
20742 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
20743 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
20744 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
20745 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
20746 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
20747 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
20748 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
20749 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
20752 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
20753 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
20754 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
20755 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
20756 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
20757 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
20758 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
20759 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
20760 following could be used:
20762 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
20763 reroute = $local_part@$1
20766 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
20767 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
20768 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
20769 call. It does not apply to UDP.
20774 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20775 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20777 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
20778 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
20779 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
20780 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
20781 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
20782 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
20783 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
20784 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
20785 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
20786 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
20788 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
20789 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
20790 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
20791 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
20792 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
20793 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
20794 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
20797 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
20798 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
20799 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
20800 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
20801 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
20802 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
20803 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
20806 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
20807 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
20808 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
20809 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
20810 below, following the list of private options.
20813 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
20815 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
20816 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
20818 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
20819 See &%host_find_failed%&.
20821 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
20822 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
20823 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
20824 of the following values:
20833 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
20834 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
20835 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
20838 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
20839 router only if &%more%& is true.
20841 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
20842 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
20843 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
20844 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
20846 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
20847 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
20848 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
20851 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
20852 .cindex "randomized host list"
20853 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
20854 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
20855 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
20856 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
20857 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
20858 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
20859 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
20860 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
20862 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
20863 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
20864 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
20865 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
20867 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
20869 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
20870 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
20871 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
20872 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
20873 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
20876 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
20877 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
20878 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
20881 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
20883 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
20884 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
20888 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
20889 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
20890 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
20891 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
20894 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
20895 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20896 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
20897 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
20898 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20899 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20900 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20901 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20903 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20904 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
20905 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20906 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
20907 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
20908 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
20909 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
20910 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
20915 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
20916 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
20917 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
20918 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
20919 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
20920 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
20922 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
20924 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
20928 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
20929 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20931 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
20932 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
20933 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
20934 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
20935 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
20936 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
20937 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
20938 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
20939 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
20940 in a &%route_list%&).
20942 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
20943 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
20944 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
20945 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
20949 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20950 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20951 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20952 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20953 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20954 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20955 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20958 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20959 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20961 This data can be accessed by setting
20963 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20965 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20966 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20967 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20968 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20969 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20974 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20975 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20976 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20977 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20978 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20979 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20980 The format of each item
20981 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20982 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20984 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20985 variables are set during its expansion:
20988 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20989 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20990 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20992 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20995 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20997 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
21000 .vindex "&$value$&"
21001 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
21002 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
21004 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
21008 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
21009 semicolon is the default route list separator.
21013 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
21014 Each item in the list of hosts can be either a host name or an IP address,
21015 optionally with an attached port number, or it can be a single "+"
21016 (see &%hosts_randomize%&).
21017 When no port is given, an IP address
21018 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
21019 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
21020 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
21023 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
21024 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
21025 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
21027 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
21028 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
21031 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
21032 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
21033 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
21034 number follows. For example:
21036 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
21040 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
21041 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
21042 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
21043 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
21044 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
21047 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
21048 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
21049 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
21050 records in the DNS. For example:
21052 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
21054 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
21057 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
21059 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
21060 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
21061 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
21062 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
21063 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
21064 happens is controlled by the
21065 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
21066 &%self%& option of the router.
21068 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
21069 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
21070 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
21071 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
21072 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
21073 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
21074 defined by MX preferences.
21076 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
21077 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
21078 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
21080 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
21081 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
21082 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
21083 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
21085 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
21086 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
21089 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
21090 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
21091 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
21093 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
21094 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
21098 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
21099 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
21100 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
21101 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
21102 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
21103 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
21104 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
21107 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
21108 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
21110 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
21111 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
21113 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
21114 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
21115 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
21117 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
21118 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
21119 timeout), delivery is deferred.
21121 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
21123 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
21128 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
21129 domain2 host4:host5
21131 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
21132 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
21133 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
21134 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
21137 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
21138 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
21139 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
21140 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
21143 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
21144 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
21149 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
21150 &%host_find_failed%& option.
21153 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
21154 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
21158 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
21159 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
21160 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
21163 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
21164 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
21165 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
21166 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
21168 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
21170 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
21171 your first router something like this:
21174 driver = manualroute
21175 domains = !+local_domains
21176 transport = remote_smtp
21177 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
21179 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
21180 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
21181 they are tried in order
21182 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
21183 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
21186 driver = manualroute
21187 transport = remote_smtp
21188 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
21190 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
21191 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
21192 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
21193 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
21194 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
21195 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
21196 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
21197 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
21200 .cindex "mail hub example"
21201 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
21202 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
21203 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
21204 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
21205 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
21206 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
21207 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
21208 lookup is easier to manage.
21210 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
21211 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
21215 driver = manualroute
21216 transport = remote_smtp
21217 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
21219 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
21220 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
21221 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
21222 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
21223 domain can be used to find the host:
21226 driver = manualroute
21227 transport = remote_smtp
21228 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
21230 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
21231 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
21232 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
21236 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
21237 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
21238 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
21239 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
21240 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
21241 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
21244 driver = manualroute
21245 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
21246 route_list = saved.domain.example
21248 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
21249 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
21250 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
21253 driver = manualroute
21255 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
21256 *.saved.domain2.example \
21257 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
21260 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21262 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
21263 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
21264 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
21265 the address if the lookup fails.
21268 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
21269 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
21270 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
21271 one way it can be done:
21277 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
21278 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
21279 return_fail_output = true
21284 driver = manualroute
21286 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
21288 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
21290 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
21292 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
21293 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
21294 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
21296 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
21297 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
21306 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21307 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21309 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
21310 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
21311 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
21312 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
21313 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
21314 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
21315 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
21316 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
21317 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
21318 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
21320 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
21322 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
21323 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
21324 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
21325 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
21326 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
21329 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
21330 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
21331 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
21332 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
21333 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
21334 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
21337 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
21338 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
21339 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
21340 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
21341 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
21342 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
21343 not set, a value for the gid also.
21345 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
21346 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
21347 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
21348 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
21349 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
21350 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
21354 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
21355 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
21356 before running the command.
21359 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
21360 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
21361 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
21365 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
21366 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
21367 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
21368 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
21369 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
21372 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
21375 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
21376 &%no_more%& is set.
21378 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
21379 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
21380 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
21381 included in the SMTP response.
21383 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
21384 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
21385 included in any SMTP response.
21387 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
21389 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
21390 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
21392 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
21393 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
21394 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
21397 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
21398 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
21401 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
21402 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
21404 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
21405 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
21406 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
21407 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
21409 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
21410 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
21411 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
21412 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
21413 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
21415 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
21416 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
21417 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
21418 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
21419 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
21421 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
21422 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
21423 variable. For example, this return line
21425 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
21427 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
21428 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
21429 .ecindex IIDquerou1
21430 .ecindex IIDquerou2
21435 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21436 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21438 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
21439 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
21440 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
21441 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
21442 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
21443 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
21444 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
21445 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
21446 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
21447 redirected in several different ways:
21450 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
21453 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
21455 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
21457 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
21459 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
21461 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
21463 It can be discarded.
21466 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
21467 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
21468 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
21469 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
21471 If success DSNs have been requested
21472 .cindex "DSN" "success"
21473 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
21474 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
21478 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
21479 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
21480 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
21481 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
21482 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
21483 aliases, in a configuration like this:
21487 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
21489 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
21490 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
21491 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
21492 cause delivery to be deferred.
21494 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
21495 &_.forward_& files, like this:
21500 file = $home/.forward
21503 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
21504 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
21505 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
21506 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only
21507 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21510 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21511 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21512 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21514 &*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
21515 directly for redirection,
21516 as they are provided by a potential attacker.
21517 In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
21518 on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
21519 the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
21523 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
21524 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
21525 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
21526 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
21529 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
21530 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
21531 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
21532 practice the router may not be able to operate.
21534 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
21535 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
21536 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
21537 saves some resources.
21545 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
21546 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21547 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21548 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
21549 can be interpreted in two different ways:
21552 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
21553 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
21554 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
21555 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
21556 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
21557 document is intended for use by end users.
21559 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
21560 described in the next section.
21563 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
21564 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
21565 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
21566 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
21567 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
21571 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
21572 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
21573 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
21574 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
21575 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
21576 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
21577 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
21578 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
21579 commas or newlines.
21580 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
21583 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
21584 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
21585 next newline character is ignored.
21587 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
21588 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
21589 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
21590 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
21593 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21594 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
21595 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
21596 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
21597 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
21598 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
21601 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
21605 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
21606 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
21607 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
21608 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
21609 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
21610 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
21611 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
21612 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
21613 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
21614 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
21615 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
21617 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
21618 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
21619 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
21620 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
21621 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
21623 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
21625 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
21626 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
21627 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
21628 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
21629 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
21632 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid
21633 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21634 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
21635 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
21636 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
21637 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
21639 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
21640 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
21645 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
21646 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
21649 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21651 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
21652 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
21653 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
21654 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
21655 should really contain
21657 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21659 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
21660 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
21661 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
21665 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
21666 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
21667 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
21670 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
21671 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
21672 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
21674 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21675 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
21676 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
21677 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21678 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21680 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
21681 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
21682 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
21683 in double quotes, for example:
21685 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
21687 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
21688 quote just the command. An item such as
21690 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
21692 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
21694 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
21695 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
21696 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
21697 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
21698 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
21699 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
21700 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
21701 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
21702 an &%accept%& router.
21705 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
21706 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
21707 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
21709 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21710 address that includes a domain. For example,
21712 /home/world/minbari
21714 is treated as a filename, but
21716 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
21718 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
21719 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
21720 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
21721 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
21723 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21724 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21726 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
21727 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
21728 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
21729 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
21732 .cindex "included address list"
21733 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
21734 If an item is of the form
21736 :include:<path name>
21738 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
21739 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
21740 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
21741 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
21742 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
21743 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
21745 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
21747 It must be given as
21749 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
21751 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21752 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21753 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21755 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
21756 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
21757 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
21758 .cindex "black hole"
21759 .cindex "abandoning mail"
21760 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
21761 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
21762 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
21766 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
21767 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
21768 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
21770 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
21771 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
21772 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
21773 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
21777 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
21778 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
21779 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
21780 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
21781 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
21782 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
21783 redirection items of the form
21788 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
21789 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
21790 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
21791 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
21793 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
21795 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
21797 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
21798 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
21800 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
21801 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
21802 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
21804 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21805 By default for verify, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
21806 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
21807 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
21808 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
21809 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
21810 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
21811 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
21812 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
21815 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
21816 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
21817 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
21818 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
21820 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
21821 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
21822 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
21823 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
21824 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
21826 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
21827 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
21828 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
21829 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
21830 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
21834 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
21835 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
21836 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
21837 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
21838 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
21839 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
21840 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
21844 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
21845 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
21846 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
21847 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
21848 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
21849 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
21850 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
21851 aliasing scheme of the type
21853 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
21857 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
21858 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
21859 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
21862 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
21863 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
21865 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
21866 the pipes are distinct.
21870 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
21871 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
21872 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
21873 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
21874 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
21875 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
21876 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
21877 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
21878 can be used to avoid this.
21881 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
21882 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
21883 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
21884 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
21885 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
21886 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
21887 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
21891 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
21893 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
21894 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
21897 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
21898 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
21899 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
21902 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
21903 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
21904 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
21905 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
21908 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
21909 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
21910 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
21911 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
21912 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
21913 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
21914 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
21916 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
21917 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
21920 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
21921 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
21922 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
21923 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
21924 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
21928 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
21929 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
21930 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
21931 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
21932 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
21933 let ordinary users do.
21937 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
21938 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
21939 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
21940 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
21941 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
21942 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
21944 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
21945 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
21946 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
21947 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
21948 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
21949 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
21951 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
21953 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
21954 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
21955 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
21956 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
21957 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
21958 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
21959 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
21960 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21963 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21964 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21965 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21966 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21967 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21968 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21969 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21970 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21974 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21975 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21976 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21977 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21978 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21979 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21982 .option data redirect string&!! unset
21983 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21984 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21985 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21986 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21987 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21989 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21990 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21991 terminated with newline characters. For example:
21993 data = #Exim filter\n\
21994 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21996 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21997 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21998 choice into a newline.
22001 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
22002 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
22003 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
22004 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
22005 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
22008 .option file redirect string&!! unset
22009 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
22010 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
22011 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
22012 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
22013 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
22014 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
22015 entirely of comments), the router declines.
22017 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
22018 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
22019 runs a check on the containing directory,
22020 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
22021 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
22022 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
22023 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
22024 not, the router declines.
22027 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
22028 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22029 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
22030 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
22031 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
22032 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
22033 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
22036 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
22037 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
22038 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
22039 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
22040 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
22043 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
22044 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22045 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22046 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
22050 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
22051 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22052 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22053 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
22054 &%allow_filter%& is true.
22059 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
22060 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22061 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
22062 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22063 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
22064 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
22065 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
22066 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
22067 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
22068 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
22069 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
22072 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
22073 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22074 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22075 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
22076 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
22079 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
22080 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22081 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22082 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
22083 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
22084 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
22086 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
22087 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22088 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22089 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
22090 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
22091 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
22092 &_.forward_& files).
22095 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
22096 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22097 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22098 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22099 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
22102 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
22103 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22104 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22105 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
22106 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
22107 of the embedded Perl support.
22110 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
22111 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22112 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22113 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22114 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
22117 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
22118 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22119 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22120 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22121 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
22124 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
22125 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22126 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22127 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
22128 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
22129 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
22130 &%one_time%& is set.
22133 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
22134 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22135 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22136 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22137 to make use of &%run%& items.
22140 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
22141 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22142 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22143 If this option is true, items of the form
22145 :include:<path name>
22147 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
22150 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
22151 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22152 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22153 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
22154 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
22155 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
22156 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
22159 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
22160 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22161 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22162 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
22163 &%allow_filter%& is true.
22166 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
22167 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
22168 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
22169 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
22170 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
22175 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
22176 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
22177 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
22178 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
22179 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
22180 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
22181 bounce may well quote the generated address.
22184 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
22186 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22187 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
22188 file did not exist.
22191 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
22193 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22194 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
22195 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
22197 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
22198 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
22199 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
22200 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
22201 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
22202 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
22203 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
22204 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
22208 .option include_directory redirect string unset
22209 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
22210 redirection list must start with this directory.
22213 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
22214 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
22215 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
22218 .option one_time redirect boolean false
22219 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
22220 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
22221 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
22222 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
22223 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
22224 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
22225 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
22226 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
22227 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
22228 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
22229 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
22230 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
22231 before they subscribed.
22233 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
22234 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
22235 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
22236 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
22239 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
22240 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
22241 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
22242 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
22244 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
22245 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
22246 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
22248 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
22251 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
22252 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
22253 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
22254 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
22255 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
22259 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
22260 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
22261 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
22262 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
22263 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
22264 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
22265 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
22266 See &%check_owner%& above.
22269 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
22270 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
22271 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
22272 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
22275 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
22276 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22277 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
22278 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
22279 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
22280 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
22281 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
22284 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
22285 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
22286 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
22287 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
22288 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
22289 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
22290 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
22291 &$qualify_recipient$&.
22293 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
22294 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
22295 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
22298 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
22299 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
22300 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
22301 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
22302 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
22303 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
22304 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
22305 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
22306 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
22307 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
22310 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
22311 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
22312 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
22313 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
22314 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
22315 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
22318 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
22319 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
22320 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
22321 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
22322 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
22323 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
22326 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
22327 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
22328 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
22329 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
22330 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
22333 .option sieve_inbox redirect string&!! inbox
22335 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22336 name of the mailbox used for "keep" operations (explicit or implicit).
22339 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
22340 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22341 :subaddress part of an address.
22343 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
22344 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
22345 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
22346 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
22349 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
22350 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
22351 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
22352 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
22353 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
22354 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
22355 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
22359 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
22360 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
22361 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
22362 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
22363 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
22364 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
22365 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
22366 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
22367 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
22368 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
22369 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
22370 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
22371 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
22372 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
22373 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
22374 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
22376 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
22377 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
22378 the following routers.
22380 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
22381 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
22382 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
22383 so it is passed to the following routers.
22385 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
22386 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
22387 action is specified by
22388 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3028.html,RFC 3028).
22389 The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
22390 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
22392 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
22393 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
22394 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
22395 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
22401 file = $home/.forward
22402 file_transport = address_file
22403 pipe_transport = address_pipe
22404 reply_transport = address_reply
22407 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
22408 syntax_errors_text = \
22409 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
22410 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
22411 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
22412 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
22413 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
22414 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
22415 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
22416 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
22417 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
22418 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
22420 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
22421 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
22422 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
22427 local_part_prefix = real-
22428 transport = local_delivery
22430 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
22431 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
22433 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
22434 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
22438 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
22439 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22442 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
22443 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22444 .ecindex IIDredrou1
22445 .ecindex IIDredrou2
22452 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22453 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22455 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
22456 "Environment for local transports"
22457 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
22458 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
22459 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
22460 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
22461 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
22462 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
22463 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
22465 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
22466 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
22467 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
22468 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
22470 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
22471 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
22472 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
22473 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
22474 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
22478 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
22479 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
22480 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
22481 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
22482 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
22483 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
22484 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
22487 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
22488 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
22492 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
22494 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
22495 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
22496 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
22497 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
22502 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
22503 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
22504 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
22505 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
22506 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
22507 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
22508 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
22509 group (set by the transport). For example:
22512 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
22516 transport = group_delivery
22519 # This transport overrides the group
22521 driver = appendfile
22522 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
22525 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
22526 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
22527 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
22530 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
22531 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
22532 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
22533 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
22534 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
22535 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
22537 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
22538 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
22539 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
22540 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
22541 original gid is also used.
22543 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
22544 following that is set is used:
22547 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
22549 A &%group%& setting of the router;
22551 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
22552 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
22554 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
22556 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
22557 the uid is the creator's uid;
22559 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
22562 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
22563 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
22564 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
22565 The first of the following that is set is used:
22568 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
22570 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
22572 A &%user%& setting of the router;
22574 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
22579 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
22580 &%never_users%& list.
22586 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
22587 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
22588 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
22589 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
22590 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
22591 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
22592 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
22593 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
22594 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
22595 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22598 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
22600 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
22602 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
22604 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
22607 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22610 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
22612 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
22616 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
22617 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
22618 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
22622 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
22623 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22624 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22625 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
22626 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
22627 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
22628 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
22629 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
22630 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
22631 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
22632 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
22633 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
22634 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
22635 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
22643 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22644 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22646 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
22647 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
22648 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
22649 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
22650 The name of a transport is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
22651 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
22654 The following generic options apply to all transports:
22657 .option body_only transports boolean false
22658 .cindex "transport" "body only"
22659 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
22660 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
22661 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
22662 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
22663 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
22664 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
22665 automatically suppress them.
22668 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
22669 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
22670 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
22671 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
22672 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
22673 logged, and delivery is deferred.
22676 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
22677 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
22678 deliveries by the transport or for any
22679 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
22680 what you are doing.
22683 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
22684 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
22685 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
22686 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
22688 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
22689 output, and Exim carries on processing.
22690 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
22691 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
22692 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
22693 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
22695 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
22696 transport and the router that called it.
22698 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
22699 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
22700 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
22701 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
22702 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
22703 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
22704 safely be resent to other recipients.
22707 .option driver transports string unset
22708 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
22709 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
22712 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
22713 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22714 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
22715 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
22716 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
22717 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
22718 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
22719 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
22720 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
22721 resent to other recipients.
22723 &*Note:*& If used on a transport handling multiple recipients
22724 (the smtp transport unless &%max_rcpt%& is 1, the appendfile, pipe or lmtp
22725 transport if &%batch_max%& is greater than 1)
22726 then information about Bcc recipients will be leaked.
22727 Doing so is generally not advised.
22730 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
22732 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
22733 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
22736 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
22737 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
22738 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
22739 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
22740 &%user%& (see below).
22743 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
22744 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
22745 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
22746 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22747 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22748 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
22749 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
22750 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
22751 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22752 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22753 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22755 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
22756 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
22759 .option headers_only transports boolean false
22760 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
22761 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
22762 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
22763 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
22764 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
22765 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
22766 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
22769 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
22770 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
22771 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
22772 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22773 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22774 to be removed from the message.
22775 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
22776 Each list item is separately expanded.
22777 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22778 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22779 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22780 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
22782 Matching headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
22783 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
22786 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
22787 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
22789 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
22790 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
22791 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
22795 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
22796 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
22797 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22798 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
22799 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
22800 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
22801 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
22802 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
22805 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
22808 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
22809 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
22810 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
22811 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
22812 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
22813 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
22814 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
22815 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
22816 change envelope recipients at this time.
22819 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
22820 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
22822 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
22823 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
22824 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
22825 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
22826 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
22827 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
22828 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
22832 .option initgroups transports boolean false
22833 .cindex "additional groups"
22834 .cindex "groups" "additional"
22835 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
22836 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
22837 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
22838 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
22841 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
22842 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
22843 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
22844 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
22845 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
22846 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
22847 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
22848 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
22850 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
22851 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
22852 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
22853 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
22854 Obviously there is scope for
22855 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22856 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22858 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
22859 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22860 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22861 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22862 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
22865 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
22866 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
22867 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
22868 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
22869 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
22870 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
22871 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
22872 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
22873 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
22874 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
22875 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
22876 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
22877 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
22882 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
22883 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
22884 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
22885 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
22886 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
22887 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
22888 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
22889 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
22892 local_part_prefix = *-
22894 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
22897 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
22899 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
22900 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
22901 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
22902 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
22903 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
22906 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
22907 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
22908 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
22909 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
22910 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
22911 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
22912 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
22913 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
22914 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
22916 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
22917 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
22918 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
22919 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
22921 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
22922 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
22923 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
22926 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
22927 .cindex "envelope sender"
22928 .cindex "envelope from"
22929 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
22930 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
22931 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
22932 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
22933 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
22934 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
22935 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
22936 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
22937 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
22939 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
22940 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
22942 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
22943 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
22944 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
22945 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
22946 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
22947 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
22948 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
22950 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
22951 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
22952 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
22953 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
22954 &%errors_to%& in a router.
22958 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
22959 .chindex Return-path:
22960 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
22961 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
22962 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
22963 have easy access to it.
22965 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821)
22966 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
22967 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
22968 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
22969 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
22970 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
22974 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
22975 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
22978 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
22979 .cindex "shadow transport"
22980 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
22981 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
22982 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
22984 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22985 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22986 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22987 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22988 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22989 cause a log line to be written.
22991 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22992 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22993 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22994 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22995 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22998 ST=<shadow transport name>
23000 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
23001 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
23002 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
23003 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
23004 headers that some sites insist on.
23007 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
23008 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23009 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23010 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
23011 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
23012 individual users or via a system filter.
23013 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
23015 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
23016 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
23017 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
23018 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock).
23019 The command must be specified as an absolute path.
23021 The process run by the command must use its standard input as the message
23022 data to be transformed, and write the results on its standard output.
23024 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
23025 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
23026 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
23027 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
23028 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
23029 &(pipe)& transports.
23031 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
23032 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
23033 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
23034 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
23035 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
23037 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
23039 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
23040 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
23041 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
23042 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
23044 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
23045 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
23046 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
23047 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
23048 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
23049 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
23051 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
23052 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
23053 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
23054 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
23055 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
23056 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
23057 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
23058 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
23060 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23061 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
23062 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
23063 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
23064 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
23065 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
23066 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
23067 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
23068 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
23069 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
23072 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23073 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
23074 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
23075 which the message is being sent. For example:
23076 . used to have $sender_address in this cmdline, but it's tainted
23078 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
23079 $host $host_address $pipe_addresses
23082 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
23083 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
23084 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
23086 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
23087 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
23088 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
23091 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
23093 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
23094 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise.
23096 Option strings in general have any fully-surrounding double quote wrapping
23097 removed early in parsing (see &<<SECTstrings>>&).
23098 Then, for this option, quotes protect against whitespace being
23099 regarded as a separator while splitting into the command argument vector.
23100 Either double or single quotes can be used here;
23101 the former interprets backlash-quoted charachters
23102 and the latter does not.
23104 If double quotes had been used in this example, they would have been
23105 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
23106 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
23107 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
23108 Exim tried to expand the first one.
23110 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
23111 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
23112 arguments. Consider this example:
23114 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
23115 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
23117 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
23118 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
23120 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
23121 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
23125 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
23126 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
23127 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
23128 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
23129 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
23130 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
23131 bounced from a transport filter.
23133 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
23134 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
23135 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
23138 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
23139 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
23140 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
23141 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
23142 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
23143 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
23144 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
23145 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
23146 becomes a temporary error.
23149 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
23150 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23151 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
23152 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
23153 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
23154 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
23155 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
23158 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
23159 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
23160 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
23162 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
23163 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
23164 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
23165 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
23167 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
23168 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
23169 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
23176 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23177 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23179 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
23181 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
23182 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
23183 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
23184 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
23185 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
23186 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
23187 copy of the message is delivered each time.
23189 .cindex "batched local delivery"
23190 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
23191 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
23192 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
23193 local transport, for example:
23196 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
23197 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
23198 recipients saves space.
23200 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
23201 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
23203 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
23204 to a scanner program or
23205 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
23209 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
23210 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
23211 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
23213 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
23214 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
23215 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
23216 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
23217 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
23218 to certain conditions:
23221 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23222 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
23223 batching is possible.
23225 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23226 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
23227 addresses with the same domain are batched.
23229 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
23230 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
23231 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
23232 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
23233 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
23236 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
23237 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
23238 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
23242 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
23243 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
23244 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
23245 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
23246 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
23247 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
23248 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
23251 escape_string = ".."
23253 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
23254 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
23255 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
23257 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
23258 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
23259 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
23260 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
23261 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
23262 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
23264 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
23265 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23266 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
23267 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
23268 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
23269 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
23270 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
23271 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
23272 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
23277 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23278 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23280 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
23281 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
23282 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
23283 .cindex "directory creation"
23284 .cindex "creating directories"
23285 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
23286 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
23287 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
23288 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
23289 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
23290 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
23291 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
23292 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
23293 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
23294 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
23296 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
23297 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
23298 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
23301 .cindex "quota" "system"
23302 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
23303 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
23304 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
23306 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
23307 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
23308 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
23309 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
23311 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
23312 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
23315 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
23316 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
23317 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
23318 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
23323 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
23324 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
23325 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
23326 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
23327 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
23329 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
23330 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23331 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
23332 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
23333 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
23334 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
23335 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
23336 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
23337 operation. There are two cases:
23340 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
23341 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
23342 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
23343 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
23344 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
23345 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
23346 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
23348 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
23349 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
23350 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
23352 If the &%create_file%& option is set to a path which
23353 matches (see the option definition below for details)
23354 a file or directory name
23355 for the delivery, that name becomes de-tainted.
23357 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
23358 .cindex appendfile "tainted data"
23359 Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
23360 This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
23361 as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
23362 which returns a path (or component).
23365 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
23366 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
23367 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
23368 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
23373 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
23375 require "fileinto";
23376 fileinto "folder23";
23378 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
23379 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
23380 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the
23385 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
23386 way of handling this requirement:
23388 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
23389 {/var/mail/$local_part_data} \
23390 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
23392 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
23396 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
23397 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
23398 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
23401 An alternative for the &"keep"& aspect is to use the &%sieve_inbox%& option
23402 on the redirect router that calls the Sieve filter,
23403 to explicitly set the filename used.
23406 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
23407 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
23408 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
23409 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
23410 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
23411 path to the transport.
23413 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
23414 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
23417 &*Note 3*&: Permitting a user to enable writes to an absolute path
23418 may be a security issue.
23423 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
23424 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
23428 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
23429 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
23430 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
23431 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
23432 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
23433 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
23434 delivery is deferred.
23437 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
23438 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23439 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23440 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
23441 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
23442 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
23443 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
23444 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
23447 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
23448 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23449 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
23450 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
23454 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
23455 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23458 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
23459 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
23460 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
23461 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
23462 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
23465 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
23466 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
23467 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
23468 process is running.
23471 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
23472 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23473 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
23474 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
23475 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
23476 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
23477 contains is significant.
23479 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
23480 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
23481 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
23482 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
23483 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
23485 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
23486 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
23487 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
23488 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
23489 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
23490 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
23492 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23493 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
23494 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23495 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23497 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
23498 .cindex "directory creation"
23499 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
23500 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
23501 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
23503 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
23504 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
23505 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
23506 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
23507 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
23511 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
23512 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
23513 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
23514 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
23515 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
23518 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
23519 &"belowhome"&, or to an absolute path.
23521 In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
23522 set for the transport, and the file or directory being created must
23524 The "belowhome" checking additionally checks for attempts to use "../"
23525 to evade the testing.
23526 This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
23527 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
23528 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
23529 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
23530 &%file_must_exist%&.
23532 In the fourth case,
23533 the value given for this option must be an absolute path for an
23534 existing directory.
23535 The value is used for checking instead of a home directory;
23536 checking is done in "belowhome" mode.
23538 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
23539 .cindex "de-tainting" "using appendfile create_file option"
23540 If "belowhome" checking is used, the file or directory path
23541 becomes de-tainted.
23544 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
23545 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
23546 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
23547 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
23549 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
23550 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
23551 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
23552 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
23553 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
23555 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23559 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
23561 .vindex "&$inode$&"
23562 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
23563 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
23564 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
23566 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
23568 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
23569 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
23573 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
23574 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
23575 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
23578 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
23579 See &%check_string%& above.
23582 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
23583 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
23584 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
23585 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
23586 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
23587 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
23590 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23593 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23594 .cindex "locking files"
23595 .cindex "lock files"
23596 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
23597 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
23599 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
23600 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
23603 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
23604 file = /home/$local_part_data/inbox
23607 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
23608 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
23609 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
23610 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
23611 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
23612 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
23616 .option file_format appendfile string unset
23617 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
23618 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
23619 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
23620 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
23621 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
23622 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
23623 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
23624 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
23627 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
23628 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
23630 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
23631 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
23632 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
23633 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
23634 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
23635 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
23636 delivery is deferred.
23639 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
23640 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
23641 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
23642 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
23645 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
23646 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23647 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
23648 .cindex "locking files"
23649 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
23650 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
23651 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
23652 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
23653 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
23654 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
23655 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
23656 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
23658 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
23659 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
23660 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
23661 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
23663 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
23664 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
23667 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
23669 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
23670 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
23671 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
23673 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
23674 local deliveries because of errors of the form
23676 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
23679 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
23680 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
23681 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
23682 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
23685 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
23686 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
23687 for details of locking.
23690 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
23691 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
23692 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
23695 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23696 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
23697 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
23700 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
23701 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23702 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
23703 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
23704 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
23707 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
23708 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23709 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23710 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23711 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
23712 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
23713 external source that maintains the data.
23716 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
23717 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23718 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23719 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23720 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
23721 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
23722 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
23723 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
23727 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
23728 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
23729 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
23730 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
23731 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
23732 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
23733 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
23734 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
23735 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
23736 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23739 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
23740 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
23741 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
23742 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
23743 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
23744 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
23745 calculation. The default value is:
23747 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
23749 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
23750 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
23752 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
23754 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
23756 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
23757 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
23758 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
23759 directly into that directory.
23762 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
23763 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
23764 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23767 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
23768 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
23769 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23772 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
23773 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23774 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
23775 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
23776 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
23777 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
23778 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
23779 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23781 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
23782 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
23783 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
23784 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
23785 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
23786 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
23787 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
23788 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
23789 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
23790 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
23793 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
23794 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
23795 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
23796 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
23797 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
23798 below for further details.
23801 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
23802 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23803 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23806 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
23807 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23808 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23811 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
23812 .cindex "locking files"
23813 .cindex "file" "locking"
23814 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
23815 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
23816 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23817 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
23818 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
23819 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
23820 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
23822 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
23823 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
23824 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
23831 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
23832 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
23833 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
23834 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
23835 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
23836 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
23837 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
23838 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
23840 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
23841 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
23842 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
23843 append messages to it.
23846 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23847 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23848 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23849 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23850 in which case it is:
23852 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
23853 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
23855 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23856 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23858 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23859 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23860 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23861 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
23866 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23867 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23869 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23870 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
23871 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
23872 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
23873 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
23874 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
23875 value, and this option is ignored.
23878 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
23879 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
23880 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
23881 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
23882 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
23885 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
23886 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
23887 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
23888 on users about incoming mail.
23891 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
23892 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
23893 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
23894 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
23895 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
23896 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
23897 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
23898 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
23899 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
23901 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
23902 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
23903 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
23905 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
23906 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
23907 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
23908 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
23909 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
23910 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
23912 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
23913 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
23914 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
23915 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
23916 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
23919 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23920 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23922 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
23924 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
23925 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
23926 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
23927 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
23928 system quota failures.
23930 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
23931 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
23932 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
23933 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
23934 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
23935 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
23936 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
23937 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
23938 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
23939 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
23942 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
23943 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
23944 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
23945 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
23946 delivery directory.
23949 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
23950 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
23951 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
23952 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
23953 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
23956 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23957 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23959 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
23960 See &%quota%& above.
23963 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
23964 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
23965 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
23966 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
23967 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
23968 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
23969 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
23971 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
23972 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
23973 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
23974 the file length to the filename. For example:
23976 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
23977 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
23979 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
23980 number of lines in the message.
23982 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
23983 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
23984 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
23986 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
23988 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
23989 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
23990 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
23991 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
23992 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
23993 as is used to adjust the effective size.
23996 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
23997 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
23998 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
24000 quota_warn_message = "\
24001 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
24002 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
24003 This message is automatically created \
24004 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
24005 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
24006 a warning threshold that is\n\
24007 set by the system administrator.\n"
24011 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
24012 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
24013 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
24014 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
24015 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
24016 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
24017 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
24018 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
24019 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
24023 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
24025 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
24026 percent sign is ignored.
24028 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
24029 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
24030 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
24031 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
24032 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
24033 &'From:'& line, the default is:
24035 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
24037 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
24038 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
24041 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
24042 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
24046 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
24047 .cindex "envelope from"
24048 .cindex "envelope sender"
24049 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
24050 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
24051 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
24052 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
24053 for details of batch SMTP.
24056 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
24057 .cindex "carriage return"
24059 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24060 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24061 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
24062 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24064 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
24065 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
24066 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
24067 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
24068 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
24069 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24072 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
24073 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
24074 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
24075 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
24076 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
24077 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
24080 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
24081 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
24082 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
24083 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
24084 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
24086 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
24087 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
24088 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
24089 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
24091 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
24092 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
24093 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
24094 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
24095 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
24098 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
24099 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
24102 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
24103 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
24104 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
24105 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
24106 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
24107 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
24108 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
24110 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
24111 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
24112 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
24113 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
24116 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
24117 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
24118 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
24121 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
24122 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
24123 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
24124 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
24125 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
24126 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
24127 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
24128 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
24129 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
24131 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
24132 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
24133 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
24134 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
24139 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
24140 .cindex "appending to a file"
24141 .cindex "file" "appending"
24142 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
24145 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
24149 .cindex "directory creation"
24150 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
24151 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
24152 &%directory_mode%& option.
24155 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
24156 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
24160 .cindex "file" "locking"
24161 .cindex "locking files"
24162 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
24163 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
24164 reliably over NFS, as follows:
24167 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
24168 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
24169 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
24171 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
24173 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
24174 Unlink the hitching post name.
24176 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
24177 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
24178 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
24179 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
24181 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
24182 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
24183 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
24184 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
24185 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
24186 it before trying again.
24190 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
24191 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
24192 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
24195 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
24196 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
24197 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
24198 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
24199 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
24200 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
24201 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
24202 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
24203 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
24207 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
24208 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
24209 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
24210 delivery is deferred.
24213 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
24214 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
24215 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
24219 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
24220 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
24221 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
24224 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
24225 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
24226 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
24229 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
24230 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
24231 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
24232 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
24233 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
24234 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
24235 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
24236 that prevents link following.
24239 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
24240 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
24241 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
24242 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
24243 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
24246 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
24249 .cindex "file" "locking"
24250 .cindex "locking files"
24251 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
24252 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
24253 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
24254 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
24255 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
24257 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
24259 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
24260 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
24261 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
24263 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
24264 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
24265 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
24267 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
24268 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
24269 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
24270 delivery is deferred.
24272 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
24273 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
24274 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
24275 immediately. It retries up to
24277 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
24279 times (rounded up).
24282 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
24283 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
24286 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
24287 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
24288 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24289 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
24290 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
24291 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
24292 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
24293 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
24294 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
24295 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
24297 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
24298 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
24299 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
24300 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
24301 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
24302 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
24303 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
24305 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
24306 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
24307 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
24308 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
24311 .cindex "maildir format"
24312 .cindex "mailstore format"
24313 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
24314 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
24315 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
24316 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
24317 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
24319 .cindex "directory creation"
24320 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
24321 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
24322 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
24323 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
24324 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
24325 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
24330 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
24331 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
24332 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
24333 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
24334 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
24335 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
24336 &_new_& subdirectory.
24338 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
24339 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
24340 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
24341 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
24342 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
24343 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
24344 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
24346 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
24347 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
24348 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
24349 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
24350 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
24351 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
24352 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
24353 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
24355 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
24356 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
24357 folders. Consider this example:
24359 maildir_format = true
24360 directory = /var/mail/$local_part_data\
24361 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
24362 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
24363 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
24365 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
24366 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
24367 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
24368 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
24369 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
24370 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
24372 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
24373 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
24374 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
24375 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
24376 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
24378 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
24379 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
24380 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
24382 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24383 .cindex "maildir++"
24384 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
24385 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
24386 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
24387 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
24388 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
24389 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
24390 amount of space used.
24392 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
24393 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
24394 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
24395 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
24396 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
24397 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
24402 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
24403 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
24404 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
24405 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
24406 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
24407 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
24410 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
24411 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
24412 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
24413 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
24414 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
24415 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
24416 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
24417 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
24418 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
24419 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
24420 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
24421 backwards compatibility).
24423 For one common implementation, you might set:
24425 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
24427 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
24429 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
24430 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
24431 &[stat()]& each message file.
24434 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
24435 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24436 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
24437 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
24438 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
24439 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
24440 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
24441 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
24442 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
24444 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
24445 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
24446 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
24447 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
24448 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
24449 need to know the quota.
24451 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
24452 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
24454 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
24455 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
24456 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
24460 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
24461 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
24462 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
24463 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
24464 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
24465 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
24466 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
24467 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
24469 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
24470 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
24471 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
24472 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
24473 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
24474 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
24476 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
24477 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
24478 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
24479 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
24480 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
24481 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
24483 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
24484 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
24485 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
24486 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
24489 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
24490 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
24491 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
24492 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
24493 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
24495 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
24497 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
24498 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
24499 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
24500 .ecindex IIDapptra1
24501 .ecindex IIDapptra2
24508 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24509 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24511 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
24512 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
24513 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
24514 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
24515 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
24516 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
24517 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
24518 to the rules in RFCs
24519 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,2822) and
24520 &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc3834,3834), respectively.
24522 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
24523 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
24524 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
24525 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
24526 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
24529 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
24530 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
24531 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
24532 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
24533 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
24535 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
24536 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
24537 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
24538 transport is run as a consequence of a
24540 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
24541 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
24542 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
24543 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
24544 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
24545 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
24547 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
24548 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
24549 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
24550 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
24552 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
24553 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
24554 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
24555 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
24556 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
24557 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
24558 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
24560 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
24561 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
24562 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
24563 the transport defers.
24564 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
24565 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
24567 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
24568 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
24569 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
24570 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
24572 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24573 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
24574 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
24575 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
24576 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
24577 problems. They are just discarded.
24581 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
24582 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
24584 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
24585 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
24586 message when the message is specified by the transport.
24589 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
24590 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
24591 when the message is specified by the transport.
24594 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
24595 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
24596 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
24597 string comes first.
24600 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
24601 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
24602 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
24605 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
24606 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
24607 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
24610 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
24611 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
24612 specified by the transport.
24615 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
24616 This specifies additional
24617 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
24618 headers that are to be added to the message
24619 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
24620 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
24623 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
24624 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
24625 the message is specified by the transport.
24628 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
24629 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
24633 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
24634 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
24635 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
24636 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
24637 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
24641 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
24642 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
24643 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
24644 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
24646 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
24647 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
24648 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
24649 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
24650 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
24651 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
24652 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
24655 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
24656 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
24657 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
24658 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
24659 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
24661 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
24662 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
24663 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
24664 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
24665 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
24666 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
24669 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
24670 See &%once%& above.
24673 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
24674 See &%once%& above.
24675 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
24678 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
24679 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
24680 specified by the transport.
24683 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
24684 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
24685 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
24686 configuration option.
24689 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
24690 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
24691 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
24692 automatic responses. For example:
24694 subject = Re: $h_subject:
24696 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
24697 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
24698 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
24699 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
24704 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
24705 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
24706 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
24707 the text comes first.
24710 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
24711 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
24712 when the message is specified by the transport.
24713 .ecindex IIDauttra1
24714 .ecindex IIDauttra2
24719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24720 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24722 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
24723 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
24724 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
24725 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
24726 .cindex "LMTP" "over a unix-domain socket"
24727 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol
24728 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2033,RFC 2033)) over a pipe to a
24730 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
24731 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
24732 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
24733 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
24734 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
24735 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
24739 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
24740 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
24741 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
24744 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
24745 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24748 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
24749 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24750 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
24751 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
24752 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24755 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
24756 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
24757 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
24758 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
24759 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
24760 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
24763 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
24764 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24765 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
24766 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
24767 in its response to the LHLO command.
24769 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
24770 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
24771 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
24772 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
24775 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
24776 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
24777 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
24778 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
24783 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
24787 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
24788 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
24792 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24795 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
24796 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
24797 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
24798 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
24799 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
24800 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
24801 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
24802 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
24806 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24807 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
24808 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
24809 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
24810 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
24812 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24813 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
24814 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
24815 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
24816 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
24817 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
24818 that are routed to the transport.
24820 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
24821 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
24822 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
24823 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
24824 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
24825 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
24826 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
24830 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
24831 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
24832 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
24834 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
24835 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
24836 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
24837 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
24838 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
24839 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
24840 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
24842 .cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
24843 .cindex pipe "tainted data"
24844 Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
24847 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
24848 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
24849 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
24850 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
24851 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
24852 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
24853 of "1" to enforce serialization.
24858 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
24859 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
24860 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
24861 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
24862 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
24863 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
24864 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
24865 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
24866 &"local delivery failed"&.
24868 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
24869 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
24870 will be sent as normal.
24872 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
24873 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
24874 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
24875 apply in this case.
24877 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
24878 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
24879 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
24880 a non-existent command may be the problem.
24882 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
24883 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
24884 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
24885 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
24886 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
24887 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
24888 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
24893 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
24894 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
24895 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
24896 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
24897 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
24900 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
24901 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
24902 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
24903 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
24905 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
24906 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
24907 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
24908 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
24909 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
24911 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
24913 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
24914 arguments. You have to write
24916 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
24918 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
24919 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
24920 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
24921 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
24922 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
24923 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
24926 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
24929 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24930 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24931 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24932 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
24933 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
24934 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
24935 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
24936 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
24937 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
24938 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
24939 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
24941 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
24942 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
24943 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
24944 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
24945 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
24946 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
24947 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
24948 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
24950 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
24951 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
24952 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
24953 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
24954 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
24955 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
24956 control what is done with it.
24958 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
24959 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
24960 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
24961 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
24962 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
24963 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
24964 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
24965 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
24966 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
24967 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
24968 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
24972 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
24973 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24974 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24975 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
24976 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
24977 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
24978 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
24979 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
24980 &*Note*&: Using enviroment variables loses track of tainted data.
24981 Writers of &(pipe)& transport commands should be wary of data supplied
24982 by potential attackers.
24984 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
24985 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
24986 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
24987 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
24988 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
24989 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
24990 &`LOGNAME `& see below
24991 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
24992 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
24993 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
24994 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
24995 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
24996 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
24997 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
24998 &`USER `& see below
25000 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
25001 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
25002 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
25003 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
25004 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
25005 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
25006 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
25009 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
25010 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
25011 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
25015 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
25016 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
25017 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
25018 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
25021 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
25022 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
25026 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
25027 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
25028 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
25029 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
25030 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
25031 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
25032 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
25033 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
25034 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
25035 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
25036 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
25039 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
25041 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
25042 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
25043 &%use_shell%& is set.
25046 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
25047 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
25050 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
25051 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
25052 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
25055 .option check_string pipe string unset
25056 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
25057 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
25058 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
25059 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
25060 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
25061 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
25062 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
25066 .option command pipe string&!! unset
25067 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
25068 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
25069 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
25070 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
25071 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
25072 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
25074 .cindex "tainted data"
25075 No part of the resulting command may be tainted.
25078 .option environment pipe "string list&!!" unset
25079 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
25080 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
25081 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
25082 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
25083 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
25084 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
25087 .option escape_string pipe string unset
25088 See &%check_string%& above.
25091 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
25092 .cindex "exec failure"
25093 .cindex "failure of exec"
25094 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
25095 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
25096 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
25097 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
25098 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
25101 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
25102 .cindex "signal exit"
25103 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
25104 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
25105 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
25106 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
25109 .option force_command pipe boolean false
25110 .cindex "force command"
25111 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
25112 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
25113 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
25114 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
25115 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
25116 command. For example:
25118 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
25122 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
25123 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
25124 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
25127 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
25128 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
25129 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
25130 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
25131 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
25132 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
25134 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
25135 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
25138 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
25139 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
25140 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
25141 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
25142 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
25143 written to the main log.
25146 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
25147 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
25148 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
25149 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
25150 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
25151 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
25155 .option log_output pipe boolean false
25156 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
25157 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
25158 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
25159 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
25162 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
25163 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
25164 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
25165 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
25166 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
25167 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
25168 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
25169 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
25172 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
25173 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
25174 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
25177 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
25181 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
25182 .cindex "&""From""& line"
25183 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
25184 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
25185 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
25190 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
25191 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
25194 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
25195 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
25196 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
25197 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
25201 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
25202 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
25205 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
25206 This option is expanded and
25207 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
25208 variable of the subprocess.
25209 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
25210 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
25211 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
25214 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
25215 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
25216 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
25217 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
25218 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
25219 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
25220 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
25221 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
25222 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
25225 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
25226 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
25227 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
25228 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
25229 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
25230 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
25231 accept the message is used.
25234 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
25235 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
25236 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
25237 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
25238 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
25239 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
25242 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
25243 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
25244 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
25245 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
25246 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
25247 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
25248 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
25252 .option return_output pipe boolean false
25253 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
25254 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
25255 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
25256 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
25257 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
25258 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
25259 of them may be set.
25263 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
25264 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
25265 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
25266 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
25267 and &%return_output%& is not set,
25268 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
25269 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
25270 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
25271 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
25272 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
25273 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
25274 and 73, respectively.
25277 .option timeout pipe time 1h
25278 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
25279 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
25280 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
25281 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
25282 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
25283 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
25285 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
25286 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
25287 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
25288 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
25289 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
25290 delivery to be deferred.
25292 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
25293 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
25296 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
25297 .cindex "envelope sender"
25298 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
25299 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
25300 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
25301 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
25302 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
25304 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
25305 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
25306 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
25307 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
25308 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
25309 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
25313 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
25314 .cindex "carriage return"
25316 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
25317 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
25318 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
25319 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
25321 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
25322 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
25323 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
25324 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
25325 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
25328 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
25329 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
25330 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
25331 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
25332 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
25333 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
25334 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
25335 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
25336 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
25341 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
25342 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
25343 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
25344 .cindex "external local delivery"
25345 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
25346 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
25347 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
25348 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
25349 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
25350 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
25351 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
25352 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
25353 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
25354 configuration for &%procmail%&:
25359 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part_data
25363 check_string = "From "
25364 escape_string = ">From "
25366 user = $local_part_data
25373 transport = procmail_pipe
25375 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
25376 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
25377 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
25378 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
25379 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
25380 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
25382 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
25386 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
25387 use a shell to run pipe commands.
25390 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
25391 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
25392 . Used to have R: local_part_suffix = .* + T: -m $local_part_suffix_v
25393 . but that suffix is tainted so cannot be used in a command arg
25394 . Really, you'd want to use a lookup for acceptable suffixes to do real detainting
25397 local_delivery_cyrus:
25399 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
25400 -- $local_part_data
25412 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
25414 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
25415 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
25417 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
25418 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
25421 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25422 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25424 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
25425 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
25426 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
25427 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
25428 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
25429 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
25430 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
25431 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
25434 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
25435 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
25439 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
25440 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
25441 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
25442 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
25443 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
25444 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
25445 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
25447 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
25448 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
25449 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
25450 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
25451 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
25452 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
25457 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
25458 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
25459 no further messages are sent over that connection.
25463 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
25465 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25466 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
25467 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
25468 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
25469 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
25470 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
25471 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
25472 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
25475 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
25476 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
25477 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
25478 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
25479 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
25480 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
25481 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
25482 are the values that were set when the message was received.
25483 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
25484 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
25485 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
25486 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
25487 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
25488 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
25490 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
25491 and will be removed in a future release.
25494 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
25495 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
25496 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
25499 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
25500 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
25501 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
25502 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
25503 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
25504 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
25505 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
25506 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
25508 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
25509 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
25510 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25511 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
25512 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
25513 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
25514 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
25515 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
25516 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
25519 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
25521 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
25522 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
25523 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
25524 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
25525 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
25528 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
25529 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
25530 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
25531 particular connection.
25533 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
25534 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
25535 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
25536 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
25538 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
25539 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
25540 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
25542 authenticated_sender = $local_part
25544 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
25545 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
25547 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
25548 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
25552 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
25553 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
25554 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
25555 authenticated as a client.
25558 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
25559 .cindex timeout "smtp transport command"
25560 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
25561 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
25562 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
25565 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
25566 .cindex timeout "smtp transport connect"
25567 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
25568 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
25569 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
25570 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
25571 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
25572 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by
25573 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1123,RFC 1123).
25576 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
25577 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
25578 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
25579 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25580 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
25581 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
25582 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
25585 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
25586 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a MAILMAX value,
25587 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
25588 that value also constrains the result of this option.
25591 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25592 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
25593 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25594 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
25595 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
25596 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
25597 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
25598 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
25599 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
25600 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
25601 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
25602 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
25603 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
25604 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
25607 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
25608 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data blocks"
25609 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
25610 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
25611 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
25614 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
25615 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25616 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
25617 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25618 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
25619 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25620 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
25621 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25622 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
25623 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25624 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
25625 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25626 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
25627 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25628 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
25629 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25630 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
25631 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25634 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
25635 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
25636 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
25637 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
25638 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
25641 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
25642 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
25643 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
25644 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
25645 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
25646 unhappy at this prospect, so...
25648 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25649 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
25650 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25651 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
25652 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
25653 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
25654 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
25655 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
25659 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
25660 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
25661 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
25662 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
25663 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
25666 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
25667 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
25668 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
25669 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
25673 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
25674 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25675 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25676 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25677 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25678 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
25679 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
25680 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
25685 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
25686 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25687 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25688 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25689 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25690 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
25691 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
25692 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
25693 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
25697 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
25698 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
25699 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
25700 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
25701 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
25702 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
25703 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
25705 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
25706 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
25707 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
25708 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
25709 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
25712 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
25713 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25714 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
25715 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
25716 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
25717 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25718 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25719 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
25721 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
25722 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
25723 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
25724 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
25725 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
25726 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
25728 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
25729 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
25730 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
25731 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
25732 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
25734 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
25735 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
25736 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
25737 copy of the message is sent.
25739 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
25740 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
25741 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
25742 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
25746 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
25747 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data accept"
25748 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
25749 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
25752 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
25753 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
25754 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
25755 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
25756 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
25757 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
25759 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
25760 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
25761 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
25762 implementations of TLS.
25764 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
25765 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
25766 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
25767 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
25768 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
25769 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
25770 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
25775 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
25776 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
25777 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
25778 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
25779 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
25780 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
25781 interface address, you could use this:
25783 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address} \
25784 {${listextract{1}{<\n $value}}} \
25785 {$primary_hostname}}
25787 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
25790 .option host_name_extract smtp "string list&!!" "see below"
25791 .cindex "load balancer" "hosts behind"
25792 .cindex TLS resumption
25793 Some mail-accepting sites
25794 (notably Microsoft)
25795 operate many servers behind a network load-balancer. When this is done,
25796 with separated TLS session caches, TLS session resuption becomes problematic.
25797 It will only succeed when the same server happens to be selected by the
25798 load-balancer, matching the session stored in the client's cache.
25800 Exim can pull out a server name, if there is one, from the response to the
25801 client's SMTP EHLO command.
25802 For normal STARTTLS use, the default value of this option:
25804 ${if and { {match {$host} {.outlook.com\$}} \
25805 {match {$item} {\N^250-([\w.]+)\s\N}} \
25808 suffices for one known case.
25810 During the expansion of this option the &$item$& variable will have the
25811 server's EHLO response.
25813 For TLS-on-connect connections we do not have an EHLO
25814 response to use. Because of this the default value of this option is
25815 set to a static string for those cases, meaning that resumption will
25816 always be attempted if permitted by the &%tls_resumption_hosts%& option.
25818 The result of the option expansion is included in the key used to store and
25819 retrieve the TLS session, for session resumption.
25821 Operators of high-load sites may wish to evaluate their logs for indications
25822 of other destination sites operating load-balancers, and develop a suitable
25823 expression for this option.
25824 The smtp:ehlo event and the &$tls_out_resumption$& variable
25825 will be useful for such work.
25827 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
25828 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
25829 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
25830 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
25831 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
25832 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
25834 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
25835 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
25836 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
25837 &%hosts_override%& is set.
25839 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
25840 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
25841 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
25842 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25843 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25844 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
25845 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
25847 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
25848 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
25849 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
25850 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
25851 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
25852 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
25853 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
25856 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
25857 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
25860 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25861 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
25862 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
25863 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
25864 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25865 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
25866 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
25867 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
25868 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
25869 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
25872 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
25873 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25874 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
25875 Exim will not use the ESMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
25876 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
25878 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
25879 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
25880 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
25881 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
25882 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
25883 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
25885 The retry hints database is used for the record,
25886 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
25887 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
25888 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
25889 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
25891 See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
25894 When the facility is used, if the transport &%interface%& option is unset
25895 the &%helo_data%& option
25896 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
25898 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
25899 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
25900 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
25901 You have been warned.
25904 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25905 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25906 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25907 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25909 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25910 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25911 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
25912 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
25913 to any host that matches this list.
25916 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
25917 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25918 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
25919 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
25920 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
25921 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
25922 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
25923 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
25926 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
25927 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
25928 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
25933 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25934 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25935 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25936 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25937 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
25938 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25939 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
25940 explanation of when this might be needed.
25942 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25943 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25944 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25945 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25946 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
25947 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25948 message on the same session.
25950 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
25951 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
25952 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
25953 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
25954 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
25955 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
25960 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
25961 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
25962 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
25963 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
25964 &%fallback_hosts%&.
25967 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
25968 .cindex "randomized host list"
25969 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
25970 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
25971 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
25972 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
25973 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
25974 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
25975 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
25976 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
25978 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
25979 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
25980 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
25981 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
25983 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
25985 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
25986 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
25987 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
25989 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25990 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
25991 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
25992 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
25993 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
25994 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
25995 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
25996 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
25997 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
26000 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" "see below"
26001 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
26002 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
26003 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
26004 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
26006 The default is &"**"& if DANE is not in use for the connection,
26007 or if DANE-TA us used.
26008 It is empty if DANE-EE is used.
26010 .option hosts_require_alpn smtp "host list&!!" unset
26011 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in client"
26013 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
26014 If the TLS library supports ALPN
26015 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any host
26016 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
26017 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
26019 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
26020 managed by this option; see &%hosts_require_tls%&.
26022 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
26023 .cindex DANE "transport options"
26024 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
26025 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
26026 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
26027 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
26028 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
26029 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
26030 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
26032 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
26033 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
26034 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
26035 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
26036 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
26038 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26039 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
26040 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
26041 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26042 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
26043 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
26045 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
26046 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
26047 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
26048 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
26049 connects. If authentication fails
26050 and &%hosts_require_auth%& permits,
26051 Exim will try to transfer the message unauthenticated.
26052 See also chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
26054 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
26055 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
26056 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
26057 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
26058 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
26059 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
26060 Unless DKIM signing is being done,
26061 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
26063 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
26064 .cindex DANE "transport options"
26065 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
26066 If built with DANE support, Exim will look up a
26067 TLSA record for any host matching the list,
26068 If one is found and that lookup was DNSSEC-validated,
26069 then Exim requires that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made for that host;
26070 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
26071 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
26072 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
26074 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
26075 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
26076 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
26077 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
26078 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
26079 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
26080 perform a TCP Fast Open (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7413,RFC 7413).
26081 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
26082 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
26083 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
26085 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
26086 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
26088 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
26089 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
26090 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
26091 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
26092 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
26094 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
26095 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
26096 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
26097 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
26098 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
26099 for multi-recipient messages.
26100 The option can usually be left as default.
26102 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
26103 .cindex "bind IP address"
26104 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
26106 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26107 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
26108 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
26109 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
26110 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
26111 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
26112 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
26113 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
26116 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
26117 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
26118 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
26119 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
26120 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
26121 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
26124 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
26126 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
26127 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
26128 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
26129 interface to use if the host has more than one.
26132 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
26133 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
26134 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
26135 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
26136 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
26137 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
26138 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
26139 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
26140 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
26141 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
26145 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
26146 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
26147 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
26148 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
26149 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
26151 .option max_rcpt smtp integer&!! 100
26152 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
26155 limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
26156 SMTP message transaction.
26157 A value setting of zero disables the limit.
26159 If a constant is given,
26160 each set of addresses is treated independently, and
26161 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
26164 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
26165 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTMAX value,
26166 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
26167 that value also constrains the result of this option
26168 and no parallel connections will be caused on meeting the RCPTMAX limit.
26171 .option message_linelength_limit smtp integer 998
26172 .cindex "line length" limit
26173 This option sets the maximum line length, in bytes, that the transport
26174 will send. Any messages with lines exceeding the given value
26175 (before a transport filter, if any)
26176 will fail and a failure-DSN ("bounce") message will if possible be returned
26178 The default value is that defined by the SMTP standards.
26180 It is generally wise to also check in the data ACL so that messages
26181 received via SMTP can be refused without producing a bounce.
26184 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
26185 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26186 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
26187 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
26188 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
26189 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
26190 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
26191 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
26193 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
26194 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
26195 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
26197 If the connection is DANE-enabled then this option is ignored;
26198 only messages having the domain used for the DANE TLSA lookup are
26199 sent on the connection.
26201 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
26202 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTDOMAINMAX value,
26203 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
26204 this option is regarded as being false.
26207 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
26208 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
26209 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
26210 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
26211 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
26212 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
26213 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
26214 variable that contains an outgoing port.
26216 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
26217 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
26219 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
26220 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
26221 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
26224 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
26225 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
26229 .option protocol smtp string smtp
26230 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
26231 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
26232 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
26234 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
26235 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
26237 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2033,RFC 2033)) instead of SMTP.
26238 This protocol is sometimes used for local
26239 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
26240 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
26242 &*Note*&: When using LMTP it should be considered whether the default values
26243 for some other features, such as DANE, are appropriate.
26245 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
26246 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
26247 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
26248 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
26249 but as of &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314) it is preferred
26250 over STARTTLS for message submission
26251 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
26254 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
26255 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
26256 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
26257 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
26258 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
26259 addresses is not affected.
26261 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
26262 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
26263 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
26264 Exim to use only the host name.
26265 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
26268 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26269 .cindex "serializing connections"
26270 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
26271 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
26272 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
26273 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
26274 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
26275 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
26276 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
26278 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
26279 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
26280 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
26281 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
26282 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
26283 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
26285 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
26286 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
26287 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
26288 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
26289 are used for ETRN serialization.
26291 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
26294 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
26295 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
26296 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
26297 .cindex "size" "of message"
26298 .cindex "transport" "filter"
26299 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
26300 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
26301 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
26302 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
26303 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
26304 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
26305 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
26307 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
26308 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
26311 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
26312 .cindex proxy SOCKS
26313 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
26314 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
26317 .option tls_alpn smtp string&!! unset
26318 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
26320 .cindex ALPN "set name in client"
26321 If this option is set
26322 and the TLS library supports ALPN,
26323 the value given is used.
26325 As of writing no value has been standardised for email use.
26326 The authors suggest using &"smtp"&.
26330 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
26331 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
26332 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
26334 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26335 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26336 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
26337 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
26338 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
26341 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
26342 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
26343 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
26344 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
26348 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
26349 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
26350 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
26351 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
26352 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
26355 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
26356 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
26357 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
26358 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
26359 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
26360 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
26363 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
26366 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
26367 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
26369 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26370 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26371 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
26372 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
26373 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26374 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
26375 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
26376 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26379 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
26380 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
26381 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
26383 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26384 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
26385 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
26386 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
26387 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26388 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
26389 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
26390 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
26391 ciphers is a preference order.
26394 .option tls_resumption_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26395 .cindex TLS resumption
26396 This option controls which connections to use the TLS resumption feature.
26397 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
26401 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
26402 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26404 .cindex SNI "setting in client"
26405 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
26406 If this option is set
26407 and the connection is not DANE-validated
26408 then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
26409 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
26410 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
26411 certificate and private key for the session.
26413 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
26415 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
26421 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
26422 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
26423 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
26424 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
26425 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
26426 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
26427 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
26428 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
26429 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26430 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26434 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
26435 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26436 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26437 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26438 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
26439 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26440 Note that unless the host is in this list
26441 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
26442 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
26443 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
26444 certificate verification succeeds.
26447 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
26448 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
26449 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26450 This option give a list of hosts for which,
26451 while verifying the server certificate,
26452 checks will be included on the host name
26453 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
26454 versus the Subject-Alternate-Name (or, if none, Subject-Name) fields.
26455 Wildcard names are permitted,
26456 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
26458 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
26461 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
26462 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26463 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26465 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26466 The value of this option must be either the
26468 or the absolute path to
26469 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
26470 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
26472 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
26473 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
26474 is taken as empty and an explicit location
26477 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
26478 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
26480 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
26482 either by file or directory
26483 are added to those given by the system default location.
26485 The values of &$host$& and
26486 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26487 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26489 For back-compatibility,
26490 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
26491 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
26492 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
26495 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26496 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26497 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26498 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26499 certificate verification must succeed.
26500 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26501 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
26502 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
26503 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
26504 that connections use TLS.
26505 Fallback to in-clear communication will be done unless restricted by
26506 the &%hosts_require_tls%& option.
26508 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer&!! -1
26509 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
26510 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
26511 If built with internationalization support,
26512 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
26514 If, after expansion, the value is 1, 0, or -1 then this value overrides
26515 any value previously set for the message. Otherwise, any previously
26516 set value is used. To permit use of a previous value,
26517 set this option to an empty string.
26518 For details on the values see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
26523 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
26525 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
26526 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
26527 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
26528 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
26529 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
26532 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
26533 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
26534 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
26535 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
26538 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
26539 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
26540 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
26542 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
26543 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
26544 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
26545 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
26546 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
26548 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
26549 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
26550 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
26551 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
26552 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
26553 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
26554 see below for an exception).
26556 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
26557 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
26558 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
26559 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
26560 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
26562 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
26563 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
26564 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
26565 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
26566 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
26567 reached their retry times.
26569 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
26570 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
26571 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
26572 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
26573 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
26574 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
26575 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
26576 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
26577 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
26578 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
26581 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
26582 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
26583 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
26584 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
26585 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
26586 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
26588 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
26589 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
26590 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
26591 possible IP addresses have been tried.
26592 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
26593 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
26599 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26600 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26602 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
26603 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
26604 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
26605 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
26606 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
26607 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
26609 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
26610 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
26611 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26612 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
26613 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
26614 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
26615 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
26617 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
26618 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
26619 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
26620 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
26623 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
26624 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
26625 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
26626 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
26628 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
26629 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
26630 facility; you do not have to use it.
26632 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
26633 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
26634 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
26635 address to which it applies.
26637 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
26638 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
26639 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
26640 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
26641 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
26642 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
26645 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
26646 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
26647 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
26648 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
26651 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
26652 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
26653 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
26654 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
26655 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
26658 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
26659 illustrated by these examples:
26662 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
26663 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
26664 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
26665 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
26667 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
26668 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
26673 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
26674 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
26675 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
26676 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
26677 message's processing.
26679 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26680 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
26681 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&), but no
26682 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
26683 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
26684 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
26685 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
26686 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
26687 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
26689 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26690 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26691 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
26692 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
26693 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
26694 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
26695 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
26696 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
26697 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
26698 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
26700 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
26701 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
26702 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
26703 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
26704 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
26705 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
26707 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
26708 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
26709 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
26711 .cindex "envelope from"
26712 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
26713 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
26714 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
26715 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
26716 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
26717 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
26718 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
26719 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
26720 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
26722 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
26723 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
26729 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
26730 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
26731 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
26732 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
26733 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
26734 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full
26735 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
26736 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
26737 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
26738 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
26739 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
26741 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
26743 might produce the output
26745 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26746 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26747 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26748 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26749 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26750 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26751 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26752 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26754 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
26755 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
26756 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
26757 set for a particular transport.
26760 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
26761 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
26762 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
26765 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
26767 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
26768 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
26769 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
26770 any colons must be doubled, of course).
26772 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
26773 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
26774 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
26775 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
26778 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
26779 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
26780 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
26782 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
26783 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
26784 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
26785 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
26786 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
26787 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
26788 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
26790 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26791 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26792 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
26793 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
26794 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
26798 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
26799 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26802 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
26803 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
26804 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
26805 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
26806 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
26807 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
26808 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
26809 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
26810 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
26812 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
26813 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
26814 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
26816 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
26817 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
26818 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
26819 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
26820 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
26821 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
26822 of pattern they are set as follows:
26825 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
26826 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
26827 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
26830 *queen@*.fict.example
26832 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
26834 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
26838 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
26839 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
26842 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
26843 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
26844 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
26845 rewriting rule of the form
26847 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
26849 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
26855 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
26856 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
26857 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
26858 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
26859 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
26863 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
26864 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
26865 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
26866 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
26867 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
26869 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
26871 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
26874 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26875 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26876 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
26877 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
26878 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26879 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
26880 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
26881 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
26882 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
26883 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
26884 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
26885 entry written to the panic log.
26889 .subsection "Rewriting flags" "SSECID153"
26890 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
26893 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
26896 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
26898 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
26901 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
26902 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
26906 .subsection "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
26908 .cindex rewriting flags
26909 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
26910 &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
26911 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
26912 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
26913 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
26915 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
26916 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
26917 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
26918 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
26919 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
26920 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
26921 &`h`& rewrite all headers
26922 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
26923 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
26924 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
26926 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
26927 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
26928 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
26930 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
26931 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
26934 .subsection "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" SSECTrewriteS
26935 .cindex SMTP "rewriting malformed addresses"
26936 .cindex RCPT "rewriting argument of"
26937 .cindex MAIL "rewriting argument of"
26938 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
26939 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
26940 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
26941 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
26942 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
26944 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26945 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26946 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
26947 compliant with RFCs
26948 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,2821) and
26949 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,2822)
26950 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
26951 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
26952 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
26953 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
26954 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
26957 .subsection "Flags controlling the rewriting process" SSECID155
26958 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
26959 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
26960 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
26963 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
26964 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
26965 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
26967 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
26968 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
26969 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
26970 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
26972 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
26973 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
26974 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
26976 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
26977 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
26978 to the working part of the address, with any comments and
26979 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
26980 &"phrase"& left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
26982 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
26986 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
26989 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
26990 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
26991 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
26992 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete
26993 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
26994 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
26995 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
26996 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to
26997 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047). The character set
26998 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
27000 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
27001 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
27005 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
27006 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
27008 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
27009 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
27010 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
27012 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
27013 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
27014 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
27015 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
27016 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
27017 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
27018 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
27019 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
27021 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
27022 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
27024 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
27026 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
27027 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
27029 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
27030 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
27031 messages that originate outside the local host:
27033 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
27034 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
27036 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
27039 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
27040 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
27041 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
27042 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
27043 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
27044 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
27045 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
27046 components. For example, the rule
27048 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
27050 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
27051 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
27052 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
27053 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
27054 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
27055 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
27056 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
27063 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27064 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27066 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
27067 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
27068 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
27069 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
27070 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
27071 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
27072 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
27073 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
27074 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
27075 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
27076 address, domain and error.
27078 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
27079 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
27080 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
27081 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
27082 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
27083 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
27084 log selector is set, the message
27085 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
27086 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
27087 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
27088 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
27090 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
27091 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
27092 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
27093 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
27094 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
27095 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
27096 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
27097 domain are maintained independently.
27099 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
27100 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
27101 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
27102 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
27103 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
27104 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
27105 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
27106 the local address is reached.
27108 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
27109 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
27110 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
27111 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
27112 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
27114 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
27115 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
27116 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
27117 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
27118 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
27119 messages that it should now be retaining.
27123 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
27124 .cindex "retry" "rules"
27125 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
27126 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
27127 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
27128 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
27129 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
27130 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
27131 message's sender, respectively.
27134 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
27135 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
27136 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
27137 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
27138 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
27139 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
27142 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27144 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
27147 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27149 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
27150 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
27153 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
27154 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
27155 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
27156 expressions work in address lists.
27158 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
27159 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
27163 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
27164 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
27165 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
27166 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
27167 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
27168 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
27169 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
27170 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
27171 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
27173 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
27174 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
27175 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
27176 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
27179 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
27180 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
27181 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
27182 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
27183 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
27184 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
27185 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
27186 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
27187 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
27188 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
27193 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
27195 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
27196 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
27197 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
27198 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
27199 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
27200 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
27202 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
27206 and the retry rules are
27208 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
27209 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
27211 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
27212 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
27213 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
27214 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
27215 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
27216 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
27218 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
27219 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
27220 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
27221 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
27223 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
27224 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
27225 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
27227 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
27229 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
27230 textual form of the IP address.
27232 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
27233 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
27234 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
27235 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
27238 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
27239 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
27240 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
27242 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
27243 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
27244 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
27246 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
27247 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
27249 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
27250 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
27253 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
27254 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
27255 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
27256 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
27257 retry rule of this form:
27259 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
27261 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
27262 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
27265 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
27266 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
27267 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
27268 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
27271 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
27272 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
27273 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
27274 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
27275 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
27277 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
27278 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
27280 .vitem &%refused_A%&
27281 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
27284 A connection was refused.
27286 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
27287 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
27289 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
27290 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
27292 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
27293 A connection attempt timed out.
27295 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
27296 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
27297 obtained from an MX record.
27299 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
27300 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
27301 obtained from an MX record.
27304 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
27306 .vitem &%tls_required%&
27307 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
27308 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
27309 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
27312 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27315 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
27316 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
27317 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
27318 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27319 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
27320 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
27324 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
27325 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
27326 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
27327 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
27328 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
27332 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
27333 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
27334 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
27336 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
27337 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
27338 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
27339 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
27340 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
27341 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
27342 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
27344 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
27345 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
27348 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
27349 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
27350 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
27355 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
27356 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
27357 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
27358 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
27359 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
27362 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
27364 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
27366 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
27368 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
27369 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
27372 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
27374 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
27375 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
27376 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
27377 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
27378 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
27380 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
27381 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
27383 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
27385 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
27386 list is never matched.
27392 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
27393 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
27394 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
27395 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
27397 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
27399 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
27400 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
27401 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
27402 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
27403 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
27405 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
27406 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
27407 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
27408 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
27409 The available algorithms are:
27412 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
27415 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
27416 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
27417 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
27419 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
27420 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
27421 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
27422 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
27423 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
27424 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
27425 queue processing times.
27428 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
27429 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
27430 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
27431 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
27432 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
27433 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
27434 interval is found. The main configuration variable
27435 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
27436 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
27437 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
27438 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
27439 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
27441 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
27442 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
27443 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
27444 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
27445 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
27446 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
27449 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
27450 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
27451 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
27452 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
27453 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
27454 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
27455 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
27456 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
27457 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
27458 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
27459 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
27460 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
27462 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
27463 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
27464 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
27465 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
27466 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
27467 deliveries that have been deferred.
27470 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
27471 Here are some example retry rules:
27473 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
27474 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
27475 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
27476 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27477 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
27478 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
27480 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
27481 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
27482 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
27483 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
27484 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
27485 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
27486 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
27489 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
27490 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
27491 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
27492 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
27493 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
27495 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
27496 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
27497 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
27498 were not obtained from an MX record.
27500 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
27501 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
27502 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
27503 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
27504 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
27508 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
27509 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
27510 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
27511 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
27512 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
27513 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
27514 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
27515 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
27516 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
27517 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
27518 failing for the first time.
27520 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
27521 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
27522 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
27523 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
27525 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
27526 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
27527 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
27532 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
27533 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
27534 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
27535 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
27536 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
27537 default retry rule:
27539 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
27541 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
27542 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
27543 failure for the recipient address that counts.
27545 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
27546 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
27547 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
27548 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
27549 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
27551 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
27552 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
27553 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
27555 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
27556 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
27557 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
27558 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
27559 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
27560 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
27561 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
27562 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
27563 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
27564 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
27565 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
27567 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
27568 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
27569 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
27570 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
27571 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
27574 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
27575 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
27576 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
27577 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
27578 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
27579 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
27580 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
27581 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
27582 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
27585 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
27586 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
27587 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
27588 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
27589 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
27590 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
27591 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
27592 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
27595 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
27596 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
27597 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
27598 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
27599 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
27600 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
27601 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
27602 time out the address.
27604 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
27605 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
27606 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
27607 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
27608 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
27609 considered immediately.
27610 .ecindex IIDretconf1
27611 .ecindex IIDregconf2
27618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27621 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
27622 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
27623 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
27624 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
27625 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
27627 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2554,RFC 2554),
27628 which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
27629 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
27630 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
27631 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
27634 The name of an authenticator is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
27635 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
27638 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
27639 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
27640 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
27643 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
27644 the client's EHLO command.
27646 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
27647 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
27649 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
27650 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
27651 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
27652 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
27653 with the AUTH command.
27655 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
27657 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
27658 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
27659 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27662 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
27663 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
27664 unauthenticated connection.
27667 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
27668 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
27669 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
27670 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
27672 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
27673 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
27674 &`Connected to server.example.`&
27675 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
27676 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
27677 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
27678 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
27679 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
27684 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
27685 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
27686 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
27687 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
27688 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
27689 included by setting
27692 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
27696 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
27701 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
27702 authentication mechanism
27703 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2195,RFC 2195)),
27704 and the second provides an interface to the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
27705 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
27706 work via a socket interface.
27707 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
27708 as defined by &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4422,RFC 4422) Appendix A.
27709 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
27710 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
27711 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
27712 supporting setting a server keytab.
27713 The seventh can be configured to support
27714 the PLAIN authentication mechanism
27715 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2595,RFC 2595))
27716 or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
27717 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
27718 The eighth authenticator
27719 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
27720 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
27721 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
27723 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
27724 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
27725 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
27726 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
27727 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
27728 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
27729 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
27731 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
27732 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
27733 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
27734 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
27735 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
27736 both sets of options, is required. For example:
27740 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27741 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
27743 client_secret = secret2
27745 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
27746 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
27748 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
27749 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
27750 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
27753 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
27754 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
27755 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
27756 authenticating data.
27758 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
27759 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
27760 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
27761 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
27762 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
27763 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
27764 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
27765 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
27766 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
27767 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
27770 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
27771 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
27772 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
27773 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
27777 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
27778 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
27779 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
27781 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27782 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
27783 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
27784 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
27785 encrypted by a setting such as:
27787 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27791 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27792 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
27793 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
27794 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
27797 .option driver authenticators string unset
27798 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
27799 authenticators is to be used.
27802 .option public_name authenticators string unset
27803 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
27804 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
27805 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens
27806 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2222,RFC 2222)),
27807 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
27808 defaults to the driver's instance name.
27811 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27812 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
27813 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
27814 mechanism is not advertised.
27815 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
27816 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
27817 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
27820 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27821 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
27822 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
27825 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
27826 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
27828 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
27829 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
27830 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
27831 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
27832 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
27833 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
27834 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27835 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
27836 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
27840 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
27841 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
27842 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
27843 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
27844 out the values of variables.
27845 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
27846 output, and Exim carries on processing.
27849 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27850 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27851 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
27852 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
27853 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
27854 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
27855 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
27856 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
27857 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
27858 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
27859 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
27860 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
27863 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27864 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
27865 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
27866 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
27867 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
27868 remembered for later use.
27869 How it is used is described in the following section.
27875 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
27876 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
27877 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27878 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
27879 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
27883 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
27884 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
27886 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
27888 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
27889 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
27890 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
27891 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
27892 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
27893 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
27894 given for the MAIL command.
27896 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
27897 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
27900 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
27901 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
27902 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
27903 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
27904 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
27905 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
27906 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
27911 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
27912 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
27913 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
27914 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
27916 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
27917 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
27918 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
27919 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
27920 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
27925 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
27926 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
27927 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
27928 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
27932 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
27934 If the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
27935 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
27938 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
27939 the mechanisms are advertised.
27941 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
27942 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
27943 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
27944 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
27945 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
27946 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
27947 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
27949 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
27951 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
27953 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
27954 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
27955 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
27958 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
27960 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27961 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
27962 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
27964 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
27965 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
27966 command. This is the case if
27969 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
27971 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
27973 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
27974 server authenticators.
27978 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
27979 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
27980 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
27982 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
27983 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
27984 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
27985 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
27986 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
27987 rejected with a 504 error.
27989 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
27990 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
27991 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
27992 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
27993 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
27994 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
27995 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
27996 no successful authentication.
27998 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
27999 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
28000 &%authresults%& expansion item.
28002 .cindex authentication "failure event, server"
28003 If an authenticator is run and does not succeed,
28004 an event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "auth:fail" is raised.
28005 While the event is being processed the variables
28006 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
28007 and &$authenticated_fail_id$& (as set by the authenticator &%server_set_id%& option)
28009 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged
28010 instead of the default log line.
28011 See <<CHAPevents>> for details on events.
28014 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
28015 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
28016 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
28017 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
28018 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
28019 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
28020 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
28024 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
28026 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
28027 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
28028 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
28029 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
28030 command line to run this script on such data might be
28032 encode '\0user\0password'
28034 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
28035 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
28036 whose code value is zero.
28038 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
28039 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
28040 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
28041 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
28043 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
28044 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
28045 example, a command such as
28047 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
28049 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
28051 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to produce
28052 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
28054 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
28056 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
28057 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
28058 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
28059 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
28063 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
28064 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
28065 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
28066 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
28067 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
28068 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
28071 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
28072 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
28073 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
28074 of the authenticator.
28077 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28078 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
28079 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
28080 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
28081 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
28082 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
28083 delivery to be deferred.
28085 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
28086 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
28087 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
28091 .cindex authentication "failure event, client"
28092 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code),
28093 an event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "auth:fail" is raised.
28094 While the event is being processed the variable
28095 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
28097 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged.
28098 See <<CHAPevents>> for details on events.
28101 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
28102 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
28103 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
28104 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
28105 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
28106 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
28107 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
28108 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
28109 deliver the message unauthenticated.
28112 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
28113 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
28114 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
28115 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
28116 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
28117 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
28118 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
28119 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
28121 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
28123 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
28124 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
28125 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
28126 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
28127 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
28128 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
28129 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
28130 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
28131 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
28132 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
28133 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
28134 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
28135 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
28142 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28143 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28145 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
28146 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
28147 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
28148 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
28149 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
28150 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
28151 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
28152 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
28153 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
28154 connections as you do for login accounts.
28156 .section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
28157 The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
28158 TLS is not being used:
28160 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
28161 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
28164 &*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
28165 but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
28166 (including their names) have been properly verified.
28168 .section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
28169 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
28170 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
28172 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
28173 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
28174 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
28176 .option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
28177 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
28178 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
28181 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
28182 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28183 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28184 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
28185 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28186 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28187 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28189 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
28190 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
28191 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
28192 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
28193 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
28194 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
28195 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
28197 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
28198 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
28199 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
28200 string expansions that also use them for other things.
28202 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
28203 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
28204 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
28206 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28207 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
28208 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28209 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28210 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28211 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28212 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28213 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28214 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28215 string as the error text.
28217 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
28218 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
28219 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
28223 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
28224 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
28225 .cindex authentication PLAIN
28226 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28227 The PLAIN authentication mechanism
28228 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2595,RFC 2595))
28229 specifies that three strings be
28230 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
28231 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
28232 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
28234 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
28235 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
28236 configured as follows:
28240 public_name = PLAIN
28242 server_condition = \
28243 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
28244 server_set_id = $auth2
28246 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
28247 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
28248 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
28249 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
28251 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
28252 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
28253 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
28254 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
28258 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
28260 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
28262 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
28263 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
28267 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
28268 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
28270 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
28271 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
28272 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
28273 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
28274 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
28276 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
28277 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
28278 authenticating clients it could make sense.
28280 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
28281 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
28282 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
28283 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
28284 This is an incorrect example:
28286 server_condition = \
28287 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
28289 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
28290 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
28291 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
28292 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
28293 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
28294 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
28295 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
28297 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
28298 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
28300 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
28301 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
28302 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
28303 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
28304 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
28307 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
28308 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
28309 .cindex authentication LOGIN
28310 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
28311 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
28312 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
28313 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
28317 public_name = LOGIN
28318 server_prompts = User Name : Password
28319 server_condition = \
28320 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
28321 server_set_id = $auth1
28323 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
28324 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
28325 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
28326 strings are used to obtain two data items.
28328 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
28329 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
28330 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
28331 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
28332 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
28336 public_name = LOGIN
28337 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
28338 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
28341 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
28342 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
28343 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
28344 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
28346 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
28347 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
28348 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
28349 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
28350 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
28351 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
28352 uninterpreted string.
28355 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
28356 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
28357 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
28358 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
28359 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
28365 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
28366 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
28367 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
28369 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
28370 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
28371 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
28372 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
28375 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
28376 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
28377 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
28378 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
28379 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
28380 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
28381 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
28382 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
28383 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
28384 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
28385 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
28386 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
28388 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
28389 splitting takes priority and happens first.
28391 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
28392 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
28393 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
28394 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
28397 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
28398 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
28402 public_name = PLAIN
28403 client_send = ^username^mysecret
28405 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
28406 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs.
28407 Note that due to the ambiguity of parsing three consectutive circumflex characters
28408 there is no way to provide a password having a leading circumflex.
28412 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
28416 public_name = LOGIN
28417 client_send = : username : mysecret
28419 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
28420 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
28422 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
28423 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
28428 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28429 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28431 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
28432 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28433 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
28434 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
28435 .cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
28436 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in
28437 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2195,RFC 2195). The server
28438 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
28439 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
28440 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
28441 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
28442 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
28443 available in plain text at either end.
28446 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
28447 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
28448 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
28449 authenticator as a server:
28451 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28452 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28453 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
28454 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
28455 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
28456 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
28457 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
28458 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
28459 returned to the client.
28461 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
28462 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
28463 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
28464 numeric variables for other things.
28466 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
28467 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
28468 user name, authentication fails.
28472 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28473 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
28474 server_set_id = $auth1
28476 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28477 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
28478 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
28479 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
28483 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28484 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
28486 server_set_id = $auth1
28488 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
28489 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
28491 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
28492 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
28493 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
28498 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28499 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
28500 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28501 server_set_id = $auth1
28504 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
28505 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
28506 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
28510 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
28511 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
28512 computing the response to the server's challenge.
28515 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28516 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
28517 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
28521 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28522 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
28523 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
28524 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
28525 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
28526 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
28527 send the message to the current server.
28529 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
28534 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28536 client_secret = secret
28538 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
28539 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
28543 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28544 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28546 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
28547 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
28548 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
28549 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
28551 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
28552 at A L Digital Ltd.
28554 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
28555 library implementation of the
28556 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2222,RFC 2222)
28557 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
28558 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
28559 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
28560 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
28562 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
28563 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
28564 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
28565 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
28567 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
28568 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
28569 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
28570 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
28571 depending on the driver you are using.
28573 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
28574 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
28575 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
28576 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
28577 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
28580 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
28581 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
28582 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
28583 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
28584 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
28585 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
28586 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
28587 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
28590 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
28591 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
28592 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
28593 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
28594 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
28595 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
28599 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
28600 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28601 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
28602 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
28605 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
28606 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28607 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28608 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28612 driver = cyrus_sasl
28613 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28614 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28615 server_set_id = $auth1
28618 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
28619 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28622 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
28623 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28626 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
28627 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
28628 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
28629 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
28632 driver = cyrus_sasl
28633 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28634 server_set_id = $auth1
28637 driver = cyrus_sasl
28638 public_name = PLAIN
28639 server_set_id = $auth2
28641 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
28642 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
28643 but it is present in many binary distributions.
28644 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
28645 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
28650 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28651 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28652 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
28653 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
28654 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
28655 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
28656 Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
28657 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
28658 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
28659 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
28660 authenticator only. There is only one non-generic option:
28662 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
28664 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
28665 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
28666 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
28667 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
28671 public_name = PLAIN
28672 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher}
28673 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28674 server_set_id = $auth1
28679 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28680 server_set_id = $auth1
28683 &*Note*&: plaintext authentication methods such as PLAIN and LOGIN
28684 should not be advertised on cleartext SMTP connections.
28685 See the discussion in section &<<SECTplain_TLS>>&.
28687 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
28688 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
28689 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
28690 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
28691 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
28692 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
28694 The Dovecot configuration to match the above will look
28697 conf.d/10-master.conf :-
28702 unix_listener auth-client {
28709 conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
28711 auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
28714 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
28715 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
28718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28720 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
28721 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
28722 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
28723 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
28724 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
28725 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28726 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28727 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
28728 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
28729 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
28730 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
28731 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
28732 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
28733 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
28734 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
28735 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
28736 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
28737 without code changes in Exim.
28739 The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
28740 realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
28741 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
28744 To see the list of mechanisms supported by the library run Exim with "auth" debug
28745 enabled and look for a line containing "GNU SASL supports".
28746 Note however that some may not have been tested from Exim.
28749 .option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
28750 This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
28751 which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
28752 by &%client_username%& option.
28753 If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
28754 which is the common case.
28756 .option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28757 See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
28759 .option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
28760 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28761 the password to be used, in clear.
28763 .option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
28764 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28765 the account name to be used.
28768 .option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
28769 This option is only supported for library versions 1.9.1 and greater.
28770 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY will be defined when this is so.
28772 If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
28773 and correctly sized
28774 it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
28775 The value after expansion should be
28776 a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
28777 with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
28779 Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
28780 supplied by the server.
28781 The option is expanded before use.
28782 During the expansion &$auth1$& is set with the client username,
28783 &$auth2$& with the iteration count, and
28784 &$auth3$& with the salt.
28786 The intent of this option
28787 is to support clients that can cache thes salted password
28788 to save on recalculation costs.
28789 The cache lookup should return an unusable value
28790 (eg. an empty string)
28791 if the salt or iteration count has changed
28793 If the authentication succeeds then the above variables are set,
28794 .vindex "&$auth4$&"
28795 plus the calculated salted password value value in &$auth4$&,
28796 during the expansion of the &%client_set_id%& option.
28797 A side-effect of this expansion can be used to prime the cache.
28800 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28801 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
28802 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
28803 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
28804 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
28807 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
28808 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
28809 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
28812 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
28813 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
28814 When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
28816 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
28817 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
28818 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
28820 . However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
28821 . Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
28822 . with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
28824 This option was deprecated in previous releases due to doubts over
28825 the "Triple Handshake" vulnerability.
28826 Exim takes suitable precausions (requiring Extended Master Secret if TLS
28827 Session Resumption was used) for safety.
28830 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
28831 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28832 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28833 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28836 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
28837 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28838 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28839 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28844 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28845 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28846 server_set_id = $auth1
28850 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
28851 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
28852 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
28853 the password itself.
28855 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
28856 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
28857 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
28858 if available, else the empty string.
28859 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
28860 else the empty string.
28862 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
28864 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
28865 option to be simply "true".
28868 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
28869 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28870 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28873 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
28874 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28875 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28876 when this option is expanded.
28878 The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
28879 and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
28880 a compute cost factor imposed on the client
28881 (if it does not cache results, or the server changes
28882 either the iteration count or the salt).
28883 A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
28884 for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
28886 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
28887 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28888 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28889 when this option is expanded.
28890 The value should be a base64-encoded string,
28891 of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
28892 If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
28893 protocol conversation.
28896 .option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
28897 .option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
28898 These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
28899 to provide stored information related to a password,
28900 the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
28902 &%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
28903 &%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
28905 They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
28906 When this is so, the macros
28907 _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
28908 and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
28911 The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
28913 If set, the results of expansion should for each
28914 should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
28915 of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
28916 &%server_password%& option.
28917 If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
28919 The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
28920 to generate these values.
28923 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
28924 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28925 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28928 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
28929 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28930 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
28931 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
28933 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
28934 meanings for these variables:
28937 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28938 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
28940 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28941 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
28943 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
28944 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
28947 On a per-mechanism basis:
28950 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28951 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
28952 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28954 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28955 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
28956 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28958 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28959 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
28960 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
28961 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28964 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
28965 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
28966 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
28969 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
28970 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
28972 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
28974 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28975 server_realm = imap.example.org
28976 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
28977 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28978 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
28979 server_condition = yes
28983 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28984 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28986 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
28987 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
28988 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
28989 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28990 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
28991 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
28992 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
28995 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
28996 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
28997 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
28998 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
29000 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
29001 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
29002 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
29003 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
29005 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
29006 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
29007 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
29011 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
29012 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
29013 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
29014 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
29016 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
29017 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
29018 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
29019 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
29021 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
29023 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
29024 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
29026 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
29027 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
29028 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
29033 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29034 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29036 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
29037 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
29038 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
29039 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
29040 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
29041 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
29042 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
29043 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
29044 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
29045 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
29046 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
29047 taken from the &url(https://www.samba.org/,Samba project). The code for the
29048 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
29052 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
29053 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
29055 The server sends back a challenge.
29057 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
29058 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
29061 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
29065 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
29066 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
29067 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
29069 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
29070 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
29071 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
29072 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
29073 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
29074 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
29075 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
29076 for other things. For example:
29081 server_password = \
29082 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
29084 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29085 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29091 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
29092 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
29093 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
29097 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
29098 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
29101 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
29102 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
29105 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
29106 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
29107 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
29113 client_username = msn/msn_username
29114 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
29115 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
29117 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
29118 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
29124 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29125 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29127 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
29128 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
29129 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
29130 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
29131 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
29132 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
29133 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
29134 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
29135 The specification is in
29136 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422,RFC 4422) Appendix A.
29137 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
29138 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
29139 by the server configuration.
29141 The client presents an identity in-clear.
29142 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
29143 and for clients to only attempt,
29144 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
29146 One possible use, compatible with the
29147 &url(https://k9mail.github.io/,K-9 Mail Android client)
29148 is for using X509 client certificates.
29150 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
29151 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
29152 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
29153 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
29154 client certificates only.
29156 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
29157 client-certificate authentication is being done.
29159 The client must present a certificate,
29160 for which it must have been requested via the
29161 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
29162 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29163 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
29164 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
29166 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
29167 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
29168 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
29170 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
29171 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
29172 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29173 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
29174 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
29175 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29176 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29178 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
29180 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
29181 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29182 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
29183 "in &(external)& authenticator"
29184 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
29185 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29187 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
29188 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
29189 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
29190 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
29191 an identity for authentication and
29192 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
29194 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
29195 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
29196 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
29197 string expansions that also use them for other things.
29199 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29200 Once an identity has been received,
29201 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
29202 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
29203 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
29204 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
29205 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
29206 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
29207 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
29208 string as the error text.
29212 ext_ccert_san_mail:
29214 public_name = EXTERNAL
29216 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
29217 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29218 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29219 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
29220 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
29221 server_set_id = $auth1
29223 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29224 of your configured trust-anchors
29225 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29226 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
29228 &*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
29229 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29230 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29234 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
29235 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
29236 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
29238 .option client_send external string&!! unset
29239 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
29240 identity being asserted.
29246 public_name = EXTERNAL
29248 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
29249 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
29253 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
29254 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
29260 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29261 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29263 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
29264 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
29265 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
29266 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
29267 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
29268 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
29269 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
29270 authentication based on client certificates.
29272 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
29273 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
29274 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
29275 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
29276 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
29277 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
29279 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
29280 for which it must have been requested via the
29281 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
29282 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29284 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
29285 run immediately after a TLS connection being negotiated
29286 (due to either STARTTLS or TLS-on-connect)
29287 and can authenticate the connection.
29288 If it does, SMTP authentication is not subsequently offered.
29290 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
29293 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
29294 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
29296 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
29297 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
29298 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
29299 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
29300 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29301 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29303 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
29304 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
29305 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
29307 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
29314 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29315 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29316 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
29319 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
29320 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
29321 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
29323 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
29325 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29326 of your configured trust-anchors
29327 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29328 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
29330 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
29331 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29332 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29334 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
29336 . An alternative might use
29338 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
29340 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
29341 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
29342 . This would help for per-device use.
29344 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
29345 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
29347 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
29348 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
29351 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
29352 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
29353 a connect- or helo-ACL.
29357 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29358 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29360 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
29361 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
29362 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
29363 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
29364 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
29367 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
29368 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
29369 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
29370 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
29371 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
29372 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
29373 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
29374 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
29375 certificates are used.
29377 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3207,RFC 3207)
29378 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
29379 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
29380 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
29381 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
29382 between them is encrypted.
29384 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
29385 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
29386 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
29387 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
29390 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
29391 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
29392 in order to get TLS to work.
29396 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
29398 .cindex "submissions protocol"
29399 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
29400 .cindex "smtps protocol"
29401 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
29402 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
29403 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
29404 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
29406 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314),
29407 the common practice of using the historically
29408 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
29409 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
29410 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
29412 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
29413 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
29414 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
29416 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
29417 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
29418 reassigned for other use.
29419 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
29421 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
29422 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
29423 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
29425 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
29426 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
29427 the most common use is expected to be:
29429 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
29431 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
29432 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
29433 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
29434 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
29435 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
29438 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
29439 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
29446 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
29447 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
29448 TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
29449 To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
29455 To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
29461 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
29462 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
29464 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
29467 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
29468 cannot be the path of a directory
29469 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
29470 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
29472 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
29474 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29475 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
29476 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
29477 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with
29478 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2253,RFC 2253). This
29479 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
29481 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
29482 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
29483 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
29484 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
29485 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
29486 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
29487 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
29490 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
29491 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
29493 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
29494 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
29495 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
29496 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
29498 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option,
29499 it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
29501 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
29502 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
29503 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
29504 implementation, then patches are welcome.
29506 The output from "exim -bV" will show which (if any) support was included
29508 Also, the macro "_HAVE_OPENSSL" or "_HAVE_GNUTLS" will be defined.
29512 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
29513 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
29514 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
29515 but not the chosen filename.
29516 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
29517 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
29519 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
29520 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
29521 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
29522 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
29524 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
29525 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
29526 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
29527 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
29528 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
29529 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
29530 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
29532 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
29533 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
29534 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
29535 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
29536 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
29538 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
29539 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
29540 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
29541 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
29542 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
29543 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
29545 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
29546 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
29547 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
29549 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
29550 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
29551 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
29552 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
29555 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
29558 # chown exim:exim new-params
29559 # chmod 0600 new-params
29560 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
29561 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
29562 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
29563 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
29564 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
29565 # chmod 0400 new-params
29566 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
29568 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
29569 stalling is removed.
29571 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
29572 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
29573 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
29574 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
29575 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
29576 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
29577 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
29578 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
29579 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
29580 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
29581 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
29583 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
29584 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
29585 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
29586 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
29588 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
29589 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
29590 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
29591 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
29592 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
29595 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
29596 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
29597 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
29598 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
29599 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
29600 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
29601 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
29602 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
29603 directly to this function call.
29604 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
29605 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
29606 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
29607 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
29610 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
29612 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
29613 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
29614 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
29617 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
29618 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
29619 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
29623 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
29626 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
29627 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
29630 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
29631 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
29633 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
29634 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
29637 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
29638 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
29639 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
29640 not be moved to the end of the list.
29643 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
29646 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
29647 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
29650 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29651 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
29652 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
29653 choice of clients used:
29655 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
29656 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29661 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
29663 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
29666 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
29667 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
29668 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
29669 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
29671 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
29673 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
29677 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
29679 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
29680 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
29681 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
29682 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
29683 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
29684 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
29685 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
29686 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
29687 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
29688 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
29690 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
29691 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
29693 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
29694 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
29695 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
29696 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
29697 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
29698 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
29700 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
29701 "Priority strings". This is online as
29702 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
29703 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
29704 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
29705 then the example code
29706 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
29707 on that site can be used to test a given string.
29711 # Disable older versions of protocols
29712 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
29715 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
29716 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
29717 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
29719 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29720 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
29721 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
29722 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
29726 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29732 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
29733 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
29734 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29735 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
29736 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
29737 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
29738 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
29739 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
29741 If STARTTLS is to be used you
29742 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
29744 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
29745 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
29746 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
29749 554 Security failure
29751 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
29752 rejected with a 554 error code.
29754 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
29755 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
29757 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
29758 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
29759 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
29760 from someone able to intercept the communication.
29762 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
29764 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
29766 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
29767 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
29769 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
29770 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
29771 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
29772 that goes with it. These files need to be
29773 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
29774 always be given as full path names.
29775 The key must not be password-protected.
29776 They can be the same file if both the
29777 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
29778 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
29779 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
29780 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
29781 the server's certificate.
29783 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
29784 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
29785 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
29786 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
29787 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
29788 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
29790 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
29791 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
29792 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
29794 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
29795 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
29796 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
29799 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
29800 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
29801 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
29803 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
29805 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
29806 with the parameters contained in the file.
29807 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
29812 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
29813 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
29814 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
29815 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
29821 for a way of generating file data.
29823 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
29824 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
29825 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
29826 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
29827 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
29829 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29830 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29831 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
29832 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
29833 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
29834 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
29835 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
29836 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
29837 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
29839 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
29840 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
29841 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
29842 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
29843 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
29844 documentation for more details.
29846 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
29847 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
29850 .subsection "Requesting and verifying client certificates"
29851 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29852 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29853 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
29854 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
29855 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
29856 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
29857 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
29858 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
29859 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
29860 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
29861 an explicit file or,
29862 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
29863 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
29865 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
29868 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
29869 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
29870 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
29872 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
29874 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
29876 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
29877 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
29879 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
29880 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
29881 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
29882 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
29883 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
29884 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
29885 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
29886 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
29887 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
29888 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
29890 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29891 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
29892 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
29893 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
29895 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29896 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
29897 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
29898 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
29899 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
29900 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
29903 .subsection "Caching of static server configuration items" "SSECTserverTLScache"
29904 .cindex certificate caching
29905 .cindex privatekey caching
29906 .cindex crl caching
29907 .cindex ocsp caching
29908 .cindex ciphers caching
29909 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
29910 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
29911 .cindex tls_certificate caching
29912 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
29913 .cindex tls_crl caching
29914 .cindex tls_ocsp_file caching
29915 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
29916 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
29917 .cindex caching certificate
29918 .cindex caching privatekey
29919 .cindex caching crl
29920 .cindex caching ocsp
29921 .cindex caching ciphers
29922 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
29923 If any of the main configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&,
29924 &%tls_crl%& and &%tls_ocsp_file%& have values with no
29925 expandable elements,
29926 then the associated information is loaded at daemon startup.
29927 It is made available
29928 to child processes forked for handling received SMTP connections.
29930 This caching is currently only supported under Linux and FreeBSD.
29932 If caching is not possible, for example if an item has to be dependent
29933 on the peer host so contains a &$sender_host_name$& expansion, the load
29934 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
29936 The cache is invalidated and reloaded after any changes to the directories
29937 containing files specified by these options.
29939 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29940 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
29941 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
29942 The latter case is not automatically invalidated;
29943 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
29944 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
29945 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
29946 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
29948 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
29949 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
29951 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
29952 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
29958 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
29959 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29960 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29961 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29962 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
29963 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
29964 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
29965 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
29966 within the &(smtp)& transport.
29968 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29969 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
29970 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
29971 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
29972 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
29973 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
29975 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
29976 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
29977 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
29978 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
29979 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
29982 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
29983 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
29984 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
29985 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
29986 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
29987 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
29988 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
29989 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
29990 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
29991 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
29994 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
29995 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
29997 This is an optional thing for TLS connections, although either end
29999 If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
30000 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
30002 &*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
30003 for client use (they are usable for server use).
30004 As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
30005 in failed connections.
30007 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
30008 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
30010 the system default set (depending on library version),
30012 or (depending on library version) a directory.
30013 The client verifies the server's certificate
30014 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
30015 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
30016 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
30017 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
30019 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
30020 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
30021 or need not succeed respectively.
30023 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
30024 name checks are made on the server certificate.
30025 The match against this list is, as per other Exim usage, the
30026 IP for the host. That is most closely associated with the
30027 name on the DNS A (or AAAA) record for the host.
30028 However, the name that needs to be in the certificate
30029 is the one at the head of any CNAME chain leading to the A record.
30030 The option defaults to always checking.
30032 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
30033 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
30034 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
30036 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
30037 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
30038 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
30041 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
30042 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
30043 for OCSP to be relevant.
30046 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
30047 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
30048 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
30049 alternative hosts, if any.
30052 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
30053 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
30054 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
30058 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
30059 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
30060 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
30061 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
30062 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
30064 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
30065 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
30066 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
30067 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
30068 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
30069 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
30070 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
30071 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
30072 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
30073 outgoing connection.
30077 .subsection "Caching of static client configuration items" SECTclientTLScache
30078 .cindex certificate caching
30079 .cindex privatekey caching
30080 .cindex crl caching
30081 .cindex ciphers caching
30082 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
30083 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
30084 .cindex tls_certificate caching
30085 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
30086 .cindex tls_crl caching
30087 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
30088 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
30089 .cindex caching certificate
30090 .cindex caching privatekey
30091 .cindex caching crl
30092 .cindex caching ciphers
30093 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
30094 If any of the transport configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&
30095 and &%tls_crl%& have values with no
30096 expandable elements,
30097 then the associated information is loaded per smtp transport
30098 at daemon startup, at the start of a queue run, or on a
30099 command-line specified message delivery.
30100 It is made available
30101 to child processes forked for handling making SMTP connections.
30103 This caching is currently only supported under Linux.
30105 If caching is not possible, the load
30106 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
30108 The cache is invalidated in the daemon
30109 and reloaded after any changes to the directories
30110 containing files specified by these options.
30112 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
30113 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
30114 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
30115 The latter case is not automatically invaludated;
30116 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
30117 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
30118 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
30119 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
30121 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
30122 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
30124 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
30125 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
30131 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
30132 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
30135 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
30136 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
30137 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
30138 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
30139 extensions, documented in
30140 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6066,RFC 6066)
30141 (and before that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4366,RFC 4366)) is
30142 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
30143 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
30144 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
30147 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
30148 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
30151 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
30152 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
30153 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
30154 be of limited use in that environment.
30156 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
30157 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
30158 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
30159 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
30160 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
30162 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
30163 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
30164 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
30165 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
30166 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
30168 If DANE validated the connection attempt then the value of the &%tls_sni%& option
30169 is forced to the name of the destination host, after any MX- or CNAME-following.
30171 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
30172 received from a client.
30173 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
30175 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
30176 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
30177 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
30180 &%tls_certificate%&
30186 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
30191 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
30192 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
30193 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
30194 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
30195 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
30196 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
30197 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
30199 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
30202 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
30203 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
30204 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
30205 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
30207 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
30208 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
30209 built, then you have SNI support).
30213 .cindex ALPN "general information"
30214 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
30215 There is a TLS feature related to SNI
30216 called Application Layer Protocol Name (ALPN).
30217 This is intended to declare, or select, what protocol layer will be using a TLS
30219 The client for the connection proposes a set of protocol names, and
30220 the server responds with a selected one.
30221 It is not, as of 2021, commonly used for SMTP connections.
30222 However, to guard against misdirected or malicious use of web clients
30223 (which often do use ALPN) against MTA ports, Exim by default check that
30224 there is no incompatible ALPN specified by a client for a TLS connection.
30225 If there is, the connection is rejected.
30227 As a client Exim does not supply ALPN by default.
30228 The behaviour of both client and server can be configured using the options
30229 &%tls_alpn%& and &%hosts_require_alpn%&.
30230 There are no variables providing observability.
30231 Some feature-specific logging may appear on denied connections, but this
30232 depends on the behaviour of the peer
30233 (not all peers can send a feature-specific TLS Alert).
30235 This feature is available when Exim is built with
30236 OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later or GnuTLS 3.2.0 or later;
30237 the macro _HAVE_TLS_ALPN will be defined when this is so.
30241 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
30243 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
30244 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
30245 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
30246 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
30247 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
30248 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
30249 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
30250 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
30251 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
30252 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
30254 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
30255 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
30256 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
30257 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
30258 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
30259 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
30260 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
30262 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
30263 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
30264 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
30265 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
30266 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
30267 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
30268 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
30269 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
30270 and delay other deliveries to that host.
30272 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
30273 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
30274 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
30275 information is recorded.
30277 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
30278 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
30279 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
30284 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
30285 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
30286 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
30287 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
30288 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
30289 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
30291 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
30292 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
30293 document is currently at
30295 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
30297 and their FAQ is at
30299 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
30302 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
30303 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
30305 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
30306 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
30307 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
30308 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
30311 .subsection "Certificate chains" SECID186
30312 A file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
30313 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
30314 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
30315 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
30316 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
30317 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
30318 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
30319 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
30320 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
30321 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
30322 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
30323 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
30325 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
30326 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
30327 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
30328 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
30332 .subsection "Self-signed certificates" SECID187
30333 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
30334 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
30335 with OpenSSL, like this:
30336 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
30337 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
30339 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
30342 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
30343 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
30344 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
30345 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
30346 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
30347 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
30348 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
30350 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
30351 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
30352 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
30353 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
30354 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
30355 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
30357 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
30358 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
30359 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
30360 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
30361 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
30362 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
30363 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
30364 be a sensible resolution).
30366 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
30367 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
30368 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
30370 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
30371 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
30372 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
30373 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
30374 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
30375 signed with that self-signed certificate.
30377 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
30378 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
30379 Open-source PKI book, available online at
30380 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
30383 .subsection "Revoked certificates"
30384 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
30385 .cindex "revocation list"
30386 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
30387 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
30388 There are three ways for a certificate to be made unusable
30392 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
30393 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
30394 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
30395 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
30396 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
30398 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
30399 file from every certificate authority they know of.
30402 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
30403 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
30404 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
30405 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
30406 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
30407 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
30409 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
30410 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
30411 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
30412 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
30415 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
30416 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
30417 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
30418 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
30419 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
30420 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
30421 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
30422 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
30424 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
30425 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
30426 support for OCSP stapling is included.
30428 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30429 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
30430 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
30431 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
30432 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
30434 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
30435 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
30436 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
30437 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
30438 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
30441 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
30442 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
30445 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
30446 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
30447 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
30448 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
30449 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
30450 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30452 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
30453 not any of the chain from CA to it.
30455 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
30458 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
30459 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
30460 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
30462 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
30463 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
30464 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
30469 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
30470 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
30473 .section "TLS Resumption" "SECTresumption"
30474 .cindex TLS resumption
30475 TLS Session Resumption for TLS 1.2 and TLS 1.3 connections can be used (defined
30476 in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5077,RFC 5077) for 1.2).
30477 The support for this requires GnuTLS 3.6.3 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 (or later).
30479 Session resumption (this is the "stateless" variant) involves the server sending
30480 a "session ticket" to the client on one connection, which can be stored by the
30481 client and used for a later session. The ticket contains sufficient state for
30482 the server to reconstruct the TLS session, avoiding some expensive crypto
30483 calculation and (on TLS1.2) one full packet roundtrip time.
30486 Operational cost/benefit:
30488 The extra data being transmitted costs a minor amount, and the client has
30489 extra costs in storing and retrieving the data.
30491 In the Exim/Gnutls implementation the extra cost on an initial connection
30492 which is TLS1.2 over a loopback path is about 6ms on 2017-laptop class hardware.
30493 The saved cost on a subsequent connection is about 4ms; three or more
30494 connections become a net win. On longer network paths, two or more
30495 connections will have an average lower startup time thanks to the one
30496 saved packet roundtrip. TLS1.3 will save the crypto cpu costs but not any
30499 .cindex "hints database" tls
30500 Since a new hints DB is used on the TLS client,
30501 the hints DB maintenance should be updated to additionally handle "tls".
30506 The session ticket is encrypted, but is obviously an additional security
30507 vulnarability surface. An attacker able to decrypt it would have access
30508 all connections using the resumed session.
30509 The session ticket encryption key is not committed to storage by the server
30510 and is rotated regularly (OpenSSL: 1hr, and one previous key is used for
30511 overlap; GnuTLS 6hr but does not specify any overlap).
30512 Tickets have limited lifetime (2hr, and new ones issued after 1hr under
30513 OpenSSL. GnuTLS 2hr, appears to not do overlap).
30515 There is a question-mark over the security of the Diffie-Helman parameters
30516 used for session negotiation.
30521 The &%log_selector%& "tls_resumption" appends an asterisk to the tls_cipher "X="
30524 The variables &$tls_in_resumption$& and &$tls_out_resumption$&
30525 have bits 0-4 indicating respectively
30526 support built, client requested ticket, client offered session,
30527 server issued ticket, resume used. A suitable decode list is provided
30528 in the builtin macro _RESUME_DECODE for in &%listextract%& expansions.
30533 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& main option specifies a hostlist for which
30534 exim, operating as a server, will offer resumption to clients.
30535 Current best practice is to not offer the feature to MUA connection.
30536 Commonly this can be done like this:
30538 tls_resumption_hosts = ${if inlist {$received_port}{587:465} {:}{*}}
30540 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30541 is offered and/or accepted.
30543 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& smtp transport option performs the
30544 equivalent function for operation as a client.
30545 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30546 is attempted (if a stored session is available) or the information
30547 stored (if supplied by the peer).
30553 In a resumed session:
30555 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_cipher$& will have values different
30556 to the original (under GnuTLS).
30558 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_ocsp$& will be "not requested" or "no response",
30559 and the &%hosts_require_ocsp%& smtp trasnport option will fail.
30560 . XXX need to do something with that hosts_require_ocsp
30566 .section DANE "SECDANE"
30568 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
30569 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
30570 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
30571 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
30572 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
30573 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
30575 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
30576 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
30577 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
30579 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
30580 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
30582 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and communicate via side-channel) copies of server certificates
30583 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
30584 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
30586 DANE requires a server operator to do three things:
30588 Run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
30589 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
30590 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
30593 Add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
30595 Offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
30598 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
30599 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
30600 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
30601 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
30603 .subsection "DNS records"
30604 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
30605 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
30606 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
30607 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
30609 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
30610 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
30611 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
30612 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
30613 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
30614 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
30616 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
30617 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
30618 does require careful arrangement.
30619 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
30620 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
30621 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
30622 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
30623 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
30625 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
30626 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
30628 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
30629 "MTA-STS", described below.
30631 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
30632 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
30633 connections to you.
30634 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
30635 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
30636 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
30637 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
30638 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
30639 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
30641 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
30642 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
30643 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
30644 random serial numbers.
30645 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
30646 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
30647 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
30648 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
30650 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
30651 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
30653 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
30656 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
30657 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
30662 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
30664 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
30667 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
30670 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
30671 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
30674 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
30676 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
30677 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
30678 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
30679 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
30681 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
30682 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
30684 .subsection "Interaction with OCSP"
30685 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
30686 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
30687 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
30690 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
30691 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
30695 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
30696 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
30697 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
30698 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
30699 control the OCSP request.
30701 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
30702 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
30705 .subsection "Client configuration"
30706 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
30707 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
30708 The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
30709 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
30710 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
30712 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
30714 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using DNSSEC.
30715 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
30716 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
30717 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
30719 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
30720 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
30721 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
30722 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
30723 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
30724 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
30725 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
30727 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
30731 tls_try_verify_hosts
30732 tls_verify_certificates
30734 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
30738 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
30739 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
30741 The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
30742 set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
30744 .subsection Observability
30745 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
30747 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
30748 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
30749 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
30750 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
30752 .cindex DANE reporting
30753 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
30754 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
30755 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
30756 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
30757 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
30758 Section 4.3 of that document.
30760 .subsection General
30761 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
30763 DANE is specified in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6698,RFC 6698).
30764 It decouples certificate authority trust
30765 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
30767 It does retain the need to trust the assurances provided by the DNSSEC tree.
30769 There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS
30770 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8461,RFC 8461)), which
30771 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website.
30772 The discovery of the address for that website does not (per standard)
30773 require DNSSEC, and could be regarded as being less secure than DANE
30776 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
30777 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
30778 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
30781 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
30782 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
30783 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
30785 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
30786 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
30787 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
30788 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
30789 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
30790 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
30791 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
30795 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30796 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30798 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
30799 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
30800 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
30801 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
30802 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
30803 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
30804 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
30805 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
30806 one very small ACL:
30810 accept hosts = one.host.only
30812 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
30813 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
30815 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
30816 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
30817 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
30818 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
30819 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
30820 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
30821 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
30822 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30825 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
30826 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
30827 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30830 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
30831 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
30832 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
30833 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
30834 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
30835 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30836 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
30837 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
30838 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30839 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30840 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
30841 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
30842 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
30843 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
30844 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
30845 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
30846 .cindex "WELLKNOWN" "ACL for"
30847 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30848 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30849 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
30850 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30853 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
30854 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
30855 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
30856 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
30857 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
30858 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
30859 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
30860 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
30861 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
30862 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
30863 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
30864 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
30865 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
30866 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
30867 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
30868 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
30869 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
30870 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
30871 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
30872 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
30873 .irow &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& "ACL for WELLKNOWN"
30876 For example, if you set
30878 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
30880 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
30881 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
30882 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
30883 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
30884 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
30885 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
30886 testing as possible at RCPT time.
30889 .subsection "The non-SMTP ACLs" SECnonSMTP
30890 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30891 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
30892 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
30893 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
30894 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
30895 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
30896 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
30897 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
30898 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
30899 in any of these ACLs.
30901 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
30902 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
30903 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
30904 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
30905 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
30906 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
30907 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
30908 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
30910 control = suppress_local_fixups
30912 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
30913 run, it is too late.
30915 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30916 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30918 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
30919 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
30920 temporary error for these kinds of message.
30923 .subsection "The SMTP connect ACL" SECconnectACL
30924 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30925 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
30926 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
30927 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
30928 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
30929 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
30930 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
30931 &%smtp_banner%& option.
30933 For tls-on-connect connections, the ACL is run before the TLS connection
30934 is accepted; if the ACL does not accept then the TCP connection is dropped without
30935 any TLS startup attempt and without any SMTP response being transmitted.
30938 .subsection "The EHLO/HELO ACL" SECheloACL
30939 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30940 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30941 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
30942 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
30943 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
30944 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
30945 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
30946 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
30948 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
30949 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
30950 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
30952 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
30953 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
30954 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
30955 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
30959 .subsection "The DATA ACLs" SECdataACLS
30960 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30961 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
30962 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
30963 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
30964 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
30965 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
30966 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
30967 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
30968 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
30970 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
30971 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
30972 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
30973 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
30974 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
30975 associated with the DATA command.
30977 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
30978 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
30979 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
30980 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
30981 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
30982 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
30983 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
30984 the data specified is received.
30986 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
30987 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
30988 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
30989 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
30990 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
30993 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
30994 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
30995 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
30996 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
30998 .subsection "The SMTP DKIM ACL" SECTDKIMACL
30999 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
31000 enabled (which is the default).
31002 If, for a specific message, an ACL control
31003 &*dkim_disable_verify*&
31004 has been set, this &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is not called.
31006 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
31007 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
31008 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
31010 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
31012 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
31015 .subsection "The SMTP MIME ACL" SECID194
31016 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31017 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31019 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
31022 .subsection "The SMTP PRDR ACL" SECTPRDRACL
31023 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
31024 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
31025 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
31026 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
31027 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
31028 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
31031 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
31032 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
31033 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
31034 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
31035 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
31036 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
31037 for some or all recipients.
31039 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
31040 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
31041 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
31042 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
31043 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
31045 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
31046 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
31047 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
31049 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
31050 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
31052 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
31053 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
31054 the feature was not requested by the client.
31056 .subsection "The SMTP WELLKNOWN ACL" SECTWELLKNOWNACL
31057 .cindex "WELLKNOWN" "ACL for"
31058 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_wellknown%&"
31059 The &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
31060 with WELLKNOWN support enabled.
31062 The ACL determines the response to an SMTP WELLKNOWN command, using the normal
31063 accept/defer/deny verbs for the response code,
31064 and a new &"control=wellknown"& modifier.
31065 This modifier takes a single option, separated by a '/'
31066 character, which must be the name of a file containing the response
31067 cleartext. The modifier is expanded before use in the usual way before
31068 it is used. The configuration is responsible for picking a suitable file
31069 to return and, most importantly, not returning any unexpected file.
31070 The argument for the SMTP verb will be available in the &$smtp_command_argument$&
31071 variable and can be used for building the file path.
31072 If the file path given in the modifier is empty or inacessible, the control will
31078 accept control = wellknown/\
31079 ${lookup {${xtextd:$smtp_command_argument}} \
31080 dsearch,key=path,filter=file,ret=full \
31081 {$spooldir/wellknown.d}}
31083 File content will be encoded in &"xtext"& form, and line-wrapping
31084 for line-length limitation will be done before transmission.
31085 A response summary line will be prepended, with the (pre-encoding) file size.
31087 The above example uses the expansion operator ${xtextd:<coded-string>}
31088 which is needed to decode the xtext-encoded key from the SMTP verb.
31090 Under the util directory there is a "mailtest" utility which can be used
31091 to test/retrieve WELLKNOWN items. Syntax is
31093 mailtest -h host.example.com -w security.txt
31096 WELLKNOWN is a ESMTP extension providing access to extended
31097 information about the server. It is modelled on the webserver
31098 facilities documented in
31099 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8615,RFC 8615)
31100 and can be used for a security.txt file
31101 and could be used for ACME handshaking
31102 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8555,RFC 8555)).
31104 Exim will advertise WELLKNOWN support in the EHLO response
31105 .oindex &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%&
31106 (conditional on a new option &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%&)
31107 and service WELLKNOWN smtp verbs having a single parameter
31108 giving a key for an item of "site-wide metadata".
31109 The verb and key are separated by whitespace,
31110 and the key is xtext-encoded
31111 (per &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461) section 4).
31114 .subsection "The QUIT ACL" SECTQUITACL
31115 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
31116 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
31117 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
31118 does not in fact control any access.
31119 For this reason, it may only accept
31120 or warn as its final result.
31122 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
31123 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
31124 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
31125 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
31127 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
31128 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
31130 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
31131 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
31134 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
31135 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
31136 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
31137 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
31138 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
31141 .subsection "The not-QUIT ACL" SECTNOTQUITACL
31142 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
31143 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
31144 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
31145 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
31146 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
31147 situation even worse.
31149 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
31150 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
31151 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
31154 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
31155 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
31156 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
31157 connection. The possible values are:
31159 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
31160 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
31161 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
31162 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
31163 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
31164 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
31165 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
31166 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
31167 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
31168 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
31170 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
31171 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
31172 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
31173 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
31174 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
31178 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
31179 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
31180 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
31181 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
31183 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
31184 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
31186 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
31188 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4409,RFC 4409)
31189 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and an
31190 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314)
31191 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
31192 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
31193 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
31195 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
31196 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
31197 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
31200 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
31201 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
31202 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
31203 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
31204 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
31205 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
31207 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
31208 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
31209 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
31211 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
31212 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
31213 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
31214 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
31216 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
31217 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
31218 matches the string.
31220 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
31221 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
31222 want to have something like
31224 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
31226 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
31227 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
31233 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
31234 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
31235 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
31236 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
31237 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
31238 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
31239 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
31240 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
31241 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
31243 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
31244 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
31245 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
31248 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
31249 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
31250 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
31251 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
31253 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
31254 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
31255 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
31256 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
31257 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
31258 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
31259 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
31261 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
31262 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
31265 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
31266 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
31267 recipients; it may create new recipients.
31271 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
31272 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
31273 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
31274 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
31275 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
31276 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
31278 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
31279 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
31280 used to accept or reject anything.
31282 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
31283 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
31284 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
31285 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
31287 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&,
31289 and &%acl_smtp_wellknown%&),
31290 the action when the ACL
31291 is not defined is &"deny"&. This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be
31292 defined in order to receive any messages over an SMTP connection.
31293 For an example, see the ACL in the default configuration file.
31297 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
31298 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
31300 .vindex &$local_part$&
31301 .vindex &$sender_address$&
31302 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
31303 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31304 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
31305 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
31306 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
31307 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
31308 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
31309 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31311 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
31312 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
31313 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
31316 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
31317 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
31318 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
31319 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
31320 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
31323 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
31324 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
31325 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
31326 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
31327 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
31328 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
31329 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
31330 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
31336 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
31337 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
31338 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
31339 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31340 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
31341 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
31342 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31343 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
31344 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
31345 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
31346 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
31347 unencrypted connections.
31350 accept encrypted = *
31351 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
31353 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
31355 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
31356 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
31357 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
31358 option to do this.)
31362 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
31363 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
31364 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
31365 An individual ACL definition consists of a number of statements.
31366 Each statement starts
31367 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
31368 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
31369 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
31371 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
31372 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
31373 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
31376 deny dnslists = list1.example
31377 dnslists = list2.example
31379 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
31380 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
31381 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
31382 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
31383 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
31385 The definition of an ACL ends where another starts,
31386 or a different configuration section starts.
31389 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
31390 The ACL verbs are as follows:
31393 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
31394 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
31395 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
31396 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
31397 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
31398 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
31399 check a RCPT command:
31401 accept domains = +local_domains
31405 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
31406 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
31407 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
31408 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
31411 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
31412 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
31413 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
31416 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
31417 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
31418 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
31419 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
31420 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
31421 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
31423 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
31424 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
31426 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
31427 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
31428 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
31430 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
31431 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
31432 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
31437 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
31438 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
31439 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
31440 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
31441 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
31442 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
31443 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
31447 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
31448 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
31449 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
31452 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31454 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
31458 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
31459 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
31460 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
31461 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
31462 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
31463 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
31464 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
31465 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
31466 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
31468 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
31469 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
31470 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
31474 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
31475 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
31476 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
31478 drop condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
31479 message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
31481 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
31482 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
31485 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
31486 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
31487 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
31488 example, when checking a RCPT command,
31490 require message = Sender did not verify
31493 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
31494 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
31495 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
31496 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
31499 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
31500 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
31501 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
31502 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
31503 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
31504 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
31505 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
31507 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
31508 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
31509 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
31510 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
31511 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31513 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
31514 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
31515 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
31516 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
31517 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
31518 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
31522 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31523 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
31524 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
31525 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
31527 warn !verify = sender
31528 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
31532 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
31534 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
31535 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
31536 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
31537 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
31538 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
31542 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
31543 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
31544 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
31545 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
31546 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
31547 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
31548 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
31549 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
31550 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
31551 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
31553 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
31554 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
31555 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
31556 on the same SMTP connection.
31558 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
31559 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
31560 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
31563 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
31564 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
31565 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
31567 accept hosts = whatever
31568 set acl_m4 = some value
31569 accept authenticated = *
31570 set acl_c_auth = yes
31572 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
31573 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
31574 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
31576 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
31577 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
31578 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
31579 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
31580 error is generated.
31582 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
31583 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
31586 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
31587 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
31588 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
31589 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
31591 deny domains = *.dom.example
31592 !verify = recipient
31594 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
31595 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
31596 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
31597 two statements are equivalent:
31599 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
31600 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
31602 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
31603 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
31605 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
31606 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
31607 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
31609 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31610 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
31611 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31612 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
31614 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
31615 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
31616 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
31617 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
31618 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
31619 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
31620 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
31622 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
31623 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
31624 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
31625 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
31626 message is handled.
31628 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
31629 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
31630 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
31631 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
31633 require message = Can't verify sender
31635 message = Can't verify recipient
31637 message = This message cannot be used
31639 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
31640 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
31641 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
31642 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
31643 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
31644 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
31646 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
31647 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
31648 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
31649 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
31652 !senders = *@my.domain.example
31653 message = Invalid sender from client host
31655 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
31656 by which time Exim has set up the message.
31660 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
31661 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
31662 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
31665 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31666 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
31667 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
31668 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31670 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31671 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
31672 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
31673 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
31674 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
31675 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
31676 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
31677 write rather ugly lines like this:
31679 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
31681 Instead, all you need is
31683 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
31686 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31687 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31688 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
31689 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
31690 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
31691 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
31692 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
31693 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
31695 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
31696 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
31697 in several different ways. For example:
31699 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
31700 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
31701 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
31705 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
31707 accept ...some conditions
31710 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
31711 other words, when the conditions are all true.
31714 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
31716 accept ...some conditions...
31718 ...some more conditions...
31720 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
31721 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
31722 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
31726 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
31727 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
31730 warn ...some conditions...
31734 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
31735 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
31739 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
31740 &%require%& verb. For example:
31742 require control = no_multiline_responses
31746 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
31747 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
31749 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
31750 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
31751 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
31752 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
31753 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
31754 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
31756 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
31759 deny ...some conditions...
31762 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
31763 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
31766 ...some conditions...
31768 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
31769 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
31771 warn ...some conditions...
31777 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
31778 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
31779 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
31780 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
31781 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
31782 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
31783 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
31787 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
31788 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
31789 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
31790 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
31791 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
31792 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
31793 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
31796 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31797 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
31798 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
31799 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
31801 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
31802 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
31804 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
31807 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
31808 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
31810 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
31811 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
31812 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
31815 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
31816 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
31817 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
31818 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
31819 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
31820 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
31823 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31824 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
31825 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
31828 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
31829 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
31830 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
31831 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
31832 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
31833 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
31835 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
31836 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
31837 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
31838 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
31839 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
31840 logging rejections.
31843 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
31844 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
31845 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
31846 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
31847 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
31848 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
31849 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
31850 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
31852 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
31853 &` log_reject_target =`&
31855 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
31856 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
31860 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31861 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
31862 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
31863 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
31864 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
31865 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
31866 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
31869 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
31870 &` control = freeze`&
31871 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
31873 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
31874 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
31875 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
31878 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
31879 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
31883 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31884 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
31885 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
31886 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
31887 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
31888 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
31889 &%accept%& for details.)
31891 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
31892 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
31893 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
31894 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
31895 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
31897 require message = Host not recognized
31900 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
31903 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
31904 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
31905 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
31906 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
31907 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
31908 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
31909 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
31910 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
31911 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
31914 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
31915 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
31916 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
31918 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
31919 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
31921 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
31922 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
31923 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
31926 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
31927 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
31929 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
31930 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
31932 If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
31934 A long message line will also be split into multi-line SMTP responses,
31935 on word boundaries if possible.
31937 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31938 While the text is being expanded, the &$acl_verify_message$& variable
31939 contains any message previously set.
31940 Afterwards, &$acl_verify_message$& is cleared.
31942 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
31943 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
31944 However, the original message is available in the variable
31945 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
31946 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
31947 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
31948 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
31950 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
31951 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
31952 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
31953 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
31954 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
31955 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
31959 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31960 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
31961 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
31962 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
31964 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
31966 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
31967 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
31968 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
31969 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
31972 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31973 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
31974 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
31975 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
31978 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
31979 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
31980 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
31981 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
31984 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
31985 .cindex "UDP communications"
31986 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
31987 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
31988 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
31989 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
31990 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
31991 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
31992 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
31995 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
31996 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
32003 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
32004 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
32005 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
32008 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
32009 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
32010 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
32011 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
32012 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
32013 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
32014 not work without it. For example:
32016 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
32017 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
32019 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
32020 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
32021 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
32022 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
32023 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
32026 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
32027 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
32028 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
32029 .cindex "case of local parts"
32030 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32031 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
32032 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
32033 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
32034 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
32035 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
32038 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
32039 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
32040 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
32041 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
32042 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
32044 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
32045 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
32048 warn control = caseful_local_part
32049 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
32051 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
32053 control = caselower_local_part
32055 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
32056 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
32059 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
32060 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
32061 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
32062 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
32064 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
32065 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
32066 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
32067 is used for all recipients of the message,
32068 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
32069 and data is copied from one to the other.
32071 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
32072 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
32073 If a recipient-verify callout
32075 connection is subsequently
32076 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
32077 any subsequent recipients and the data,
32078 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
32080 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
32081 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
32082 Note also that headers cannot be
32083 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
32084 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
32085 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
32086 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
32087 this will affect the timestamp.
32089 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
32090 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
32091 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
32092 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
32095 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
32096 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
32097 before the entire message has been received from the source.
32098 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
32102 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
32103 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
32104 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
32105 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
32106 before the acceptance "<=" line.
32108 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
32110 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
32111 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
32112 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
32113 and does not queue the message.
32114 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
32116 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
32118 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
32121 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
32122 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
32123 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
32124 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
32125 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
32126 by default called &'debuglog'&.
32128 Logging set up by the control will be maintained across spool residency.
32130 Options are a slash-separated list.
32131 If an option takes an argument, the option name and argument are separated by
32132 an equals character.
32133 Several options are supported:
32135 tag=<&'suffix'&> The filename can be adjusted with thise option.
32136 The argument, which may access any variables already defined,
32137 is appended to the default name.
32139 opts=<&'debug&~options'&> The argument specififes what is to be logged,
32140 using the same values as the &`-d`& command-line option.
32142 stop Logging started with this control may be
32143 stopped by using this option.
32145 kill Logging started with this control may be
32146 stopped by using this option.
32147 Additionally the debug file will be removed,
32148 providing one means for speculative debug tracing.
32150 pretrigger=<&'size'&> This option specifies a memory buffuer to be used
32151 for pre-trigger debug capture.
32152 Debug lines are recorded in the buffer until
32153 and if) a trigger occurs; at which time they are
32154 dumped to the debug file. Newer lines displace the
32155 oldest if the buffer is full. After a trigger,
32156 immediate writes to file are done as normal.
32158 trigger=<&'reason'&> This option selects cause for the pretrigger buffer
32159 see above) to be copied to file. A reason of &*now*&
32160 take effect immediately; one of &*paniclog*& triggers
32161 on a write to the panic log.
32164 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
32168 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
32169 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
32170 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
32171 control = debug/kill
32172 control = debug/opts=+all/pretrigger=1024/trigger=paniclog
32173 control = debug/trigger=now
32177 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
32178 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
32179 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
32180 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
32181 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
32184 .vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*& &&&
32185 &*control&~=&~dmarc_enable_forensic*&
32186 .cindex "disable DMARC verify"
32187 .cindex DMARC "disable verify"
32188 .cindex DMARC controls
32189 .cindex DMARC "forensic mails"
32190 These control affect DMARC processing. For details on
32191 the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
32193 The &"disable"& turns off DMARC verification processing entirely.
32196 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
32197 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
32198 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
32199 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
32200 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
32201 strings or to numeric value.
32202 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
32203 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
32204 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
32206 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
32207 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
32208 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
32209 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
32210 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
32213 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
32214 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
32215 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
32216 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
32217 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
32218 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
32219 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
32220 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
32222 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
32223 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
32224 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
32225 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
32226 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
32227 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
32231 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
32232 .cindex "fake defer"
32233 .cindex "defer, fake"
32235 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
32236 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
32237 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
32238 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
32239 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
32241 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
32242 .cindex "fake rejection"
32243 .cindex "rejection, fake"
32245 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
32246 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
32247 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
32248 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
32249 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
32250 the same SMTP connection.
32252 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
32253 message is supplied, the following is used:
32255 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
32256 550-kept for evaluation.
32257 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
32258 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
32260 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
32262 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
32263 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
32264 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
32265 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
32266 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
32267 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
32270 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
32271 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
32272 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
32273 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
32275 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
32276 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
32277 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
32278 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
32279 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
32280 disables such output flushing.
32282 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
32283 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32284 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
32285 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
32286 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
32287 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
32289 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
32290 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
32291 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
32292 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
32293 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
32294 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
32295 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
32296 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
32297 to be useful in production.
32299 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
32300 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
32301 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
32302 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
32303 SMTP responses, despite the fact that
32304 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc821,RFC 821)
32305 defined them over 20 years ago.
32307 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
32308 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
32309 one long line. However,
32310 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821)
32311 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
32312 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
32313 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
32314 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
32317 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
32318 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
32319 verification failed"&) is sent.
32321 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
32325 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
32326 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
32328 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
32329 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
32330 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
32331 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
32332 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
32333 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
32334 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
32335 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
32337 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
32338 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
32339 .oindex "&%queue%&"
32340 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
32341 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
32342 .cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
32343 .cindex "first pass routing"
32344 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
32345 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
32346 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
32348 If used with no options set,
32349 no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
32350 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
32352 If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
32353 the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
32354 a delivery process is started which stops short of making
32355 any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
32356 the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
32357 able to send all such messages on a single connection.
32359 The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
32360 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32362 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
32363 .cindex "message" "submission"
32364 .cindex "submission mode"
32365 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
32366 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
32367 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
32368 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
32369 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
32370 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
32371 late (the message has already been created).
32373 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
32374 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
32375 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
32376 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
32377 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32379 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
32380 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
32381 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
32382 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
32383 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
32386 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
32387 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
32389 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
32391 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
32394 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
32395 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
32396 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
32397 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
32400 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
32401 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
32403 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
32404 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
32406 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
32408 .vitem &*control&~=&~wellknown*&
32409 This control sets up a response data file for a WELLKNOWN SMTP command.
32410 It may only be used in an ACL servicing that command.
32411 For details see section &<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>&.
32415 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
32416 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
32419 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
32421 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
32422 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
32424 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
32426 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
32431 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
32432 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
32433 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
32434 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
32435 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
32436 to an incoming message, as in this example:
32438 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32439 dialup.mail-abuse.org
32440 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
32442 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32443 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32444 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32445 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
32446 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
32449 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
32450 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32452 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
32453 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
32454 contains one or more newlines that
32455 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
32456 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
32457 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
32459 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32460 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32461 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
32462 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
32463 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
32464 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
32465 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
32466 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
32467 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
32468 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
32469 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
32471 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
32472 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
32474 until they are added to the
32475 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
32476 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
32477 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
32478 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
32479 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
32480 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
32481 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32483 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
32485 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32486 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32488 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32489 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32491 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32492 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32494 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
32495 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
32496 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
32497 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
32500 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
32501 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
32502 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
32503 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
32504 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
32505 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
32506 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
32509 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
32510 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
32511 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
32512 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
32513 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
32515 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
32516 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
32517 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
32518 to be a header name first.) For example:
32520 warn add_header = \
32521 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
32523 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
32524 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
32525 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
32526 up in reverse order.
32528 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32529 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
32530 system filter or in a router or transport.
32534 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
32535 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
32536 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
32537 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
32538 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
32539 from an incoming message, as in this example:
32541 warn message = Remove internal headers
32542 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32544 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32545 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32546 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32547 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
32548 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
32549 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
32551 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
32552 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32554 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
32555 list of header specifiers.
32556 If a specifier does not start with a circumflex (^)
32557 then it is treated as a header name.
32558 The header name matching is case insensitive.
32559 If it does, then it is treated as a (front-anchored)
32560 regular expression applied to the whole header.
32562 &*Note*&: The colon terminating a header name will need to be doubled
32563 if used in an RE, and there can legitimately be whitepace before it.
32567 remove_header = \N^(?i)Authentication-Results\s*::\s*example.org;\N
32570 List expansion is not performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
32571 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
32572 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
32574 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
32575 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32576 warn message = Remove internal headers
32577 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
32579 Header specifiers for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32580 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32581 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
32582 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
32583 a non-existent header. Further header specifiers for removal may be accumulated
32584 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which matching headers are removed
32585 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, remove specifiers are
32586 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are acted on after
32587 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
32588 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
32589 would have been removed.
32591 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
32592 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
32593 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
32594 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
32595 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
32596 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
32597 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
32598 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
32599 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32601 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32602 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32604 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
32605 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32607 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32608 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
32610 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
32611 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
32612 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
32613 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
32616 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32617 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
32618 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
32623 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
32624 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
32625 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
32626 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
32627 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
32628 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32630 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
32631 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
32632 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
32633 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
32634 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
32635 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
32636 The conditions are as follows:
32640 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
32641 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
32642 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
32643 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
32644 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
32645 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
32646 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
32647 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
32648 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
32649 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
32650 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
32651 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
32653 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
32654 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
32655 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
32656 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
32657 The name and values are expanded separately.
32658 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
32659 will act as argument separators.
32661 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
32662 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
32663 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
32664 conditions are tested.
32666 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
32667 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
32668 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
32669 for different local users or different local domains.
32671 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32672 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
32673 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
32674 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
32675 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
32676 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
32677 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
32682 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
32683 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
32684 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
32685 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
32686 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
32687 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
32688 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
32689 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
32690 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
32691 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
32692 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
32693 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
32696 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
32697 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
32698 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32699 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32700 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
32701 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
32702 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
32703 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32705 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
32706 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
32707 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
32708 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32709 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
32710 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
32711 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
32712 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
32713 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
32714 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
32716 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32717 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
32718 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
32719 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
32720 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
32721 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the domain
32722 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
32723 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
32724 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
32727 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
32728 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
32731 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32732 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
32733 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
32734 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
32735 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
32736 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
32737 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
32743 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
32744 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
32745 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
32746 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
32747 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
32748 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
32749 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
32751 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32753 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
32754 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
32755 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
32757 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
32758 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
32759 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
32760 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
32761 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
32762 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
32764 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
32765 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
32767 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32768 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
32770 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
32771 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
32772 statement can then check the IP address.
32774 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
32775 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
32776 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
32777 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
32779 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
32780 message = $host_data
32782 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
32784 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
32785 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
32786 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
32787 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
32788 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
32789 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the local
32790 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
32791 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
32792 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
32793 the next &%local_parts%& test.
32795 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
32796 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
32797 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
32798 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
32799 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32800 content-scanning extension
32801 and only after a DATA command.
32802 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
32803 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32805 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32806 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
32807 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32808 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32809 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32810 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
32811 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
32814 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32815 .cindex "rate limiting"
32816 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
32817 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
32819 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32820 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
32821 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
32822 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
32823 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks the entire
32824 recipient address against a list of recipients.
32826 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32827 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
32828 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32829 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32830 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
32831 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
32832 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32834 .vitem &*seen&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32835 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
32836 This condition can be used to test if a situation has been previously met,
32837 for example for greylisting.
32838 Details are given in section &<<SECTseen>>&.
32840 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32841 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
32842 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
32843 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
32844 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32845 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
32846 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
32847 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
32848 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
32849 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
32850 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
32851 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
32852 influence the sender checking.
32854 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
32855 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
32857 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32858 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
32859 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
32860 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
32861 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
32862 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
32866 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
32867 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
32869 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
32870 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
32871 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
32872 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32873 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
32874 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32876 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
32877 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32878 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
32879 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
32880 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
32881 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
32882 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
32883 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
32884 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
32885 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
32887 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
32888 .cindex "CSA verification"
32889 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
32890 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
32891 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
32893 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
32894 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32895 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
32896 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
32897 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
32898 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32900 This usually means an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
32901 It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
32902 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
32903 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
32905 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
32906 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
32907 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
32909 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
32910 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32911 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
32912 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
32913 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
32914 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
32915 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32916 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
32917 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
32918 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
32919 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
32920 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
32921 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
32922 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
32923 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
32925 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
32926 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
32927 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
32928 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
32931 !verify = header_sender
32932 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
32935 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
32936 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32937 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
32938 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
32939 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
32940 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32941 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
32942 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
32943 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
32944 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
32945 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
32946 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
32947 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
32950 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
32951 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
32955 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
32956 common as they used to be.
32958 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
32959 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32960 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
32961 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
32962 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
32963 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
32964 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
32965 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
32966 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
32967 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
32968 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
32969 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
32970 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
32972 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
32973 option), this condition is always true.
32976 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
32977 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
32978 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
32979 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
32980 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
32981 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
32982 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
32983 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
32984 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
32986 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
32987 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
32989 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
32990 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
32993 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
32994 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32995 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
32996 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
32997 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
32998 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
32999 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
33000 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
33001 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
33002 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
33003 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
33004 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
33005 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
33006 value for the child address.
33008 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
33009 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33010 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
33011 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
33012 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
33013 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
33014 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
33015 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
33016 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
33017 original IP address.
33019 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
33020 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
33022 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
33023 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
33025 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
33026 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33027 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
33028 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
33029 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
33030 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
33031 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
33032 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
33033 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
33035 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
33036 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
33037 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
33038 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
33039 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
33040 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
33041 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
33043 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
33044 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
33045 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
33047 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
33048 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33049 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
33050 verified as a sender.
33052 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
33053 (eg. is generated from the received message)
33054 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
33056 verify = sender=${listquote{/}{${address:$h_sender:}}}
33062 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
33063 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
33064 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
33065 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
33066 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
33067 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
33068 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
33069 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
33070 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
33071 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
33073 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
33074 dialups.mail-abuse.org
33076 the following records are looked up:
33078 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33079 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
33081 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
33082 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
33083 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
33084 use two separate conditions:
33086 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33087 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
33089 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
33090 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
33091 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
33094 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
33095 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
33096 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
33097 following special items in the list:
33098 .itable none 0 0 2 25* left 75* left
33099 .irow "+include_unknown" "behave as if the item is on the list"
33100 .irow "+exclude_unknown" "behave as if the item is not on the list (default)"
33101 .irow "+defer_unknown " "give a temporary error"
33103 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
33104 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
33105 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
33106 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
33108 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
33110 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
33111 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
33113 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33114 warn dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
33115 message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
33117 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
33119 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
33120 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
33121 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
33122 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
33123 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
33124 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
33126 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
33127 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
33128 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
33132 .subsection "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" SECID201
33133 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
33134 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
33135 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
33136 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
33138 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
33140 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
33141 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
33142 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
33143 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
33148 .subsection "DNS lists keyed on domain names" SECID202
33149 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
33150 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
33151 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
33152 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
33153 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
33154 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
33156 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
33157 message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
33159 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
33160 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
33161 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
33162 up by this example is
33164 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
33166 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
33167 addresses. For example:
33169 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33170 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
33172 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
33173 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
33178 .subsection "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" SECTmulkeyfor
33179 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
33180 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
33181 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
33182 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
33183 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
33184 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
33185 either to double the separators like this:
33187 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
33189 or to change the separator character, like this:
33191 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
33193 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
33194 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
33195 occurs. Consider this condition:
33197 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
33199 The DNS lookups that occur are:
33201 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
33202 a.domain.black.list.tld
33204 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
33205 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
33206 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
33207 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
33208 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
33209 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
33210 error for a previous item.
33212 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
33213 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
33215 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
33216 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
33218 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
33219 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
33221 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
33222 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
33223 $sender_address_domain} }} }
33224 message = The mail servers for the domain \
33225 $sender_address_domain \
33226 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
33229 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
33230 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
33231 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
33232 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
33234 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
33236 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
33237 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
33239 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
33240 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
33245 .subsection "Data returned by DNS lists" SECID203
33246 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
33247 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
33248 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
33249 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
33250 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
33251 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
33252 .irow 127.1.0.1 "RBL"
33253 .irow 127.1.0.2 "DUL"
33254 .irow 127.1.0.3 "DUL and RBL"
33255 .irow 127.1.0.4 "RSS"
33256 .irow 127.1.0.5 "RSS and RBL"
33257 .irow 127.1.0.6 "RSS and DUL"
33258 .irow 127.1.0.7 "RSS and DUL and RBL"
33260 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
33261 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
33262 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
33264 Values returned by a properly running DBSBL should be in the 127.0.0.0/8
33265 range. If a DNSBL operator loses control of the domain, lookups on it
33266 may start returning other addresses. Because of this, Exim now ignores
33267 returned values outside the 127/8 region.
33270 .subsection "Variables set from DNS lists" SECID204
33271 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
33272 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
33273 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
33274 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
33275 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
33276 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
33277 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
33278 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
33279 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
33280 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
33281 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
33282 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
33283 cases, for example:
33285 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
33287 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
33288 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
33289 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
33290 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
33292 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
33294 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
33295 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
33297 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
33298 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
33299 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
33300 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
33301 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
33304 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
33305 &-- even if these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
33306 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
33308 deny hosts = !+local_networks
33309 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
33311 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
33316 .subsection "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" SECTaddmatcon
33317 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
33318 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
33319 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
33322 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
33324 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
33325 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
33326 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
33327 describes how multiple records are handled.
33329 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
33330 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
33331 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
33333 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33335 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
33336 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
33337 first. For example:
33339 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
33340 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
33343 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
33344 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
33345 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
33346 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
33347 tested. For example:
33349 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
33351 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
33352 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
33353 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
33355 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33357 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
33362 .subsection "Negated DNS matching conditions" SECID205
33363 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
33366 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33368 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33369 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
33371 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33373 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33374 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
33375 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
33376 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
33378 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
33379 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
33381 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
33382 previous example is precisely equivalent to
33384 deny dnslists = a.b.c
33385 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33387 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
33388 Consider this example:
33390 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33392 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
33395 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
33397 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33399 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
33400 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
33401 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
33403 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
33405 Negation can also be used with a bitwise-and restriction.
33406 The dnslists condition with only be trus if a result is returned
33407 by the lookup which, anded with the restriction, is all zeroes.
33410 deny dnslists = zen.spamhaus.org!&0.255.255.0
33416 .subsection "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" SECThanmuldnsrec
33417 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
33418 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
33419 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
33420 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
33421 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
33423 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
33425 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
33426 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
33427 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
33428 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
33429 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
33430 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
33433 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
33434 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
33435 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33437 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
33438 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
33441 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
33443 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33444 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
33446 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
33448 for the condition to be true.
33451 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
33452 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
33454 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
33455 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
33457 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
33459 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33460 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33462 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
33463 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
33465 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
33467 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33468 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
33470 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33472 for the condition to be false.
33474 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
33475 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
33480 .subsection "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" SECTmordetinf
33481 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
33482 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
33483 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
33484 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
33485 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
33486 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
33487 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
33488 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
33491 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
33492 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
33493 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
33494 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
33495 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
33496 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
33497 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
33500 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
33501 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33503 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
33504 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
33506 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
33507 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
33508 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
33509 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
33510 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
33511 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
33513 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
33514 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
33515 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
33518 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
33519 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
33520 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
33521 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33523 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
33524 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
33525 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
33529 .subsection "DNS lists and IPv6" SECTmorednslistslast
33530 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
33531 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
33532 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
33533 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
33534 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
33536 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
33537 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33539 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
33540 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
33541 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
33543 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
33545 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
33546 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
33548 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
33549 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
33551 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
33552 dnslists = some.list.example
33555 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
33556 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
33557 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
33559 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
33563 .section "Previously seen user and hosts" "SECTseen"
33564 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
33565 .cindex greylisting
33566 The &%seen%& ACL condition can be used to test whether a
33567 situation has been previously met.
33568 It uses a hints database to record a timestamp against a key.
33569 The syntax of the condition is:
33571 &`seen =`& <&'optional flag'&><&'time interval'&> &`/`& <&'options'&>
33576 defer seen = -5m / key=${sender_host_address}_$local_part@$domain
33578 in a RCPT ACL will implement simple greylisting.
33580 The parameters for the condition are
33581 a possible minus sign,
33583 then, slash-separated, a list of options.
33584 The interval is taken as an offset before the current time,
33585 and used for the test.
33586 If the interval is preceded by a minus sign then the condition returns
33587 whether a record is found which is before the test time.
33588 Otherwise, the condition returns whether one is found which is since the
33591 Options are read in order with later ones overriding earlier ones.
33593 The default key is &$sender_host_address$&.
33594 An explicit key can be set using a &%key=value%& option.
33596 If a &%readonly%& option is given then
33597 no record create or update is done.
33598 If a &%write%& option is given then
33599 a record create or update is always done.
33600 An update is done if the test is for &"since"&.
33601 If none of those hold and there was no existing record,
33602 a record is created.
33604 Creates and updates are marked with the current time.
33606 Finally, a &"before"& test which succeeds, and for which the record
33607 is old enough, will be refreshed with a timestamp of the test time.
33608 This can prevent tidying of the database from removing the entry.
33609 The interval for this is, by default, 10 days.
33610 An explicit interval can be set using a
33611 &%refresh=value%& option.
33613 Note that &"seen"& should be added to the list of hints databases
33614 for maintenance if this ACL condition is used.
33617 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
33618 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
33619 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
33620 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
33621 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
33622 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
33623 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
33624 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
33625 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
33626 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
33628 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
33630 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
33631 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
33633 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
33634 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
33635 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
33638 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
33639 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
33640 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
33641 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
33642 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
33643 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
33644 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
33645 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
33646 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
33648 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
33649 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
33650 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
33651 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
33653 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
33654 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
33655 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
33656 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
33657 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
33658 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
33659 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
33660 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
33661 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
33662 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
33664 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
33665 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
33666 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
33669 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
33670 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
33671 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
33672 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
33673 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
33674 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
33676 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
33677 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
33678 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
33679 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
33680 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
33681 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
33682 the &%count=%& option.
33685 .subsection "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" ratoptmea
33686 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
33689 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33690 This option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
33691 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
33692 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
33695 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33696 This option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
33697 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
33698 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
33699 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
33702 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33703 This option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
33704 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
33705 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
33706 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
33707 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
33708 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
33709 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
33712 .cindex "rate limiting" per_rcpt
33713 This option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
33714 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
33715 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, or &%acl_smtp_data%& ACLs. In
33716 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
33717 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
33718 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
33719 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
33722 .cindex "rate limiting" per_addr
33723 This option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
33724 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
33725 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
33726 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
33730 .cindex "rate limiting" per_cmd
33731 This option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
33732 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
33733 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
33734 multiple different commands.
33737 .cindex "rate limiting" count
33738 This option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
33740 A value is required, after an equals sign.
33741 For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
33742 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&.
33743 If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
33744 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
33745 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&).
33746 The count does not have to be an integer.
33749 .cindex "rate limiting" unique
33750 This option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
33754 .subsection "Ratelimit update modes" ratoptupd
33755 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
33756 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
33757 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
33758 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
33760 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
33761 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
33763 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
33764 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
33765 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
33766 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
33770 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
33771 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33772 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33775 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
33776 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33777 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33780 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
33781 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
33782 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
33783 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
33784 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
33785 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
33788 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
33789 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
33790 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
33791 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
33792 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
33795 .subsection "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" ratoptfast
33796 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
33797 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
33798 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
33799 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
33800 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
33803 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
33804 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
33805 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
33806 up to the given limit.
33807 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
33808 consists of refusing the message, and
33809 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
33810 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
33811 likely not what is wanted.
33813 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
33814 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
33815 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
33816 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
33817 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
33818 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
33819 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
33820 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
33822 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
33826 .subsection "Limiting the rate of different events" ratoptuniq
33827 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
33828 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
33829 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
33830 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
33831 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
33832 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
33833 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
33834 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
33836 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
33837 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
33838 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
33839 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
33840 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
33841 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
33843 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
33844 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
33847 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
33848 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
33849 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
33850 required increases with larger limits.
33852 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
33853 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
33854 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
33855 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
33856 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
33857 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
33858 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
33859 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
33860 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
33864 .subsection "Using rate limiting" useratlim
33865 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
33866 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
33867 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
33868 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
33869 message. For example:
33871 # Log all senders' rates
33872 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
33873 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
33875 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
33876 # at the decimal point.
33877 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
33878 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
33879 $sender_rate_limit }s
33881 # Keep authenticated users under control
33882 deny authenticated = *
33883 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
33885 # System-wide rate limit
33886 defer ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
33887 message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
33889 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
33890 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
33891 defer ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
33892 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
33893 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
33894 message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
33895 messages per $sender_rate_period
33897 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
33898 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
33899 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
33900 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
33901 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
33902 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
33903 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
33907 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
33908 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
33909 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
33910 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
33911 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
33912 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
33913 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
33914 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
33915 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
33917 verify = sender/callout
33918 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
33920 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
33921 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
33922 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
33923 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
33924 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
33925 The available options are as follows:
33928 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
33929 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
33930 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
33932 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
33933 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
33934 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
33935 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
33937 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
33938 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
33940 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
33941 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
33942 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
33943 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
33945 If the &%quota%& option is specified for recipient verify,
33946 successful routing to an appendfile transport is followed by a call into
33947 the transport to evaluate the quota status for the recipient.
33948 No actual delivery is done, but verification will succeed if the quota
33949 is sufficient for the message (if the sender gave a message size) or
33950 not already exceeded (otherwise).
33953 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
33954 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
33955 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
33956 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
33957 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
33958 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
33961 warn !verify = sender
33962 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
33964 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
33965 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
33966 verification failure.
33967 This variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
33969 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
33970 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
33973 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
33974 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
33976 &%route%&: Routing failed.
33978 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
33979 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
33980 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
33982 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
33984 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
33986 &%quota%&: The quota check for a local recipient did non pass.
33989 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
33990 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
33992 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
33993 address verification to:
33996 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
34002 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
34003 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
34004 .cindex "callout" "verification"
34005 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
34006 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
34007 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
34008 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
34009 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
34010 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
34011 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
34012 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
34013 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
34016 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
34017 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
34018 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
34019 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
34020 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
34021 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
34023 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
34024 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
34025 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
34026 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
34027 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
34029 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
34030 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
34031 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
34032 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
34033 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
34034 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
34035 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
34036 supplies a host list.
34037 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
34039 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
34040 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
34041 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
34042 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
34043 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
34044 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
34045 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
34047 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
34048 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
34049 following SMTP commands are sent:
34051 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
34053 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
34056 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
34059 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
34062 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
34063 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
34064 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
34065 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
34066 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
34067 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
34069 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
34070 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
34071 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
34072 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
34073 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
34075 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
34076 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
34077 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
34078 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
34079 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
34081 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
34082 .cindex "de-tainting" "using recipient verify"
34083 A recipient callout which gets a 2&'xx'& code
34084 will assign untainted values to the
34085 &$domain_data$& and &$local_part_data$& variables,
34086 corresponding to the domain and local parts of the recipient address.
34091 .subsection "Additional parameters for callouts" CALLaddparcall
34092 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
34093 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
34094 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
34096 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
34098 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
34099 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
34100 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
34104 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
34105 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
34106 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
34109 verify = sender/callout=5s
34111 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
34112 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
34113 the &%connect%& parameter.
34116 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34117 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
34118 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
34119 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
34121 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
34123 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
34125 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
34126 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
34127 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
34128 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
34129 updated in this circumstance.
34131 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
34132 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
34133 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
34134 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
34135 accordance with the specification in
34136 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821).
34137 The RFC states that the unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
34140 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
34141 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
34142 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
34143 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
34144 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
34145 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
34146 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
34147 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
34148 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
34149 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
34151 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
34153 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
34156 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34157 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
34158 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
34161 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
34163 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
34164 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
34165 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
34166 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
34167 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
34170 .vitem &*no_cache*&
34171 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
34172 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
34173 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
34175 .vitem &*postmaster*&
34176 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
34177 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
34178 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
34179 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
34180 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
34181 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
34182 made, until the cache record expires.
34184 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
34185 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
34186 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
34189 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
34191 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
34192 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
34194 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
34196 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
34197 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
34198 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
34199 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
34203 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
34204 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
34205 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
34206 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
34207 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
34209 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
34211 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
34212 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
34213 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
34214 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
34215 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
34217 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
34218 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
34219 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34221 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
34223 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34224 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
34225 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
34226 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
34227 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
34229 .vitem &*use_sender*&
34230 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34232 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
34234 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
34235 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
34236 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
34237 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
34238 usefulness of callout caching.
34241 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34243 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
34245 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
34246 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
34247 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
34248 when that is used for the connections.
34249 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
34250 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
34251 if the use_sender option is used,
34252 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
34253 and if no other callouts intervene.
34256 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
34257 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
34258 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
34259 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
34260 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
34261 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
34262 these circumstances.
34264 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
34265 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
34266 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
34267 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
34268 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
34269 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
34270 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
34272 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
34273 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
34274 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
34275 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
34280 .subsection "Callout caching" SECTcallvercache
34281 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
34282 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
34283 .cindex "caching" "callout"
34284 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
34285 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
34286 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
34287 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
34288 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
34289 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
34291 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
34292 the failure. However, for subsequent failures that use the cache data, this message
34295 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
34296 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
34297 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
34299 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
34300 commands up to and including
34304 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
34305 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
34306 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
34307 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
34308 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
34309 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
34310 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
34312 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
34313 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
34314 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
34315 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
34316 will eventually be noticed.
34318 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
34319 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
34320 behaviour will be the same.
34324 .section "Quota caching" "SECTquotacache"
34325 .cindex "hints database" "quota cache"
34326 .cindex "quota" "cache, description of"
34327 .cindex "caching" "quota"
34328 Exim caches the results of quota verification
34329 in order to reduce the amount of resources used.
34330 The &"callout"& hints database is used.
34332 The default cache periods are five minutes for a positive (good) result
34333 and one hour for a negative result.
34334 To change the periods the &%quota%& option can be followed by an equals sign
34335 and a number of optional paramemters, separated by commas.
34338 verify = recipient/quota=cachepos=1h,cacheneg=1d
34340 Possible parameters are:
34342 .vitem &*cachepos&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34343 .cindex "quota cache" "positive entry expiry, specifying"
34344 Set the lifetime for a positive cache entry.
34345 A value of zero seconds is legitimate.
34347 .vitem &*cacheneg&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34348 .cindex "quota cache" "negative entry expiry, specifying"
34349 As above, for a negative entry.
34351 .vitem &*no_cache*&
34352 Set both positive and negative lifetimes to zero.
34354 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
34355 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
34356 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
34357 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
34358 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
34359 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
34362 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
34364 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
34365 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
34366 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
34367 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
34368 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
34369 550 Sender verification failed
34371 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
34372 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
34373 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
34374 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
34377 verify = sender/no_details
34380 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
34381 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
34382 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
34383 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
34384 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
34385 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
34386 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
34389 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
34390 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
34391 verification also fails.
34393 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
34394 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
34397 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
34398 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
34399 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
34402 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
34404 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
34405 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
34406 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
34407 verification to succeed.
34409 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
34410 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
34411 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
34412 option. For example:
34414 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
34416 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
34417 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
34419 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
34420 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
34421 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
34422 address and a report is output for each of them.
34426 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
34427 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
34428 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
34429 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
34430 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
34431 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
34432 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
34436 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
34437 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
34438 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
34439 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
34440 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
34441 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
34443 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
34444 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
34445 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
34446 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
34449 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
34451 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
34453 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
34454 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
34456 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
34457 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
34460 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
34461 use for the DNS query. The default is:
34463 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
34465 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
34466 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
34467 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
34468 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
34471 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
34473 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
34474 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
34475 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
34477 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
34478 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
34479 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
34480 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
34481 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
34482 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
34483 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
34484 of legitimate HELO domains.
34486 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
34487 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
34488 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
34489 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
34492 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
34494 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
34495 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
34496 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
34501 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
34502 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
34503 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
34504 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
34505 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
34506 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
34507 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
34508 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
34510 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
34511 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
34512 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
34513 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
34514 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
34515 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
34516 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
34517 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
34519 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
34520 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
34523 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
34524 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
34527 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
34528 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
34531 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
34533 recipients = +batv_senders
34534 message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
34536 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
34538 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
34539 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
34540 !condition = $prvscheck_result
34541 message = Invalid reverse path signature.
34543 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
34544 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
34545 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
34546 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
34547 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
34549 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
34550 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
34551 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
34552 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
34553 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
34554 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
34555 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
34557 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
34558 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
34559 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
34560 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
34564 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
34566 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
34567 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
34568 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
34571 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
34574 external_smtp_batv:
34576 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
34577 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
34578 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
34579 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
34582 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
34586 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
34587 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
34588 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
34589 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
34590 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
34591 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
34592 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
34593 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
34594 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
34595 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
34597 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
34598 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
34599 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
34600 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
34601 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
34602 same host is fulfilling both functions,
34604 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
34606 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
34607 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
34608 system to arbitrary domains.
34611 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
34612 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
34613 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
34614 example, suppose you want to do the following:
34617 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
34618 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
34619 &'my.dom2.example'&.
34621 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
34622 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
34624 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
34625 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
34629 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
34631 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
34632 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
34633 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
34635 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
34639 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
34640 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
34642 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
34643 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
34644 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
34645 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
34646 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
34647 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
34648 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
34652 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
34653 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
34654 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
34655 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
34656 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
34661 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34662 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34664 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
34665 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
34666 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
34667 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
34668 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
34669 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
34672 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
34673 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
34674 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
34675 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
34676 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
34678 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
34679 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
34680 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
34683 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
34684 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
34686 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
34687 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
34688 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
34690 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
34691 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
34693 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
34696 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
34699 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
34700 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
34701 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
34702 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
34703 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
34704 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
34706 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
34707 temporarily created in a file called:
34709 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
34711 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
34712 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
34713 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
34714 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
34715 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
34717 control = no_mbox_unspool
34719 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
34720 same directory by default.
34724 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
34725 .cindex "virus scanning"
34726 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
34727 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
34728 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
34729 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
34730 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
34731 in memory and thus are much faster.
34733 Since message data needs to have arrived,
34734 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
34736 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
34737 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
34740 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
34741 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
34743 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
34744 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
34745 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
34746 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
34748 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
34750 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
34752 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
34754 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
34756 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
34757 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
34758 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
34762 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
34763 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
34764 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
34765 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
34766 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
34767 This scanner type takes one option,
34768 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34769 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34770 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34771 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34772 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
34773 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
34774 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
34776 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
34777 If &`pass_unscanned`&
34778 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
34779 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
34784 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34785 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34786 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
34788 If you omit the argument, the default path
34789 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
34791 If you use a remote host,
34792 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
34793 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
34794 For information about available commands and their options you may use
34796 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
34802 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
34803 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
34804 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
34806 .vitem &%aveserver%&
34807 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34808 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
34809 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
34810 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
34813 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
34818 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
34819 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
34820 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
34821 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
34822 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
34824 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
34825 a UNIX socket specification,
34826 a TCP socket specification,
34827 or a (global) option.
34829 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
34830 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
34831 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
34832 and the second a port number,
34833 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
34834 These per-server options are supported:
34836 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
34839 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
34840 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
34842 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
34846 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
34847 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
34848 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
34849 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
34850 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
34852 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
34854 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
34855 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
34856 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
34857 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
34859 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
34860 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
34861 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
34862 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
34863 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
34864 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
34865 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
34866 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
34867 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
34869 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
34870 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
34871 (Connection refused)
34874 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
34875 contributing the code for this scanner.
34878 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
34879 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
34880 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
34881 type takes 3 mandatory options:
34884 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
34885 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
34888 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
34889 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
34890 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
34891 the &"trigger"& expression.
34894 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
34895 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
34896 &"name"& expression.
34899 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
34901 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
34903 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
34904 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
34905 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
34906 configuration setting:
34908 av_scanner = cmdline:\
34909 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
34910 found in file:'(.+)'
34913 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
34914 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
34916 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34917 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34918 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34919 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34922 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
34923 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
34925 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
34926 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
34929 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
34930 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
34931 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
34935 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
34937 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
34939 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
34940 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
34941 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
34942 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
34945 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
34947 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
34950 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
34951 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
34952 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
34954 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
34956 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
34957 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
34959 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
34960 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34961 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
34962 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
34963 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
34966 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
34968 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
34971 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
34972 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
34973 though some documentation was available in English.
34974 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
34975 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
34976 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
34978 The only option for this scanner type is
34979 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
34980 provided that mksd has
34981 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
34983 av_scanner = mksd:2
34985 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
34988 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
34989 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
34990 running on the local machine.
34991 There are four options:
34992 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
34993 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
34994 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
34995 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
34996 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
34999 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
35001 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
35002 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
35003 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
35004 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
35005 specify an empty element to get this.
35008 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
35009 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
35010 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
35011 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
35012 client communication. For example:
35014 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
35016 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
35020 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
35021 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
35024 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
35025 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
35026 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
35027 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
35028 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
35029 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
35032 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
35033 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
35034 The first element can then be one of
35037 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
35038 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
35041 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
35042 the condition fails immediately.
35044 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
35045 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
35046 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
35047 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
35048 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
35051 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
35052 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
35053 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
35055 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
35056 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
35059 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
35061 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
35063 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
35064 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
35065 is set to record the actual address used.
35067 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
35068 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
35069 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
35070 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
35073 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
35074 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
35076 Here is a very simple scanning example:
35079 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35081 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
35083 deny malware = */defer_ok
35084 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35086 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
35087 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
35089 av_scanner = $acl_m0
35091 in the main Exim configuration.
35093 deny set acl_m0 = sophie
35095 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35097 deny set acl_m0 = aveserver
35099 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35103 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
35104 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
35105 .cindex "spam scanning"
35106 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
35108 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
35109 score and a report for the message.
35110 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
35112 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
35113 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
35114 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
35116 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
35118 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
35120 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
35121 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
35124 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
35125 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
35126 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
35127 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
35128 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
35129 configuration as follows (example):
35131 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
35133 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
35134 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
35135 iptables firewall, consider setting
35136 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
35137 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
35138 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
35139 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
35143 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
35145 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
35147 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
35150 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
35151 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
35152 filename instead of an address/port pair:
35154 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
35156 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
35157 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
35158 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
35159 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
35161 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
35162 192.168.2.11 783 : \
35165 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
35166 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
35167 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
35170 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
35171 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
35172 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
35173 take care to not double the separator.
35175 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
35176 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
35177 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
35178 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
35180 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
35182 The supported options are:
35184 pri=<priority> Selection priority
35185 weight=<value> Selection bias
35186 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
35187 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
35188 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
35189 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
35192 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
35193 higher values being tried first.
35194 The default priority is 1.
35196 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
35197 Within a priority set
35198 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
35199 The default value for selection bias is 1.
35201 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
35202 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
35203 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
35204 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
35206 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
35207 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
35209 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
35210 The default value is two minutes.
35212 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
35213 a failed connect is made.
35214 The default is to not retry.
35216 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
35217 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
35218 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
35221 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
35222 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
35223 is set to record the actual address used.
35225 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
35226 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
35229 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35231 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
35232 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
35233 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
35234 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
35235 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
35238 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
35239 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
35240 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
35241 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
35242 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
35244 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
35245 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
35247 or the use of PRDR,
35248 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
35249 are needed to use this feature.
35251 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
35252 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
35253 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
35256 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
35257 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
35258 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
35261 deny condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
35263 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35266 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
35267 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
35268 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
35269 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
35271 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
35272 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
35274 Except for &$spam_report$&,
35275 these variables are saved with the received message so are
35276 available for use at delivery time.
35279 .vitem &$spam_score$&
35280 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
35281 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
35283 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
35284 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
35285 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
35286 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
35287 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
35289 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
35290 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
35291 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
35292 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
35293 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
35294 spam bar is 50 characters.
35296 .vitem &$spam_report$&
35297 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
35298 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
35299 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
35300 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
35301 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
35302 unencoded in headers.
35304 .vitem &$spam_action$&
35305 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
35306 spam score versus threshold.
35307 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
35311 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
35312 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
35313 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
35315 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
35316 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
35317 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
35318 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
35319 spam condition, like this:
35321 deny spam = joe/defer_ok
35322 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35324 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
35326 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
35329 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
35330 warn spam = nobody:true
35331 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
35332 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
35334 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
35335 # is over threshold
35337 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
35339 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
35340 deny spam = nobody:true
35341 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
35342 message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
35347 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
35348 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
35349 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
35350 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
35351 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
35352 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
35353 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
35354 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
35355 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
35356 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
35359 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
35360 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
35361 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
35362 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
35363 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
35364 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
35365 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
35367 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
35368 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
35369 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
35370 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
35371 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
35373 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
35374 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
35375 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
35376 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
35377 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
35380 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
35382 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
35386 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
35388 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
35389 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
35390 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
35391 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
35393 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
35394 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
35395 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
35396 the full path and filename.
35398 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
35399 filename, and the default path is then used.
35401 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
35402 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages.
35403 The variable &$mime_filename$& will have the suggested name for the file.
35404 Note however that this might contain anything, and is very difficult
35405 to safely use as all or even part of the filename.
35406 If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
35407 automatically unlinked.
35409 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
35410 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
35411 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
35412 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
35413 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
35415 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
35416 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
35417 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
35419 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
35420 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
35421 available in the MIME ACL:
35424 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
35425 &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35426 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_level$&
35427 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35428 If there are problems decoding, these variables contain information on
35429 the detected issue.
35431 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
35432 .vindex &$mime_boundary$&
35433 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$& below), it should
35434 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
35435 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
35436 contains the empty string.
35438 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
35439 .vindex &$mime_charset$&
35440 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
35441 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
35447 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
35448 case-insensitively.
35450 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
35451 .vindex &$mime_content_description$&
35452 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
35453 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
35454 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
35455 only used for display purposes.
35457 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
35458 .vindex &$mime_content_disposition$&
35459 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
35460 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
35462 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
35463 .vindex &$mime_content_id$&
35464 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
35465 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
35467 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
35468 .vindex &$mime_content_size$&
35469 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35470 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
35471 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
35472 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
35474 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35475 .vindex &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35476 This variable contains the normalized content of the
35477 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
35478 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
35480 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
35481 .vindex &$mime_content_type$&
35482 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
35483 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
35484 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
35488 application/octet-stream
35492 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
35495 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35496 .vindex &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35497 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35498 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
35499 containing the decoded data.
35504 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
35505 .vindex &$mime_filename$&
35506 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
35507 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
35508 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
35509 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047) or
35510 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2231,RFC 2231)
35511 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
35513 found, this variable contains the empty string.
35515 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35516 .vindex &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35517 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
35518 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
35519 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
35521 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
35522 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
35526 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
35529 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
35530 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
35533 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
35534 and the rest are attachments.
35537 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
35540 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
35541 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
35542 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
35544 deny !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
35545 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
35546 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
35547 message = HTML mail is not accepted here
35550 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
35551 .vindex &$mime_is_multipart$&
35552 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
35553 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
35554 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
35555 want to carry out specific actions on them.
35557 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35558 .vindex &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35559 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
35560 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
35561 decoding is fully recursive.
35563 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
35564 .vindex &$mime_part_count$&
35565 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
35566 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
35567 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
35568 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
35569 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
35570 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
35575 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
35576 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
35577 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
35578 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
35579 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
35581 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
35582 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
35583 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
35584 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
35585 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
35587 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
35588 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
35589 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
35590 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
35591 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
35592 32K characters are checked.
35594 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
35595 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
35596 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
35597 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
35598 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
35600 deny regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
35601 message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
35603 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
35604 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
35605 matching regular expression.
35606 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
35607 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
35609 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
35617 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35620 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
35621 "Local scan function"
35622 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
35623 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
35624 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
35625 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
35626 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
35628 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
35629 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
35630 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
35631 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
35632 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
35634 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
35635 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
35636 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
35637 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
35639 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
35640 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
35641 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
35642 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
35644 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
35645 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
35646 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
35647 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
35648 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
35649 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
35650 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
35651 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
35652 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
35656 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
35657 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
35658 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
35659 function is before building Exim, by setting
35660 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
35661 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
35662 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
35663 directory, so you might set
35665 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
35666 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
35668 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
35669 the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
35670 and then #include "local_scan.h".
35672 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
35673 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
35674 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
35675 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
35676 _src/local_scan.c_.
35678 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
35679 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
35681 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35683 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
35688 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
35689 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
35690 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
35691 You must include this line near the start of your code:
35694 #include "local_scan.h"
35696 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
35697 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
35698 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
35699 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
35700 It also makes available the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
35701 strings and pointers to character strings:
35703 #define CS (char *)
35704 #define CCS (const char *)
35705 #define CSS (char **)
35706 #define US (unsigned char *)
35707 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
35708 #define USS (unsigned char **)
35710 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
35712 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
35714 The arguments are as follows:
35717 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
35718 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
35719 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
35721 The descriptor is positioned at character 26 of the file, which is the first
35722 character of the body itself, because the first 26 characters (19 characters
35723 before Exim 4.97) are the message id followed by &`-D`& and a newline.
35724 If you rewind the file, you should use the
35725 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
35726 case this changes in some future version.
35728 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
35729 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
35732 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
35735 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
35736 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
35737 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
35738 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
35739 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
35740 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
35742 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
35743 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35744 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
35746 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
35747 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35748 queued without immediate delivery.
35750 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
35751 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
35752 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
35753 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
35754 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
35757 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
35758 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
35759 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
35762 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35763 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
35764 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
35765 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
35766 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
35767 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
35768 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35770 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35771 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
35772 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35775 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
35776 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
35777 &%-oe%& command line options.
35781 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
35782 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
35783 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
35784 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
35785 want to do this, you must have the line
35787 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35789 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
35790 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
35791 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
35794 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
35795 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
35796 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
35797 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
35798 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
35799 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
35801 static int my_integer_option = 42;
35802 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
35804 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
35805 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
35806 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
35809 int local_scan_options_count =
35810 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
35812 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
35813 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
35817 my_string = some string of text...
35819 The available types of option data are as follows:
35822 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
35823 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
35824 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
35825 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
35826 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
35827 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
35830 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
35831 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
35832 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
35833 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
35836 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
35837 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
35840 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
35841 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
35842 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
35843 printed with the suffix K or M.
35845 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
35846 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
35847 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
35848 always output in octal.
35850 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
35851 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
35852 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
35854 .vitem &*opt_time*&
35855 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
35856 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
35859 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
35860 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
35864 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
35865 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
35866 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
35867 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
35868 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
35869 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
35870 C variables are as follows:
35873 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
35874 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
35875 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
35877 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
35878 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
35879 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
35881 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
35882 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
35883 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
35884 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
35887 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
35888 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
35889 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
35892 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
35893 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
35897 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
35898 selected, you should use code like this:
35900 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
35901 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
35903 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
35904 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
35905 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
35907 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
35908 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
35911 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
35912 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
35914 .vitem &*const&~uschar&~*headers_charset*&
35915 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
35917 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
35918 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
35919 &%-bh%& command line option.
35921 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
35922 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
35923 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
35925 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
35926 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
35927 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
35928 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
35930 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
35931 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
35932 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
35934 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
35935 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
35937 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
35938 The number of accepted recipients.
35940 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
35941 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
35942 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
35943 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
35944 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
35945 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
35946 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
35947 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
35948 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
35949 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
35950 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
35951 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
35953 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
35954 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
35956 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
35957 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
35958 locally-submitted messages.
35960 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
35961 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
35962 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
35964 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
35965 The name of the sending host, if known.
35967 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
35968 The port on the sending host.
35970 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
35971 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
35973 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
35974 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
35976 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
35977 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
35978 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
35982 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
35983 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
35984 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
35985 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
35990 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
35991 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
35993 .vitem &*int&~type*&
35994 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
35995 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
35996 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
35997 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
35998 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
35999 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
36001 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
36002 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
36005 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
36006 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
36007 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
36012 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
36013 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
36016 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
36017 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
36019 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
36020 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
36021 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
36022 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
36024 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
36025 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
36026 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
36027 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
36028 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
36029 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
36030 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
36031 is NULL for all recipients.
36036 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
36037 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
36038 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
36039 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
36043 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
36044 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
36046 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
36047 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
36048 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
36049 for the process in &%newumask%&.
36051 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
36052 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
36053 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
36054 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
36055 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
36057 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
36059 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
36060 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
36061 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
36062 return value is as follows:
36067 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
36073 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
36079 The process timed out.
36083 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
36086 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
36087 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
36088 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
36089 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
36090 forks a subprocess that is running
36092 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
36094 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
36095 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
36096 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
36097 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
36099 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
36100 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
36101 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
36102 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
36105 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
36106 *sender_authentication)*&
36107 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
36110 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
36112 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
36115 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
36116 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'printf()'&. The
36117 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
36118 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
36119 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
36121 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
36122 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
36125 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
36126 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
36127 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
36128 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
36129 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
36130 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
36131 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
36132 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
36134 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
36135 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
36136 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
36137 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
36138 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
36139 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
36141 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
36142 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
36143 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
36144 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
36146 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
36147 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
36148 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
36149 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
36150 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
36151 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
36152 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
36153 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
36154 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
36155 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
36157 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
36158 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
36160 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
36161 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
36164 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
36165 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
36166 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
36167 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
36168 match the specification, the function does nothing.
36171 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
36172 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
36173 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
36174 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
36175 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
36176 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
36178 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
36180 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
36181 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
36182 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
36183 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
36184 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
36187 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
36188 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
36189 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
36190 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
36191 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
36192 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
36193 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
36194 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
36196 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
36197 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
36198 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
36199 .itable none 0 0 2 15* left 85* left
36200 .irow &`OK`& "match succeeded"
36201 .irow &`FAIL`& "match failed"
36202 .irow &`DEFER`& "match deferred"
36204 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
36205 inability to contact a database.
36207 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
36209 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
36210 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
36211 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
36213 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
36215 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
36216 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
36217 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
36219 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
36221 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
36224 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
36226 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
36227 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
36228 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
36229 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
36230 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
36231 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
36234 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
36236 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
36237 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
36238 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
36239 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
36240 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
36241 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
36244 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
36245 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
36246 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
36247 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
36249 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
36250 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
36251 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
36252 value afterwards. For example:
36254 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
36255 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
36256 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
36259 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
36260 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
36261 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
36262 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
36269 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
36270 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
36271 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to
36272 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047). Typically
36273 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
36274 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
36275 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
36276 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
36277 binary string is returned with an error message.
36279 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
36280 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
36281 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
36283 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
36284 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
36285 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
36286 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
36287 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
36289 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
36290 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
36291 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
36293 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
36294 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
36295 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
36296 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
36300 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
36301 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
36304 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
36305 The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
36306 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
36307 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
36308 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
36309 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
36310 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
36311 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
36314 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
36315 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
36317 The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
36318 (when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
36319 This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
36320 sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
36322 The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
36323 Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
36324 ABI version number was incremented.
36326 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
36327 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
36328 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
36329 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
36330 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
36331 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
36332 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
36334 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
36335 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
36337 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
36338 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
36339 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
36340 multiple output lines.
36342 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
36344 guarantee a flush of
36345 pending output, and therefore does not test
36346 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
36347 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
36348 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
36349 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
36350 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
36353 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
36354 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
36355 chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
36356 The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
36357 data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
36358 FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
36359 Exim bombs out if it ever
36360 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36362 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
36363 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
36364 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36366 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
36369 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
36372 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
36373 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
36374 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
36375 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
36376 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
36377 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
36383 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
36384 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
36385 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
36386 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
36387 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
36388 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
36389 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
36392 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
36393 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
36394 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
36395 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
36397 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
36398 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
36400 store_pool = POOL_PERM
36402 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
36403 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
36404 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
36405 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
36407 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
36408 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
36409 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
36410 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
36417 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36420 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
36421 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
36422 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
36423 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
36424 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
36425 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
36426 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
36427 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
36429 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
36430 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
36431 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
36432 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
36433 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
36435 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
36436 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
36437 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
36438 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
36439 .cindex retry condition
36440 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
36441 prevent it happening on retries.
36443 .vindex "&$domain$&"
36444 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36445 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
36446 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
36447 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
36448 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
36449 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
36450 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
36453 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
36454 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
36455 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
36456 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
36457 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
36458 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
36459 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
36461 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
36462 system_filter_user = exim
36464 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
36465 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
36466 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
36467 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
36468 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
36469 by the &%reply%& command.
36472 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
36473 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
36474 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
36475 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
36477 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
36478 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
36482 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
36483 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
36484 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
36485 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
36486 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
36487 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
36490 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
36491 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
36492 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
36493 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
36494 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
36495 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
36496 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
36498 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
36499 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
36500 succeed, it will not be tried again.
36501 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
36502 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
36504 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
36505 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
36506 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
36507 to which users' filter files can refer.
36511 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
36512 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
36513 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
36514 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
36515 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
36519 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
36520 .cindex "freezing messages"
36521 .cindex "message" "freezing"
36522 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
36523 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
36524 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
36525 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
36526 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
36527 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
36528 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
36529 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
36530 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
36532 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
36534 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
36536 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
36537 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
36538 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
36539 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
36540 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
36543 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
36544 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
36545 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
36546 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
36548 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
36549 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
36550 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
36551 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
36552 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
36553 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
36554 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
36555 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
36556 message. For example:
36558 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
36559 because it contains attachments that we are \
36560 not prepared to receive."
36563 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
36564 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
36565 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
36566 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
36567 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
36568 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
36571 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
36572 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
36574 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
36575 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
36576 generated by the filter.
36578 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
36580 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
36581 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
36587 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
36588 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
36593 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
36594 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
36595 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
36596 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
36597 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
36599 headers add <string>
36600 headers remove <string>
36602 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
36603 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
36604 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to
36605 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822) syntax. Leading white
36606 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
36607 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
36609 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
36610 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
36611 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
36614 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
36615 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
36618 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
36619 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
36620 space after input continuations is ignored.
36622 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
36623 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
36624 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
36625 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
36626 header with the same name, they are all removed.
36628 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
36629 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
36630 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
36631 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
36632 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
36633 used for all recipients of the message.
36635 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
36636 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
36637 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
36638 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
36639 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
36640 until the message is actually being written (see section
36641 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
36643 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
36644 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
36645 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
36646 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
36647 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
36648 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
36649 modified more than once.
36651 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
36652 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
36655 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
36656 headers remove "Subject"
36657 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
36658 headers remove "Old-Subject"
36663 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
36664 .cindex "envelope from"
36665 .cindex "envelope sender"
36666 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
36668 errors_to <some address>
36670 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
36671 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
36672 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
36675 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
36677 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
36678 address if its delivery failed.
36682 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
36683 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
36684 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
36685 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
36686 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
36687 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
36688 such as &$local_part_data$& and &$domain_data$& can be used,
36689 and indeed, the choice of filter file could be made dependent on them.
36690 This is an example of a router which implements such a filter:
36695 domains = +local_domains
36696 file = /central/filters/$local_part_data
36701 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
36702 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
36703 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
36704 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
36706 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
36707 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
36708 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
36709 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
36711 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
36712 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
36713 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
36720 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36721 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36723 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
36724 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
36725 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
36726 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
36727 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
36728 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
36729 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
36730 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
36732 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
36733 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
36734 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
36735 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
36736 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
36738 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
36739 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
36740 loopback interface specially in any way.
36742 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
36743 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
36748 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
36749 .cindex "message" "submission"
36750 .cindex "submission mode"
36751 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
36752 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
36753 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
36754 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
36756 control = submission
36758 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
36759 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
36760 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
36761 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
36762 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
36763 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
36765 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
36766 control = submission
36768 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
36769 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
36770 is used to separate options. For example:
36772 control = submission/sender_retain
36774 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
36775 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
36776 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
36777 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
36778 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
36779 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
36780 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
36782 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
36783 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
36786 control = submission/domain=some.domain
36788 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
36789 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
36790 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
36791 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
36793 accept authenticated = *
36794 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
36795 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
36796 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
36798 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
36799 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
36800 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
36802 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
36804 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
36807 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
36809 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
36810 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
36811 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
36812 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
36814 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
36815 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
36816 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
36817 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
36818 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
36819 spoof another's address.
36821 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
36822 .cindex "line endings"
36823 .cindex "carriage return"
36825 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821)
36826 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
36827 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
36828 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
36829 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
36830 use CRLF or just CR.
36832 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
36833 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
36834 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
36835 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
36836 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
36837 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
36838 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
36839 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
36843 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
36846 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
36847 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
36850 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
36851 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
36852 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
36853 people trying to play silly games.
36855 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
36856 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
36857 line and a bare LF in a body line is replaced with a space.
36859 If the first header line received in a message does not end with CRLF, a subsequent
36860 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
36867 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
36868 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
36869 .cindex "address" "qualification"
36870 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
36871 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
36872 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
36873 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
36874 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
36876 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
36877 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
36878 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
36879 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
36880 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
36882 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
36883 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
36884 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
36885 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
36886 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
36887 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
36888 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
36889 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
36894 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
36895 .cindex "&""From""& line"
36896 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
36897 .cindex "sender" "address"
36898 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
36899 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
36900 .cindex "envelope from"
36901 .cindex "envelope sender"
36902 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
36903 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
36904 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
36905 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
36907 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
36908 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
36910 This line precedes the
36911 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
36912 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
36913 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
36914 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
36915 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
36916 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
36917 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
36918 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
36919 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
36920 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
36922 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
36923 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
36924 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
36925 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
36927 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
36928 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
36929 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
36930 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
36932 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
36933 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
36934 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
36936 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
36937 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
36938 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
36939 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
36943 .section "Header lines"
36944 .subsection "Resent- header lines" SECID220
36946 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
36947 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
36948 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
36949 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
36950 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
36951 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
36954 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
36955 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
36958 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
36959 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
36963 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
36964 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
36966 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
36967 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
36968 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
36970 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
36973 For a locally-submitted message,
36974 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
36975 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
36976 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
36977 included in log lines in this case.
36979 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
36980 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
36986 .subsection Auto-Submitted: SECID221
36987 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
36988 includes the header line:
36990 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
36993 .subsection Bcc: SECID222
36994 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
36995 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
36996 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
36997 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
36998 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
37001 .subsection Date: SECID223
37003 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
37004 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
37005 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
37007 .subsection Delivery-date: SECID224
37008 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
37009 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
37010 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard
37011 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37013 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
37014 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
37015 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
37016 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
37020 .subsection Envelope-to: SECID225
37021 .chindex Envelope-to:
37022 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
37023 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard
37024 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822) header set.
37025 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
37026 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
37027 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
37028 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
37032 .subsection From: SECTthefrohea
37034 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
37035 .cindex "message" "submission"
37036 .cindex "submission mode"
37037 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
37038 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
37041 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
37042 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
37044 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
37045 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
37047 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
37048 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
37049 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
37051 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
37052 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
37054 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
37055 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
37059 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
37061 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
37062 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
37063 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
37064 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
37065 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
37066 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
37067 &%qualify_domain%&.
37069 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
37070 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
37071 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
37072 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
37075 .subsection Message-ID: SECID226
37076 .chindex Message-ID:
37077 .cindex "message" "submission"
37078 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
37079 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
37080 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
37081 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
37082 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
37083 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
37084 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
37085 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
37086 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
37087 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
37090 .subsection Received: SECID227
37092 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
37093 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
37094 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
37096 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
37097 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
37098 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
37099 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
37101 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
37102 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
37103 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
37106 .subsection References: SECID228
37107 .chindex References:
37108 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
37109 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
37111 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37112 (which states that replies should contain such a header line),
37113 and section 3.14 of &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc3834,RFC 3834)
37114 (which states that automatic
37115 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
37116 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
37117 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
37118 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
37119 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
37123 .subsection Return-path: SECID229
37124 .chindex Return-path:
37125 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
37126 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
37127 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
37128 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
37129 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
37130 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
37134 .subsection Sender: SECTthesenhea
37135 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
37136 .cindex "message" "submission"
37138 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
37139 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
37140 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
37141 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
37144 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
37145 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
37146 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
37147 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
37148 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
37149 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
37150 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
37151 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
37152 line is added to the message.
37154 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
37155 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
37156 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
37157 options true at the same time.
37159 .cindex "submission mode"
37160 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
37161 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
37162 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
37163 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
37165 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
37166 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
37167 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
37168 created as follows:
37171 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
37172 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
37173 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
37175 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
37176 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
37178 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
37179 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
37182 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
37183 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
37184 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
37185 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
37187 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
37188 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
37189 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
37190 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
37194 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
37195 "SECTheadersaddrem"
37196 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
37197 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
37198 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
37199 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
37200 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
37201 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
37202 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
37204 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
37205 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
37206 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
37207 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
37208 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
37209 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
37211 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
37212 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
37213 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
37215 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
37216 option must be in the form of one or more
37217 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37218 header lines, separated by newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
37220 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
37221 X-added-second: another added header line
37223 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
37225 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
37226 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
37227 Each header-line is separately expanded.
37229 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
37230 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
37231 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
37232 not part of the names. For example:
37234 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
37237 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
37238 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
37239 Each item is separately expanded.
37240 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
37241 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
37242 will act as list separators.
37244 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
37245 items are expanded at routing time,
37246 and then associated with all addresses that are
37247 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
37248 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
37249 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
37251 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
37252 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
37253 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
37254 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
37256 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
37257 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
37258 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
37261 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
37262 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
37263 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
37264 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
37265 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
37266 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
37267 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
37269 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
37270 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
37271 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
37272 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
37274 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
37275 the following consequences:
37278 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
37279 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
37280 to it, at all times.
37282 Header lines that are added by a router's
37283 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
37284 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
37286 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
37287 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
37289 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
37290 a later router or by a transport.
37292 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
37293 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
37295 headers_remove = subject
37296 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
37300 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
37301 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
37307 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
37308 .cindex "address" "constructed"
37309 .cindex "constructed address"
37310 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
37313 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
37317 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
37319 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
37320 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
37321 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
37322 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
37323 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
37324 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
37325 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
37326 there is no password file entry.
37329 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to
37330 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37332 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
37333 characters, it is encoded as described in
37334 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047), which defines a way of
37335 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
37336 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
37337 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
37338 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
37339 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
37343 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
37344 .cindex "case of local parts"
37345 .cindex "local part" "case of"
37346 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37347 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
37348 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
37349 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
37350 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
37351 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
37352 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
37355 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
37356 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
37357 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
37358 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
37359 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
37363 domains = +local_domains
37364 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
37365 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
37368 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
37369 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
37370 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
37371 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
37372 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
37376 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
37377 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
37378 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
37379 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37380 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
37381 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
37382 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
37383 empty components for compatibility.
37387 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
37388 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
37389 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
37390 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
37391 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
37392 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
37394 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
37395 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
37396 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
37397 example, a header such as
37401 might get rewritten as
37403 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
37405 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
37406 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
37409 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
37410 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
37411 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
37412 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
37413 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
37414 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
37415 .ecindex IIDmesproc
37419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37420 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37422 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
37423 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
37424 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
37425 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
37426 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
37427 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
37428 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
37431 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
37433 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
37435 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
37438 For mail delivery, the following are available:
37441 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
37443 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
37446 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
37449 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
37450 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
37453 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
37454 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
37455 used to contain the envelope information.
37459 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
37460 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
37461 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
37462 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
37463 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
37466 .cindex "SIZE" "option on MAIL command"
37467 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
37468 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
37469 processing is the same in both cases.
37471 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
37472 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
37473 extension is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
37474 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
37475 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
37476 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
37477 .cindex "transport" "filter"
37478 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
37479 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
37482 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
37483 pipelining extension to SMTP
37484 (&url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2197,RFC 2197))
37485 to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets required for the transaction.
37487 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
37488 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
37489 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
37490 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
37491 is called for verification.
37493 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
37494 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
37495 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
37497 .cindex "carriage return"
37499 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37500 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
37501 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37504 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
37505 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
37506 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
37507 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
37508 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
37509 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
37510 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
37511 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
37512 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
37514 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
37515 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
37516 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
37517 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
37519 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
37520 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
37521 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
37522 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
37524 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
37525 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
37526 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
37527 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
37528 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected.
37529 If it finds one, it arranges to attempt that message on the same connection.
37531 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
37532 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
37534 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37535 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
37536 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
37537 square bracket of the IP address.
37542 .subsection "Errors in outgoing SMTP" SECToutSMTPerr
37543 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
37544 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
37545 .cindex "host" "error"
37546 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
37547 message errors, and recipient errors.
37550 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
37551 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
37552 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
37555 Connection refused or timed out,
37557 Any error response code on connection,
37559 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
37561 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
37563 I/O errors at any time,
37565 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
37566 the &"."& at the end of the data.
37569 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
37570 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
37571 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
37572 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
37573 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
37574 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
37575 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
37576 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
37578 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
37579 .cindex "message" "error"
37580 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
37581 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
37582 message errors are:
37585 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
37588 Timeout after MAIL,
37590 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
37591 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
37592 connection at any other time.
37595 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
37596 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
37597 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
37598 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
37599 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
37600 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
37601 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
37602 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
37603 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
37604 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
37606 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
37607 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
37608 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
37611 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
37612 .cindex "recipient" "error"
37613 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
37614 recipient errors are:
37617 Any error response to RCPT,
37619 Timeout after RCPT.
37622 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
37623 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
37624 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
37625 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
37626 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
37627 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
37628 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
37629 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
37630 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
37631 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
37632 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
37633 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
37634 the retry clock is reset.
37636 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
37637 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
37638 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
37639 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
37640 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
37641 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
37642 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
37643 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
37644 recipient's retry time.
37647 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
37648 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
37649 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
37650 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
37651 until the next delivery attempt.
37653 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
37654 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
37655 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
37656 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
37657 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
37660 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
37661 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
37662 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
37663 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
37664 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
37665 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
37666 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
37668 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
37669 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
37670 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
37671 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
37672 then to be treated as a host error.
37674 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
37675 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
37676 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
37677 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
37678 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
37683 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
37684 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
37685 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
37688 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
37689 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
37690 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
37692 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
37694 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
37695 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
37696 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
37697 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
37698 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
37699 stream and exits with an error code.
37701 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
37702 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
37703 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
37704 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
37706 .cindex "carriage return"
37708 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37709 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
37710 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37712 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
37713 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
37714 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
37716 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
37717 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
37718 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
37719 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
37720 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
37721 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
37722 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
37723 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
37725 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
37726 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
37727 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
37728 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
37729 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
37730 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
37731 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
37732 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
37733 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
37735 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
37736 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
37737 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
37739 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
37740 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
37741 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
37742 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
37743 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
37745 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
37746 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
37747 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
37748 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
37749 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
37750 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
37751 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
37753 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
37754 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
37755 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
37756 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
37757 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
37759 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
37760 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
37761 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
37762 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
37763 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
37764 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
37765 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
37766 a delivery process.
37768 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
37769 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
37770 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
37771 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
37772 however, available with &'inetd'&.
37774 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
37775 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
37776 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
37777 section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&.
37779 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
37780 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
37781 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
37785 .subsection "Unrecognized SMTP commands" SECID234
37786 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
37787 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
37788 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
37789 the error response to the last command. The default value for
37790 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
37791 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
37792 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
37795 .subsection "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" SECID235
37796 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
37797 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
37798 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
37799 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
37800 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
37801 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
37802 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
37803 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
37804 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
37805 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
37809 .subsection "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" SECID236
37810 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
37811 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
37812 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
37813 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
37814 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
37815 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
37816 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
37818 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
37819 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
37820 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
37821 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
37822 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
37825 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
37826 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
37827 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
37829 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
37830 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
37831 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
37832 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
37833 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
37838 .subsection "The VRFY and EXPN commands" SECID237
37839 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
37840 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
37841 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
37843 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
37844 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
37845 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
37846 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
37847 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
37848 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
37849 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
37850 SMTP response codes.
37852 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
37853 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
37854 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
37855 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
37856 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
37857 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
37858 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
37859 VRFY verification failures are logged in the main log for consistency with
37864 .subsection "The ETRN command" SECTETRN
37865 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
37866 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
37867 Most modern installations never need to use this.
37868 It is used for managing messages queued for an intermittently-connecting
37869 destination (eg. one using a dialup connection).
37871 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_etrn%&"
37872 The command is only available if permitted by an ACL
37873 specfied by the main-section &%acl_smtp_etrn%& option.
37875 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1985,RFC 1985)
37876 describes an ESMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
37877 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
37878 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
37879 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
37880 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
37882 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
37883 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
37884 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
37885 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
37886 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
37887 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
37888 argument. For example,
37896 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
37897 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
37898 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
37899 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
37900 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
37902 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
37903 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
37904 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
37905 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
37906 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
37907 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
37908 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
37909 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
37911 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
37912 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
37913 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
37914 whatever the form of its argument. For
37917 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
37918 $sender_host_address
37920 .vindex "&$domain$&"
37921 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
37922 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
37923 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
37924 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
37925 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
37926 for it to change them before running the command.
37930 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
37931 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
37932 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
37933 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
37934 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
37935 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
37936 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
37937 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
37938 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
37939 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
37940 runs for RCPT commands:
37944 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
37948 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
37949 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
37950 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
37951 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
37952 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
37953 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
37954 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
37955 envelope along with the message.
37957 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
37958 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
37959 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
37960 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
37961 can be used to specify it.
37963 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
37964 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
37965 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
37966 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
37967 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
37970 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
37971 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
37972 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
37977 driver = manualroute
37978 transport = smtp_appendfile
37979 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
37983 driver = appendfile
37984 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
37989 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
37990 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
37991 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
37995 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
37996 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
37997 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
37998 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
37999 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
38000 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
38001 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
38002 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
38003 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
38004 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
38006 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
38007 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
38009 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
38010 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
38011 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
38012 make some use of automatically, for example:
38014 554 Unexpected end of file
38015 Transaction started in line 10
38016 Error detected in line 14
38018 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
38021 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
38022 The error message was:
38024 501 '>' missing at end of address
38026 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
38027 The error was detected in line 12.
38028 The SMTP command at fault was:
38030 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
38032 1 previous message was successfully processed.
38033 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
38035 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
38036 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
38038 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
38039 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
38043 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38044 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38046 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
38047 "Customizing messages"
38048 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
38049 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
38050 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
38051 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
38052 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
38054 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
38055 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
38056 option. Exim also adds the line
38058 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
38060 to all warning and bounce messages,
38063 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
38064 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
38065 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
38066 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
38067 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
38068 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
38069 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
38071 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
38072 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
38073 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
38074 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
38075 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
38078 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
38079 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
38080 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
38081 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
38082 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
38083 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
38084 option, rounded to a whole number.
38086 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
38089 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
38090 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
38092 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
38093 failing addresses with their error messages.
38095 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
38096 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
38098 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
38099 The fields exist for back-compatibility
38102 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
38103 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
38104 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
38106 Subject: Mail delivery failed
38107 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
38108 {: returning message to sender}}
38110 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
38112 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
38113 {that you sent }{sent by
38117 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
38118 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
38120 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
38122 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
38125 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
38127 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
38130 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
38131 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
38132 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
38133 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
38134 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
38138 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
38139 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
38141 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
38142 the delayed addresses.
38144 The third item then ends the message.
38147 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
38148 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
38150 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
38151 $warn_message_delay
38153 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
38155 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
38156 {that you sent }{sent by
38160 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
38161 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
38163 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
38164 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
38165 The date of the message is: $h_date
38167 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
38169 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
38170 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
38171 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
38172 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
38173 the message will be returned to you.
38175 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
38176 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
38177 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
38178 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
38179 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
38180 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
38181 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
38182 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
38188 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38189 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38191 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
38192 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
38193 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
38197 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
38198 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
38199 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
38200 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
38201 routing explicitly:
38203 send_to_smart_host:
38204 driver = manualroute
38205 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
38206 transport = remote_smtp
38208 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
38209 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
38210 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
38211 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
38212 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
38217 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
38218 .cindex "mailing lists"
38219 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
38220 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
38221 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
38223 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
38224 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
38225 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
38226 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
38230 domains = lists.example
38231 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38234 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
38237 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
38238 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
38239 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
38240 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
38242 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
38243 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
38246 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
38247 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
38248 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
38249 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
38250 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
38252 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
38253 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
38254 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
38255 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
38256 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
38257 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
38258 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
38259 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
38260 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
38264 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
38265 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
38266 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
38267 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
38268 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
38269 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
38270 addresses are not rigorously checked.
38272 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
38273 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
38274 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
38275 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
38276 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
38280 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
38281 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
38282 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
38283 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
38284 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
38285 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
38286 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
38287 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
38288 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
38289 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
38291 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
38292 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
38293 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
38294 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
38295 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
38296 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
38297 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
38298 pre-existing messages.
38300 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
38301 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
38302 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
38303 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
38304 one level of expansion anyway.
38308 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
38309 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
38310 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
38311 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
38312 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
38313 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
38315 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
38316 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
38320 domains = lists.example
38321 local_part_suffix = -request
38322 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file {/usr/lists}}
38323 file = /usr/lists/${local_part_data}-request
38328 domains = lists.example
38329 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38330 senders = ${if exists {$local_part_data} {lsearch;$local_part_data}{*}}
38331 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38334 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
38339 domains = lists.example
38341 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
38343 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
38344 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
38345 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
38348 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
38349 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
38350 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
38351 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
38352 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
38353 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
38354 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
38355 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
38356 &"unrouteable address"& error.
38358 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
38359 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
38360 the address, giving a suitable error message.
38365 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
38367 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
38368 .cindex "envelope from"
38369 .cindex "envelope sender"
38370 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
38371 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
38372 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
38373 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
38374 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
38375 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
38377 .oindex &%errors_to%&
38378 .oindex &%return_path%&
38379 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
38380 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
38381 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
38382 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
38383 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
38384 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
38385 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
38391 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38392 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38394 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
38395 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
38396 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
38397 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
38398 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
38399 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
38400 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
38403 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
38405 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
38406 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
38407 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
38408 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
38409 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
38410 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
38412 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
38413 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
38414 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
38415 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
38419 domains = ! +local_domains
38421 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38422 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
38425 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
38426 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
38427 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
38428 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
38431 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
38432 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
38433 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
38434 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
38435 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
38439 domains = ! +local_domains
38440 transport = remote_smtp
38442 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
38443 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38446 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
38447 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
38448 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
38449 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
38452 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
38453 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
38454 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
38455 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
38456 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
38457 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
38465 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
38466 .cindex "virtual domains"
38467 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
38468 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
38472 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
38473 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
38474 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
38476 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
38477 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
38478 have login accounts on that host.
38481 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
38482 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
38483 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
38484 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
38485 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
38486 to a router of this form:
38490 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
38491 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain_data}}
38494 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
38495 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
38496 domain that is being processed.
38497 The &(dsearch)& lookup used results in an untainted version of &$domain$&
38498 being placed into the &$domain_data$& variable.
38500 When the router runs, it looks up the local
38501 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
38502 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
38503 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
38505 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
38506 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
38507 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
38508 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
38510 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
38511 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
38512 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
38516 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
38517 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
38518 transport = my_mailboxes
38520 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
38521 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
38522 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
38523 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
38524 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
38528 driver = appendfile
38529 file = /var/mail/$domain_data/$local_part_data
38532 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
38533 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
38535 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
38536 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
38537 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
38538 information about the domains.
38542 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
38543 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
38544 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
38545 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
38546 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
38547 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
38548 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
38549 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
38550 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
38551 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
38552 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
38553 example, consider this router:
38558 file = $home/.forward
38559 local_part_suffix = -*
38560 local_part_suffix_optional
38563 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
38564 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
38565 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
38566 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
38568 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
38569 save /home/$local_part_data/Mail/special
38572 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
38573 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
38574 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
38575 control over which suffixes are valid.
38577 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
38578 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
38584 local_part_suffix = -*
38585 local_part_suffix_optional
38586 file = ${lookup {.forward$local_part_suffix} dsearch,ret=full {$home} {$value}fail}
38589 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
38590 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
38591 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
38592 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
38593 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
38597 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
38598 .cindex "vacation processing"
38599 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
38600 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
38601 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
38602 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
38603 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
38606 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
38607 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
38608 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
38609 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
38611 spqr, vacation-spqr
38614 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
38615 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
38616 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
38617 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
38618 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
38622 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
38623 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
38627 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
38628 .cindex "message" "copying every"
38629 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
38630 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
38631 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
38632 each day's messages.
38634 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
38635 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
38636 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
38637 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
38641 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
38642 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
38643 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
38644 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
38645 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
38646 permanently connected.
38648 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
38649 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
38650 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
38653 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
38654 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
38655 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
38656 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
38657 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
38658 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
38659 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
38660 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
38662 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
38663 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
38664 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
38665 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
38666 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
38667 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
38670 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
38671 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
38672 intermittent host. For example:
38674 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
38676 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
38677 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
38678 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
38679 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
38680 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
38681 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
38684 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
38685 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
38686 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
38687 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
38688 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
38689 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
38690 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
38694 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
38695 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
38696 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
38697 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
38698 delivered immediately.
38700 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
38701 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
38702 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
38703 .cindex "first pass routing"
38704 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
38705 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
38706 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
38707 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
38708 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
38709 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
38710 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
38711 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
38712 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
38713 single SMTP connection.
38717 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38720 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
38721 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
38722 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
38723 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
38724 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
38725 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
38726 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
38727 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
38728 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
38729 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
38732 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
38733 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
38734 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
38735 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
38736 email is not desirable.
38738 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
38739 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
38740 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
38741 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
38742 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
38743 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
38744 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
38746 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
38747 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
38748 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
38749 before sending a message to the smart host.
38751 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
38752 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
38753 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
38755 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
38756 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
38757 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
38758 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
38759 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
38760 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
38761 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
38763 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
38767 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
38768 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
38770 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
38771 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
38772 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
38773 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
38774 successful, a zero return code is given.
38776 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
38777 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
38778 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
38779 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
38780 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
38783 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
38784 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
38785 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
38787 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
38788 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
38789 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
38790 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
38791 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
38793 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
38794 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
38795 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
38797 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
38798 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
38799 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
38800 are ever generated.
38802 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
38804 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
38805 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
38806 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
38809 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
38810 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
38811 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
38812 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
38813 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
38814 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
38819 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38820 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38822 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
38823 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
38824 .cindex "log" "types of"
38825 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
38830 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
38831 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
38832 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
38833 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
38834 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
38835 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
38836 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
38837 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
38839 .cindex "reject log"
38840 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
38841 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
38842 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
38843 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
38844 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
38845 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
38846 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
38847 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
38848 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
38851 .cindex "panic log"
38852 .cindex "system log"
38853 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
38854 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
38855 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
38856 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
38857 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
38858 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
38859 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
38860 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
38861 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
38864 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
38865 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
38866 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
38868 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
38871 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
38872 ways of changing this:
38875 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
38880 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
38882 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
38885 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
38889 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
38890 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
38891 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
38892 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
38893 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
38894 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
38899 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
38900 .cindex "log" "destination"
38901 .cindex "log" "to file"
38902 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
38904 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
38905 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
38906 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
38907 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
38908 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
38909 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
38910 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
38912 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
38913 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
38914 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
38915 references to the host name:
38917 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
38919 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
38920 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
38921 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
38922 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
38923 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
38926 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
38927 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
38928 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
38929 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
38930 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
38931 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
38932 implying the use of a default path.
38934 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
38935 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
38936 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
38937 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. If no such item exists, log
38938 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
38939 equivalent to the configuration file setting:
38941 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
38943 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
38944 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
38945 that is where the logs are written.
38947 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
38948 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
38950 Here are some examples of possible Makefile settings:
38952 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
38953 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
38954 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
38955 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
38957 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
38962 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
38963 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38964 .cindex "cycling logs"
38965 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38966 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
38967 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
38968 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
38969 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
38970 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
38971 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
38973 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
38974 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
38975 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
38976 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
38977 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
38978 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
38979 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
38980 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
38981 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
38982 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
38983 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
38988 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
38989 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
38990 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
38991 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
38992 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
38993 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
38994 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
38995 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
38997 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
38998 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
38999 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
39000 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
39002 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
39003 examples of names generated by the above examples:
39005 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
39006 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
39007 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
39008 /var/log/exim/main.200212
39010 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
39011 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
39012 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
39013 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
39015 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
39016 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
39017 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
39018 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
39019 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
39020 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
39023 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
39024 /var/log/exim-panic.log
39025 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
39026 /var/log/exim/panic
39030 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
39031 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
39032 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
39033 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
39034 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
39035 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
39036 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
39037 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
39038 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
39039 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
39040 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
39041 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
39042 the time and host name to each line.
39043 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
39046 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
39048 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
39050 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
39053 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
39054 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
39055 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
39056 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
39058 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
39059 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
39060 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
39061 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
39062 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
39063 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
39064 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
39065 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3164,RFC 3164), you should set
39067 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
39069 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
39070 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
39072 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
39073 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
39074 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
39075 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
39076 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
39077 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
39078 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
39079 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
39080 name, and pid as added by syslog:
39082 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
39083 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
39084 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
39085 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
39088 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
39091 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
39092 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
39093 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
39094 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
39096 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
39097 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
39098 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
39099 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
39100 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
39101 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
39103 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
39104 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
39105 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
39108 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
39110 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
39111 without modification.
39113 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
39114 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
39115 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
39120 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
39121 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
39122 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
39123 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
39124 timestamp. The flags are:
39125 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
39126 .irow &%<=%& "message arrival"
39127 .irow &%(=%& "message fakereject"
39128 .irow &%=>%& "normal message delivery"
39129 .irow &%->%& "additional address in same delivery"
39130 .irow &%>>%& "cutthrough message delivery"
39131 .irow &%*>%& "delivery suppressed by &%-N%&"
39132 .irow &%**%& "delivery failed; address bounced"
39133 .irow &%==%& "delivery deferred; temporary problem"
39137 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
39138 .cindex "log" "reception line"
39139 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
39140 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
39141 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
39143 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
39144 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
39145 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
39147 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
39148 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
39149 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
39153 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
39157 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
39158 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
39159 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
39160 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
39161 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
39162 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
39163 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
39164 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
39165 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
39166 name in parentheses.
39168 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
39169 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
39170 the log containing text like these examples:
39172 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
39173 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
39175 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
39178 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
39179 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
39182 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
39183 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
39184 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
39185 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
39186 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
39187 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
39188 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
39189 suite that was used.
39191 .cindex log protocol
39192 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
39193 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
39194 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
39195 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
39196 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
39197 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
39198 authenticator name.
39200 .cindex "size" "of message"
39201 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
39202 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
39203 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
39204 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
39207 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
39208 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
39212 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
39213 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
39214 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
39215 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
39216 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
39217 to fit it on the page:
39219 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
39220 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
39221 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
39222 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
39223 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
39225 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
39226 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
39227 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
39228 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
39229 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
39231 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
39232 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
39233 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
39234 option, this is logged too, as a second colon-separated list item.
39235 Optionally (see the &%smtp_mailauth%& &%log_selector%&) there may be a third list item.
39237 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
39238 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
39240 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
39242 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
39243 parentheses afterwards.
39245 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
39246 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
39247 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
39248 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
39249 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the
39250 remote IP address (and port if enabled)
39251 in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
39252 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
39253 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
39254 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
39255 TLS cipher information is still available.
39257 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
39258 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
39259 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
39260 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
39261 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
39263 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
39264 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
39266 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
39267 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
39270 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
39271 .cindex "discarded messages"
39272 .cindex "message" "discarded"
39273 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
39274 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
39275 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
39277 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
39278 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
39280 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
39281 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
39283 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
39284 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
39288 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
39289 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
39291 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
39292 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
39294 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
39295 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
39296 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
39298 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
39299 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
39301 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
39302 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
39303 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
39307 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
39308 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
39309 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
39310 following form is logged:
39312 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
39313 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
39315 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
39316 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
39318 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
39319 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
39320 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
39321 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
39322 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
39324 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
39325 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
39326 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
39327 flagged with &`**`&.
39331 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
39332 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
39333 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
39334 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
39335 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
39339 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
39342 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
39344 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
39345 at the end of its processing.
39350 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
39351 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
39352 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
39353 the following table:
39355 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
39356 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
39357 &`Ci `& connection identifier
39358 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39359 &`CV `& certificate verification status
39360 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39361 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
39362 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
39363 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
39364 &`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
39365 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
39366 &`H `& host name and IP address
39367 &`I `& local interface used
39368 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
39369 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
39370 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
39371 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
39372 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
39373 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
39374 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
39375 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
39376 &`Q `& alternate queue name
39377 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
39378 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
39379 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
39380 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
39381 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
39382 &`S `& size of message in bytes
39383 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
39384 &`ST `& shadow transport name
39385 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
39386 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
39387 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
39388 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
39389 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
39393 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
39394 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
39395 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
39398 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
39399 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
39400 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
39401 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
39402 during the first delivery attempt.
39404 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
39405 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
39406 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
39408 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
39409 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
39410 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
39411 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
39412 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
39415 .cindex "error" "ignored"
39416 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
39419 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
39420 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
39422 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
39423 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39425 A delivery set up by a router configured with
39426 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
39427 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
39431 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39434 .cindex DKIM "log line"
39435 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
39436 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
39443 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
39444 .cindex "log" "selectors"
39445 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
39446 default logging to the main log, or you can request additional logging. The value of
39447 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
39450 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
39452 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
39453 selection marked by asterisks:
39454 .itable none 0 0 3 2.8in left 10pt center 3in left
39455 .irow &`8bitmime`& "received 8BITMIME status"
39456 .irow &`acl_warn_skipped`& * "skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL"
39457 .irow &`address_rewrite`& "address rewriting"
39458 .irow &`all_parents`& "all parents in => lines"
39459 .irow &`arguments`& "command line arguments"
39460 .irow &`connection_id`& "connection identifier"
39461 .irow &`connection_reject`& * "connection rejections"
39462 .irow &`delay_delivery`& * "immediate delivery delayed"
39463 .irow &`deliver_time`& "time taken to attempt delivery"
39464 .irow &`delivery_size`& "add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines"
39465 .irow &`dkim`& * "DKIM verified domain on <= lines"
39466 .irow &`dkim_verbose`& "separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature; DKIM signing"
39467 .irow &`dnslist_defer`& * "defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups"
39468 .irow &`dnssec`& "DNSSEC secured lookups"
39469 .irow &`etrn`& * "ETRN commands"
39470 .irow &`host_lookup_failed`& * "as it says"
39471 .irow &`ident_timeout`& "timeout for ident connection"
39472 .irow &`incoming_interface`& "local interface & port on <= and => lines"
39473 .irow &`incoming_port`& "remote port on <= lines"
39474 .irow &`lost_incoming_connection`& * "as it says (includes timeouts)"
39475 .irow &`millisec`& "millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times"
39476 .irow &`msg_id`& * "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value"
39477 .irow &`msg_id_created`& "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added"
39478 .irow &`outgoing_interface`& "local interface on => lines"
39479 .irow &`outgoing_port`& "add remote port to => lines"
39480 .irow &`queue_run`& * "start and end queue runs"
39481 .irow &`queue_time`& "time on queue for one recipient"
39482 .irow &`queue_time_exclusive`& "exclude recieve time from QT times"
39483 .irow &`queue_time_overall`& "time on queue for whole message"
39484 .irow &`pid`& "Exim process id"
39485 .irow &`pipelining`& "PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines"
39486 .irow &`proxy`& "proxy address on <= and => lines"
39487 .irow &`receive_time`& "time taken to receive message"
39488 .irow &`received_recipients`& "recipients on <= lines"
39489 .irow &`received_sender`& "sender on <= lines"
39490 .irow &`rejected_header`& * "header contents on reject log"
39491 .irow &`retry_defer`& * "&<quote>&retry time not reached&</quote>&"
39492 .irow &`return_path_on_delivery`& "put return path on => and ** lines"
39493 .irow &`sender_on_delivery`& "add sender to => lines"
39494 .irow &`sender_verify_fail`& * "sender verification failures"
39495 .irow &`size_reject`& * "rejection because too big"
39496 .irow &`skip_delivery`& * "delivery skipped in a queue run"
39497 .irow &`smtp_confirmation`& * "SMTP confirmation on => lines"
39498 .irow &`smtp_connection`& "incoming SMTP connections"
39499 .irow &`smtp_incomplete_transaction`& "incomplete SMTP transactions"
39500 .irow &`smtp_mailauth`& "AUTH argument to MAIL commands"
39501 .irow &`smtp_no_mail`& "session with no MAIL commands"
39502 .irow &`smtp_protocol_error`& "SMTP protocol errors"
39503 .irow &`smtp_syntax_error`& "SMTP syntax errors"
39504 .irow &`subject`& "contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines"
39505 .irow &`tls_certificate_verified`& * "certificate verification status"
39506 .irow &`tls_cipher`& * "TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines"
39507 .irow &`tls_peerdn`& "TLS peer DN on <= and => lines"
39508 .irow &`tls_resumption`& "append * to cipher field"
39509 .irow &`tls_sni`& "TLS SNI on <= lines"
39510 .irow &`unknown_in_list`& "lookup failed in list match"
39511 .irow &`all`& "&*all of the above*&"
39513 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
39514 section &<<SECID99>>&
39516 More details on each of these items follows:
39520 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
39521 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
39522 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
39523 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
39524 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
39525 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
39527 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
39528 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
39529 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
39530 this log selector is set.
39532 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
39533 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
39534 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
39535 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
39536 such users cannot access the log).
39538 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
39539 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
39540 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
39541 parentheses between them.
39543 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
39544 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
39545 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
39546 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
39547 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
39548 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
39549 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
39550 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
39551 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
39552 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
39553 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
39554 between the caller and Exim.
39556 .cindex log "connection identifier"
39557 .cindex connection "identifier logging"
39558 &%connection_id%&: An identifier for the accepted connection is added to
39559 connection start and end lines and to message accept lines.
39560 The identifier is tagged by Ci=.
39561 The value is PID-based, so will reset on reboot and will wrap.
39563 .cindex log "connection rejections"
39564 .cindex connection "rejection logging"
39565 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
39566 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
39568 .cindex log "delayed delivery"
39569 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
39570 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
39571 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
39572 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
39573 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
39575 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
39576 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
39577 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
39578 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39579 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
39581 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
39582 .cindex "size" "of message"
39583 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
39584 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
39586 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39587 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39588 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
39589 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
39591 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39592 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39593 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
39594 Also, on message delivery lines signing information (domain and selector)
39595 is added, tagged with DKIM=.
39597 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
39598 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
39599 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
39600 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
39601 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
39604 .cindex dnssec logging
39605 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
39606 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
39607 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
39608 It does not cover helo-name verification.
39609 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
39611 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
39612 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
39613 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
39614 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
39615 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
39616 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
39618 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
39619 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
39620 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
39621 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
39622 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
39624 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
39625 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
39626 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
39627 client's ident port times out.
39629 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
39630 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39631 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39632 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39633 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39634 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39635 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
39636 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
39637 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
39638 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
39639 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing
39640 &"=>"&, &"->"&, &"=="& and &"**"& lines.
39641 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39643 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
39644 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
39645 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
39646 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
39647 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
39648 on a proxied connection
39649 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
39650 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
39652 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
39653 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
39654 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
39655 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
39656 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
39657 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
39658 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
39659 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
39660 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
39661 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
39662 important with the widening use of NAT
39663 (see &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2505,RFC 2505)).
39665 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
39666 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
39667 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
39669 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
39670 .cindex millisecond logging
39671 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
39672 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
39673 appended to the seconds value.
39675 .cindex "log" "message id"
39676 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
39678 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
39679 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
39680 (submission mode) without one.
39681 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
39683 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39684 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39685 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39686 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39687 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39688 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
39689 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
39690 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
39691 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39693 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
39694 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
39695 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
39696 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
39697 containing => tags) following the IP address.
39698 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
39699 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
39700 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
39701 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
39702 local port is a random ephemeral port.
39704 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
39705 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
39706 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
39707 immediately after the time and date.
39709 .cindex log pipelining
39710 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
39711 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
39712 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
39713 The field is a single "L".
39715 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
39716 the field has a minus appended.
39718 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
39719 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
39720 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
39721 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
39722 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
39725 .cindex "log" "queue run"
39726 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
39727 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
39729 .cindex "log" "queue time"
39730 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
39731 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
39733 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39734 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
39736 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
39737 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
39738 example, &`QT=3m45s`&.
39740 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
39741 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
39742 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
39743 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39744 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
39746 .cindex "log" "recipients"
39747 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
39748 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
39749 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
39750 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
39752 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
39755 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
39756 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
39757 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
39758 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
39760 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
39761 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
39762 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
39763 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
39764 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
39766 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
39767 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
39768 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
39769 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
39772 .cindex "log" "return path"
39773 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
39774 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
39775 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
39776 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
39778 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
39779 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
39780 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
39781 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
39782 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
39784 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
39785 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
39786 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
39787 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
39790 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
39791 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
39794 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
39795 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
39796 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
39797 queue run because it another process is already delivering it or because
39799 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
39800 .cindex "&""message is frozen""&"
39801 The message that is written is either &"spool file is locked"& or
39802 &"message is frozen"&.
39804 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
39805 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
39806 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
39807 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
39808 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
39809 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
39812 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
39813 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
39814 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
39815 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
39816 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
39817 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
39818 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
39819 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
39820 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
39821 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
39823 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
39824 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
39825 reset if the daemon is restarted.
39826 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
39827 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
39828 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
39829 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
39830 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
39832 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
39833 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
39834 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
39835 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
39836 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
39837 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
39839 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
39840 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
39841 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
39842 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
39843 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
39844 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
39845 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
39846 already have their own log lines.
39848 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
39849 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
39850 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
39851 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
39852 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
39853 the same logging options.
39855 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
39856 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
39860 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
39861 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
39862 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
39863 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
39864 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
39866 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
39867 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
39868 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
39869 was accepted or used.
39871 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
39872 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
39873 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
39874 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
39875 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
39876 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
39877 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
39878 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
39880 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
39881 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
39882 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
39883 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
39884 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
39885 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
39886 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
39887 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
39888 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
39890 .cindex "log" "subject"
39891 .cindex "subject, logging"
39892 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
39893 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
39894 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
39895 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
39896 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
39898 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
39900 .cindex DANE logging
39901 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
39902 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
39904 using a CA trust anchor,
39905 &`CV=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
39906 and &`CV=no`& if not.
39908 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
39909 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
39910 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39911 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
39913 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
39914 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
39915 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39916 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
39917 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
39919 .cindex "log" "TLS resumption"
39920 .cindex "TLS" "logging session resumption"
39921 &%tls_resumption%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39922 connection and the TLS session resumed one used on a previous TCP connection,
39923 an asterisk is appended to the X= cipher field in the log line.
39925 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
39926 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
39927 .cindex SNI logging
39928 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
39929 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
39930 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
39932 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
39933 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
39934 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed, or because
39935 a bad IP address was in the list.
39939 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
39940 .cindex "message" "log file for"
39941 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
39942 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
39943 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
39944 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
39945 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
39946 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
39947 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
39948 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
39949 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
39950 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
39951 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
39953 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
39954 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
39955 &%message_logs%& option false.
39961 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39962 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39964 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
39965 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
39966 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
39967 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
39968 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
39970 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
39971 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
39972 "list what Exim processes are doing"
39973 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
39974 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
39975 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
39976 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
39978 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
39979 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
39980 "extract statistics from the log"
39981 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
39982 "check address acceptance from given IP"
39983 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
39984 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
39985 .irow &<<SECTdumpdb>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
39986 .irow &<<SECTtidydb>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
39987 .irow &<<SECTfixdb>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
39988 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
39989 .irow &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>& &'exim_msgdate'& "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)"
39992 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
39993 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
39994 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
39999 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
40000 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
40001 .cindex "process, querying"
40003 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
40004 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
40005 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
40006 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
40007 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
40008 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
40009 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
40010 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
40012 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
40013 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
40014 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
40017 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
40018 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
40019 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
40020 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
40021 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
40023 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
40024 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD`& "the command for running &'ps'&"
40025 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG`& "the argument for &'ps'&"
40026 .irow &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG`& "the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output"
40027 .irow &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG`& "the argument for the &'kill'& command"
40029 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
40031 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
40032 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
40033 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
40034 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
40035 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
40036 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
40038 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
40039 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
40043 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
40044 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
40045 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
40046 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
40050 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
40054 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
40055 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
40058 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
40059 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
40060 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
40064 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
40065 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
40066 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
40068 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
40069 Match against the size field.
40071 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
40072 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
40074 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
40075 Match messages that are older than the given time.
40078 Match only frozen messages.
40081 Match only non-frozen messages.
40083 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
40084 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
40087 The following options control the format of the output:
40091 Display only the count of matching messages.
40094 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
40098 Display message ids only.
40101 Brief format &-- one line per message.
40104 Display messages in reverse order.
40107 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
40110 The following options give alternates for configuration:
40113 .vitem &*-C*&&~<&'config&~file'&>
40114 is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
40115 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
40117 .vitem &*-E*&&~<&'path'&>
40118 can be used to specify a path for the exim binary,
40119 overriding the built-in one.
40122 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
40123 At least one selection option, or either the &*-c*& or &*-h*& option, must be given.
40127 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
40128 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
40129 .cindex "queue" "summary"
40130 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
40131 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
40132 running a command such as
40134 exim -bp | exiqsumm
40136 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
40137 it, as in the following example:
40139 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
40141 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
40142 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
40143 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
40144 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
40146 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
40147 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
40148 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
40149 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
40150 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
40151 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
40154 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
40155 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
40156 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
40157 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
40158 level"& addresses).
40163 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
40165 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
40166 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
40167 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
40168 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
40169 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
40170 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
40171 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
40172 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
40173 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
40174 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
40176 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
40178 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
40180 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
40181 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
40182 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
40184 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
40185 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
40186 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
40187 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
40188 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
40190 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
40191 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
40192 regular expression.
40194 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
40195 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
40197 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
40198 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
40202 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
40203 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
40204 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
40205 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
40206 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
40207 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
40210 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
40211 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
40212 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
40213 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
40214 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
40217 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
40218 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
40219 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
40220 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
40221 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
40222 the &%--help%& option.
40225 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
40226 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
40227 .cindex "cycling logs"
40228 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
40229 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
40230 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
40231 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
40232 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
40233 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
40234 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
40236 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
40237 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
40239 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
40240 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
40241 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
40245 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
40246 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
40247 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
40248 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
40249 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
40250 logs are handled similarly.
40252 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
40253 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
40254 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
40255 any existing log files.
40257 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
40258 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
40259 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
40260 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
40261 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
40263 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
40265 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
40266 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
40270 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
40271 .cindex "statistics"
40272 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
40273 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
40274 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
40275 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
40276 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
40278 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
40279 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
40280 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
40281 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
40282 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
40284 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
40286 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
40287 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
40288 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
40289 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
40290 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
40291 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
40292 also produced per user.
40294 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
40295 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
40296 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
40297 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
40298 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
40300 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
40301 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
40302 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
40303 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
40304 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
40305 an entirely separate message.
40307 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
40308 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
40309 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
40310 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
40311 least one address that failed.
40313 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
40314 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
40315 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
40316 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
40317 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
40318 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
40319 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
40321 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
40322 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
40323 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
40325 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
40326 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
40327 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
40329 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
40332 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
40333 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
40334 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
40335 .cindex "checking access"
40336 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
40337 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
40338 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
40339 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
40340 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
40341 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
40343 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
40344 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
40346 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
40348 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
40349 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
40350 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
40351 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
40354 550 Relay not permitted
40356 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
40357 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
40358 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
40359 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
40362 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
40363 -f himself@there.example
40365 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
40366 mandatory arguments.
40368 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
40369 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
40370 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
40374 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
40375 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
40376 .cindex "building DBM files"
40377 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
40378 .cindex "lower casing"
40379 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
40380 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
40381 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
40382 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
40383 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
40384 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
40386 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
40387 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
40388 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
40389 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
40392 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
40393 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
40394 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
40398 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
40399 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
40400 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
40401 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
40403 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
40405 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
40406 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
40408 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
40409 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
40410 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
40411 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
40412 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
40413 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
40415 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
40416 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
40417 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
40418 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
40419 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
40420 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
40421 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
40427 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
40428 .cindex "retry" "times"
40429 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
40430 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
40431 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
40432 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
40433 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
40434 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
40435 output. For example:
40437 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
40438 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
40439 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40440 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40441 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
40442 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
40443 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
40444 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
40445 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
40446 past final cutoff time
40448 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
40449 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
40450 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
40451 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
40452 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
40453 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
40456 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
40457 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
40458 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
40459 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
40460 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
40461 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
40465 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
40466 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
40467 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
40468 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
40469 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
40470 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
40471 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
40474 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
40476 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
40479 &'callout'&: the callout cache
40481 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
40483 &'tls'&: TLS session resumption data
40485 &'misc'&: other hints data
40488 The &'misc'& database is used for
40491 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
40492 &(smtp)& transport)
40494 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
40497 Recording EHLO-time facilities advertised by hosts
40499 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
40504 .subsection "exim_dumpdb" "SECTdumpdb"
40505 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
40506 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
40507 &'exim_dumpdb'& program,
40508 taking as arguments the spool and database names.
40509 An option &'-z'& may be given to request times in UTC;
40510 otherwise times are in the local timezone.
40511 An option &'-k'& may be given to dump only the record keys.
40512 For example, to dump the retry database:
40514 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
40516 For the retry database
40517 two lines of output are produced for each entry:
40519 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
40520 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
40522 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
40523 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
40524 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
40525 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
40526 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
40527 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
40528 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
40529 and a textual description of the error.
40531 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
40532 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
40533 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
40536 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
40537 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
40538 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
40539 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
40540 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
40541 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
40546 .subsection "exim_tidydb" "SECTtidydb"
40547 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
40548 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
40549 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
40550 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
40551 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
40552 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
40553 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
40554 updated sufficiently often.
40556 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
40557 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
40558 the retry database:
40560 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
40562 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
40563 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
40564 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
40565 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
40566 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
40567 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
40568 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
40569 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
40570 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
40571 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
40572 whenever it removes information from the database.
40574 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
40575 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
40576 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
40577 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
40578 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
40580 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
40581 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
40582 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
40583 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
40584 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
40585 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
40586 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
40589 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
40590 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
40595 .subsection "exim_fixdb" "SECTfixdb"
40596 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
40597 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
40598 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
40599 getting round problems in a live system. Its interface
40600 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
40601 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
40604 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
40605 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
40606 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
40607 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
40608 by new data, for example:
40612 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
40613 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
40614 used as optional separators.
40616 Both displayed and input times are in the local timezone by default.
40617 If an option &'-z'& is used on the command line, displayed times
40623 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
40624 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
40625 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
40626 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
40627 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
40628 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
40629 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
40630 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
40631 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
40632 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
40633 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
40634 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
40635 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
40639 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
40642 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
40645 .vitem &%-interval%&
40646 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
40647 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
40649 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
40650 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
40653 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
40656 Suppress verification output.
40658 .vitem &%-retries%&
40659 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
40660 the lock (default 10).
40662 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
40663 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
40664 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
40665 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
40668 .vitem &%-timeout%&
40669 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
40670 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
40671 default), a non-blocking call is used.
40674 Generate verbose output.
40677 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
40678 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
40679 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
40680 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
40681 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
40682 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
40683 more than 30 minutes old.
40685 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
40686 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
40687 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
40688 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
40689 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
40690 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
40692 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
40693 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
40694 suppresses all output except error messages.
40698 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
40700 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
40702 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
40703 <&'some commands'&>
40706 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
40707 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
40710 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
40711 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
40713 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
40714 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
40717 .section "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)" "SECTexim_msgdate"
40718 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
40719 The &'exim_msgdate'& utility is written by Andrew Aitchison and included in the Exim distribution.
40720 This Perl script converts an Exim Mesage ID back into a human readable form.
40721 For details of &'exim_msgdate'&'s options, run &'exim_msgdate'& with the &%--help%& option.
40723 Section &<<SECTmessiden>>& (Message identification) describes Exim Mesage IDs.
40725 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40726 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40728 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
40729 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
40730 .cindex "X-windows"
40731 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
40732 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
40733 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
40734 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
40735 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
40736 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
40737 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
40738 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
40742 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
40743 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
40744 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
40745 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
40746 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
40747 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
40748 parameters are for.
40750 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
40751 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
40752 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
40754 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
40756 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
40757 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
40758 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
40759 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
40760 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
40762 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
40763 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
40765 Eximon*background: gray94
40767 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
40768 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
40769 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
40770 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
40771 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
40772 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
40773 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
40776 Eximon*highlight: gray
40779 .cindex "admin user"
40780 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
40781 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
40783 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
40784 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
40785 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
40786 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
40787 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
40789 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
40790 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
40791 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
40792 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
40793 different parts of the display.
40798 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
40799 .cindex "stripchart"
40800 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
40801 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
40802 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
40803 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
40804 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
40805 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
40806 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
40807 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
40808 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
40810 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
40811 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
40812 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
40813 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
40815 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
40816 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
40817 to a single partition.
40819 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
40820 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
40821 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
40822 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
40823 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
40824 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
40825 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
40830 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
40831 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
40832 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
40833 .cindex "window size"
40834 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
40835 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
40836 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
40837 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
40838 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
40839 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
40841 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
40842 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
40843 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
40844 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
40846 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
40847 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
40848 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
40849 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
40850 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
40851 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40853 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
40854 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
40855 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40859 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
40860 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
40861 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
40862 the main log is maintained.
40863 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
40864 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
40865 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
40866 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
40867 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
40869 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
40870 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
40871 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
40872 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
40873 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
40874 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
40875 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
40876 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
40877 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
40878 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
40879 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40881 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
40882 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
40883 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
40884 It cannot go further back up the log.
40886 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
40887 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
40888 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
40889 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
40890 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
40891 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
40893 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
40894 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
40895 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
40896 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
40897 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
40898 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
40900 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
40901 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
40902 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
40903 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
40904 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
40905 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
40906 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
40907 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
40908 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
40913 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
40914 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
40915 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
40916 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
40917 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
40918 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
40919 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
40920 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
40921 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
40922 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
40924 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
40925 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
40926 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
40927 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
40928 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
40929 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
40930 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
40932 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
40933 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
40934 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
40935 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
40936 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
40937 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
40938 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
40940 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
40941 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
40942 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
40943 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
40945 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
40946 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
40947 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
40948 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
40949 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
40950 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
40951 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
40954 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
40955 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
40957 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
40958 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
40959 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
40960 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
40961 display is updated.
40965 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
40966 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
40967 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
40968 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
40969 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
40972 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
40973 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
40974 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
40975 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
40976 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
40978 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
40980 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
40984 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
40985 in a new text window.
40987 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
40988 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
40989 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
40991 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
40992 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
40993 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
40994 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
40996 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
40997 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
40998 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
40999 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
41000 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
41002 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
41003 that the message be frozen.
41005 .cindex "thawing messages"
41006 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
41007 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
41008 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
41009 that the message be thawed.
41011 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
41012 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
41013 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
41014 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
41016 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
41017 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
41020 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
41021 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
41022 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
41023 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
41024 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
41025 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
41026 which case no action is taken.
41028 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
41029 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
41030 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
41031 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
41032 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
41033 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
41034 case no action is taken.
41036 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
41037 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
41039 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
41040 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
41041 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
41042 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
41043 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
41044 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
41045 the address is qualified with that domain.
41048 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
41049 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
41050 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
41051 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
41052 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
41053 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
41054 if no output is generated.
41056 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
41057 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
41058 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
41059 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
41061 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
41062 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
41063 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
41070 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41071 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41073 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
41074 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
41075 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
41076 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
41078 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
41079 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
41080 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
41081 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
41082 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
41083 its security as compared with other MTAs.
41085 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
41086 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
41087 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
41088 as soon as possible.
41091 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
41092 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
41093 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
41094 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
41095 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
41096 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
41099 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
41100 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
41101 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
41102 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
41103 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
41104 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
41106 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
41107 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
41108 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
41109 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
41112 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
41113 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
41114 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
41115 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
41116 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
41117 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
41118 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
41119 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
41120 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
41124 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
41125 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
41126 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
41127 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
41128 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
41129 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
41130 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
41132 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
41135 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
41136 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
41137 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
41138 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
41139 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
41144 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
41146 .cindex "root privilege"
41147 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
41148 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
41149 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
41150 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
41151 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
41152 is required for two things:
41155 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
41156 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
41159 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
41160 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
41164 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
41165 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
41166 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
41167 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
41168 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
41169 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
41170 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
41171 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
41173 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
41174 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
41175 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
41177 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
41178 uid and gid in the following cases:
41183 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
41184 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
41185 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
41186 the calling process.
41187 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
41188 option may not be used at all.
41189 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
41190 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
41191 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
41196 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
41197 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
41200 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
41201 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
41202 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
41203 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
41204 testing address verification
41207 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
41210 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
41211 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
41214 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
41217 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
41218 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
41219 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
41220 will be used during message reception.
41222 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
41223 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
41226 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution.,
41227 including while the recipient addresses in a message are being routed.
41230 However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
41231 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
41232 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
41235 Any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
41236 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid.
41239 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox.
41241 For remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used.
41244 Once all the delivery
41245 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
41246 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
41247 generating bounce and warning messages.
41250 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
41251 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
41257 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
41258 .cindex "privilege, running without"
41259 .cindex "unprivileged running"
41260 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
41261 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
41262 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
41263 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
41264 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
41265 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
41266 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
41270 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
41271 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
41272 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
41273 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
41275 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
41276 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
41277 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
41278 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
41279 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
41281 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
41282 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
41283 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
41286 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
41287 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
41288 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
41290 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
41291 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
41292 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
41293 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
41294 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
41295 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
41296 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
41297 address this problem at this time.
41299 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
41300 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
41301 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
41302 be used in the most straightforward way.
41304 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
41305 number of restrictions on what you can do:
41308 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
41309 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
41310 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
41311 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
41312 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
41314 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
41315 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
41317 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
41318 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
41319 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
41320 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
41322 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
41323 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
41326 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
41327 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
41328 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
41330 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
41331 owned by the Exim user.
41333 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
41334 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
41335 mailboxes need to be created manually.
41340 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
41341 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
41342 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
41343 gives more security at essentially no cost.
41345 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
41346 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
41351 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
41352 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
41353 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
41357 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
41358 .cindex "security" "local commands"
41359 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
41360 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
41361 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
41362 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
41363 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
41366 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
41367 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
41368 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
41369 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
41370 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
41372 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
41373 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
41374 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
41375 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
41376 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
41377 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
41378 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
41380 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
41381 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
41382 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
41384 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
41385 taint checking might apply to their usage.
41387 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
41388 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
41389 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
41391 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
41392 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
41393 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
41395 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
41396 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
41397 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
41398 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
41404 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
41405 .cindex "security" "data sources"
41406 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
41407 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
41408 .cindex "PCRE2" "security"
41409 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
41410 are some issues to be aware of:
41413 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
41415 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
41417 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
41418 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE2. Be aware of what
41419 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
41420 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
41421 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
41422 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
41425 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
41426 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
41427 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
41429 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
41430 expected to yield one result.
41436 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
41437 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
41438 .cindex "IP source routing"
41439 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
41440 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
41441 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
41442 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
41446 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
41447 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
41448 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
41453 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
41454 .cindex "trusted users"
41455 .cindex "admin user"
41456 .cindex "privileged user"
41457 .cindex "user" "trusted"
41458 .cindex "user" "admin"
41459 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
41460 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
41461 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
41462 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
41463 permit a remote host to be specified.
41466 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
41467 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
41468 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
41469 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
41470 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
41471 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
41473 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
41474 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
41475 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
41476 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
41477 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
41479 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
41480 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
41481 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
41482 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
41483 includes the contents of files on the spool.
41487 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
41488 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
41489 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
41490 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
41491 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
41492 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
41494 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
41495 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
41496 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
41497 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
41498 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
41499 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
41502 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
41503 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
41504 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
41505 This affects most of the checking options,
41506 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
41509 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
41510 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
41511 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
41512 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
41513 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
41514 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
41518 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
41519 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
41520 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
41521 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
41522 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
41527 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
41528 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
41529 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
41530 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
41535 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
41536 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
41537 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
41538 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
41539 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
41543 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
41544 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
41545 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
41549 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
41550 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
41551 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
41552 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
41553 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
41554 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
41555 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
41557 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
41558 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
41563 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
41564 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
41565 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
41566 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
41570 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
41571 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
41572 enough to hold the result.
41573 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
41578 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41579 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41581 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
41582 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
41583 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
41584 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
41585 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
41586 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
41587 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
41588 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
41589 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
41590 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
41591 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
41592 themselves are recoverable.
41594 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
41595 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
41596 and should not be used as such.
41598 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
41599 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
41600 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
41603 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
41604 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
41605 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
41606 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
41607 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
41609 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
41610 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
41611 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
41612 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
41614 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
41616 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
41619 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
41621 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
41622 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
41623 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
41624 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
41625 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
41626 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
41627 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
41628 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
41631 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
41632 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
41633 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
41634 relics of crashes and can be removed.
41636 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
41637 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
41638 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
41639 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
41640 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
41641 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
41642 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
41643 normally the Exim user.
41645 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
41646 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
41647 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
41648 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
41649 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
41650 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
41651 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
41652 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
41654 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
41655 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
41656 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
41657 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
41659 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen.
41660 These contain variables, can appear in any
41661 order, and are omitted when not relevant.
41663 If there is a second hyphen after the first,
41664 the corresponding data is tainted.
41665 If there is a value in parentheses, the data is quoted for a lookup.
41667 The following word specifies a variable,
41668 and the remainder of the item depends on the variable.
41671 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41672 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
41673 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
41674 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
41675 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
41676 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
41677 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
41678 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
41679 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
41682 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41683 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
41684 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
41685 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
41686 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
41687 character. It may contain internal newlines.
41689 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41690 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
41691 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
41692 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
41693 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
41694 character. It may contain internal newlines.
41696 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
41697 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
41698 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
41700 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
41701 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
41702 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
41703 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
41704 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
41706 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
41707 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
41708 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
41709 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
41710 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
41712 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
41713 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
41714 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
41716 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
41717 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
41718 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
41720 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
41721 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
41722 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
41724 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
41725 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
41726 present if the number is greater than zero.
41728 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
41729 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
41730 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
41732 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
41733 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
41734 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
41736 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
41737 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
41740 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
41741 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
41742 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
41745 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
41746 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
41747 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
41748 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
41750 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
41751 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
41752 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
41754 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
41755 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
41756 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
41757 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
41758 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
41759 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
41761 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
41762 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
41763 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
41764 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
41765 supplied by the remote host, if any.
41767 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
41768 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
41769 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
41770 generated messages.
41773 The message is from a local sender.
41775 .vitem &%-localerror%&
41776 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
41778 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
41779 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
41780 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
41781 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
41783 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
41784 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
41785 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
41788 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
41789 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
41792 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
41793 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
41794 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
41796 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
41797 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
41798 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
41800 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
41801 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
41802 of &$spam_score_int$&.
41804 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
41805 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
41806 rather than Unix-format.
41807 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
41808 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
41810 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
41811 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
41812 certificate was verified by the server.
41814 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
41815 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
41816 name of the cipher suite that was used.
41818 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
41819 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
41820 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
41824 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
41825 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
41826 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
41827 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
41828 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
41829 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
41830 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
41831 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
41832 addresses are complete.
41834 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
41835 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
41836 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
41837 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
41838 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
41839 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
41841 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
41842 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
41843 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41845 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
41846 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
41847 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
41848 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
41852 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41853 darcy@austen.fict.example
41855 alice@wonderland.fict.example
41857 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
41858 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
41859 line is of the following form:
41861 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
41862 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
41864 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
41865 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
41866 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
41867 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
41868 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
41869 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
41870 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
41871 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
41874 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
41875 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
41876 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
41877 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
41878 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
41882 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
41883 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
41884 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
41885 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
41886 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
41887 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
41888 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
41889 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
41890 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
41891 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
41894 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
41895 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
41896 typical set of headers:
41898 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
41899 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
41900 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
41901 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
41902 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
41903 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
41904 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
41905 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41906 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
41907 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41908 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
41910 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
41911 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
41912 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
41913 .ecindex IIDforspo1
41914 .ecindex IIDforspo2
41915 .ecindex IIDforspo3
41917 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
41918 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
41919 an ASCII newline character.
41920 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
41921 can have an alternate format.
41922 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
41923 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
41924 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
41925 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
41926 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
41927 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
41929 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41930 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41932 .chapter "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
41933 "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC Support"
41935 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
41938 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
41939 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
41940 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
41941 DKIM is documented in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376).
41943 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
41944 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
41945 any original DKIM signature.
41947 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
41948 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41950 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
41952 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
41953 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
41954 (including transport filters) except cutthrough delivery.
41955 However, signing options may not depend on headers modified by
41956 routers, the transport or a transport filter.
41958 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
41959 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
41960 different signature contexts.
41963 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
41964 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
41965 Exim's standard controls.
41967 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
41968 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
41970 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
41971 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
41972 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
41973 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
41975 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
41976 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
41977 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
41978 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
41981 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
41982 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
41983 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
41984 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
41988 .subsection "Signing outgoing messages" SECDKIMSIGN
41989 .cindex DKIM signing
41991 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
41992 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301)
41993 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
41995 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
41997 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
41998 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
42001 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
42002 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
42003 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
42004 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
42005 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
42007 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
42008 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
42010 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
42011 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
42012 After expansion, this can be a list.
42013 Each element in turn,
42015 .vindex "&$dkim_domain$&"
42016 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
42017 while expanding the remaining signing options.
42018 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
42019 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
42021 .option dkim_selector smtp "string list&!!" unset
42022 This sets the key selector string.
42023 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
42024 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
42025 .vindex "&$dkim_selector$&"
42026 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
42027 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
42028 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
42029 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
42031 To do, for example, dual-signing with RSA and EC keys
42032 this could be be used:
42034 dkim_selector = ec_sel : rsa_sel
42035 dkim_private_key = KEYS_DIR/$dkim_selector
42038 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
42039 This sets the private key to use.
42040 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
42041 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
42042 The result can either
42044 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
42046 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
42047 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
42049 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
42052 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
42053 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
42057 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
42059 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
42060 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
42062 The result file from the first command should be retained,
42063 permissions set so that Exim can read it,
42064 and this option set to use it.
42065 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
42066 for the DNS TXT record.
42067 See section 3.6 of &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376)
42068 for the record specification.
42072 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
42073 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
42076 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42078 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
42079 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
42082 EC keys for DKIM are defined by
42083 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8463,RFC 8463).
42084 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
42085 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
42086 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
42087 for some transition period.
42088 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
42091 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
42093 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
42094 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
42097 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
42099 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
42100 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
42103 Exim also supports an alternate format
42104 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
42105 of the standard, but not adopted.
42106 A future release will probably drop that support.
42108 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
42109 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
42111 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
42113 &`sha256`& &-- the default
42115 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
42118 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42120 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
42123 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
42124 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
42125 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
42126 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
42127 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
42128 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
42130 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
42131 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
42132 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
42133 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
42134 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
42136 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
42137 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
42138 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
42139 either &"1"& or &"true"&, Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
42140 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
42143 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
42144 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
42145 list of header names.
42146 Headers with these names, or the absence of such a header, will be included
42147 in the message signature.
42148 When unspecified, the header names listed in
42149 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4871,RFC 4871) will be used,
42150 whether or not each header is present in the message.
42151 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
42152 &"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS"&
42153 and an oversigning variant is in &"_DKIM_OVERSIGN_HEADERS"&.
42155 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
42156 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
42157 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
42159 A name can be prefixed with either an &"="& or a &"+"& character.
42160 If an &"="& prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
42162 If a &"+"& prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
42163 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
42164 name will be appended.
42166 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
42167 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
42168 If not set, no such information will be included.
42169 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the
42170 current time for the expiry tag (e.g. 1209600 for two weeks); both creation
42171 (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included unless the offset is 0 (no expiry).
42173 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376)
42174 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
42177 .subsection "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" SECDKIMVFY
42178 .cindex DKIM verification
42180 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
42181 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
42183 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
42184 Individual classes of DKIM signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
42185 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
42186 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
42187 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
42189 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
42190 Performing verification sets up information used by the
42191 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42193 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
42194 of this section can be ignored.
42196 The results of verification are made available to the
42197 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which (for complex needs) can examine and modify them.
42198 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
42199 By default, the ACL is called once for each
42200 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
42201 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
42202 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
42203 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
42205 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
42206 a large number of expansion variables
42207 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
42208 runtime of the ACL.
42210 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
42211 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
42212 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
42213 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
42215 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
42216 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
42217 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
42218 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
42219 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
42220 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
42223 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
42225 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
42226 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
42227 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
42229 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
42231 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
42232 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
42233 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
42235 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
42238 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
42239 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
42241 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
42242 (such as the From: header)
42243 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
42244 and for the domain part if identities.
42245 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
42247 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
42248 for each matching signature.
42251 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
42252 available (from most to least important):
42256 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
42257 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
42258 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
42259 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
42261 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
42262 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined
42263 (it need do no more than accept, which is the default),
42264 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
42265 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
42266 The value is maintained for the MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
42268 Within the DKIM ACL,
42269 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
42271 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
42272 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42274 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
42275 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
42277 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
42278 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
42280 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
42283 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
42284 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
42285 hash-method or key-size:
42287 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
42288 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
42289 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
42290 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
42291 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
42292 set dkim_verify_status = fail
42293 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
42296 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
42297 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
42298 "fail" or "invalid". One of
42300 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
42301 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
42303 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
42304 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
42306 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
42307 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
42308 means that the message body was modified in transit.
42310 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
42311 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
42312 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
42313 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
42316 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
42318 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
42319 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
42320 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
42321 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42323 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
42324 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
42325 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
42326 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42328 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
42329 The key record selector string.
42331 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
42332 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
42333 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
42334 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
42335 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
42338 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42340 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
42342 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
42343 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
42346 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
42347 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
42348 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
42349 processing of such signatures.
42351 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
42352 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42354 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
42355 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42357 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
42358 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
42359 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
42360 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376)
42361 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
42362 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
42363 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
42365 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
42366 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
42367 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
42368 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
42369 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
42370 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
42371 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
42372 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
42374 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
42375 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
42376 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
42378 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
42379 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
42380 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
42381 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
42382 integer size comparisons against this value.
42383 Note that Exim does not check this value.
42385 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
42386 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
42388 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
42389 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
42391 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
42392 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
42394 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
42395 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42398 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
42399 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42402 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
42403 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
42405 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
42406 Number of bits in the key.
42407 Valid only once the key is loaded, which is at the time the header signature
42408 is verified, which is after the body hash is.
42410 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42412 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
42413 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
42416 This is enforced by the default setting for the &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%&
42421 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
42424 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
42425 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
42426 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
42427 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42428 This condition is only usable in a DKIM ACL.
42429 This is typically used to restrict an ACL
42430 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
42433 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
42434 warn sender_domains = gmail.com
42435 dkim_signers = gmail.com
42437 log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
42440 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
42441 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
42443 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
42444 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
42445 results against the actual result of verification,
42446 given by &$dkim_verify_status$& if that is non-empty or "none" if empty.
42447 This condition may be used in DKIM, MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
42449 A basic verification might be:
42451 deny !dkim_status = pass:none:invalid
42454 A more complex use could be
42455 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
42458 deny sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
42459 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
42460 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
42461 message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
42464 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
42465 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
42466 for more information of what they mean.
42468 The condition is true if the status
42469 (or any of the list of status values)
42470 is any one of the supplied list.
42476 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
42477 .cindex SPF verification
42479 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
42480 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by
42481 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7208,RFC 7208).
42482 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
42483 the &url(http://openspf.org).
42484 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
42485 . --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
42486 . --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
42489 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
42490 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
42492 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
42493 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
42494 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
42496 .cindex "dynamic modules"
42497 The support can be built as a dynamic-load module if desired;
42498 see the comments in that Makefile.
42501 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
42502 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
42504 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
42505 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
42506 Performing verification sets up information used by the
42507 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42510 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42511 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
42512 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
42513 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
42514 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
42518 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
42521 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
42522 domain in the envelope-from address.
42524 .vitem &%softfail%&
42525 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
42529 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
42532 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
42533 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
42534 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
42536 .vitem &%permerror%&
42537 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
42538 You may deny messages when this occurs.
42540 .vitem &%temperror%&
42541 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
42542 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
42545 There was an error during processing of the SPF lookup
42548 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
42549 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
42550 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
42551 short-circuit fashion.
42556 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
42557 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
42558 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
42559 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why;\
42560 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
42561 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
42562 ip=$sender_host_address
42565 Note: The above mentioned URL may not be as helpful as expected. You are
42566 encouraged to replace the link with a link to a site with more
42569 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
42572 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
42574 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
42575 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
42576 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
42577 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
42578 it for logging purposes.
42580 .vitem &$spf_received$&
42581 .vindex &$spf_received$&
42582 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header (name and
42583 content) that can be added to the message. Please note that
42584 according to the SPF draft, this header must be added at the
42585 top of the header list, i.e. with
42587 add_header = :at_start:$spf_received
42589 See section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>& for further details.
42591 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
42592 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
42594 .vitem &$spf_result$&
42595 .vindex &$spf_result$&
42596 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
42597 currently one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror,
42598 temperror, or &"(invalid)"&.
42600 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
42601 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
42602 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
42603 and required in order to obtain a result.
42605 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42606 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42607 .vindex &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&
42608 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
42609 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
42610 The string is generated by the SPF library from the template configured in the main config
42611 option &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&.
42615 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42616 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
42617 .cindex SPF "best guess"
42618 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
42619 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
42620 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
42622 Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
42623 for a description of what it means.
42624 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
42626 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
42627 of the spf one. For example:
42630 deny spf_guess = fail
42631 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
42634 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
42635 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
42636 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
42639 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
42640 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
42642 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
42643 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
42644 &%spf_guess%& option.
42645 For example, the following:
42648 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
42651 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
42654 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
42656 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
42657 address as the key and an IP address
42662 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
42665 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
42666 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
42672 .subsection "SRS (Sender Rewriting Scheme)" SECTSRS
42673 .cindex SRS "sender rewriting scheme"
42674 .cindex VERP "variable envelope return path"
42676 SRS can be used to modify sender addresses when forwarding so that
42677 SPF verification does not object to them.
42678 It can also be used to identify a received bounce message as
42679 likely (or not) having been trigged by a message from the
42680 local system, and for identifying dead addresses in mailing lists.
42681 It is one implementation of a VERP (Variable Envelope Return Path) method.
42683 SRS operates by encoding the original envelope sender in a new
42684 sender local part and using a domain run by the forwarding site
42685 as the new domain for the sender. Any DSN message should be returned
42686 to this new sender at the forwarding site, which can extract the
42687 original sender from the coded local part and forward the DSN to
42690 This is a way of avoiding the breakage that SPF does to forwarding.
42691 The constructed local-part will be longer than the original,
42692 leading to possible problems with very long addresses.
42693 The changing of the sender address also hinders the tracing of mail
42696 Exim can be built to include native SRS support. To do this
42697 SUPPORT_SRS=yes must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&.
42698 If this has been done, the macros _HAVE_SRS and _HAVE_NATIVE_SRS
42700 The support is limited to SRS0-encoding; SRS1 is not supported.
42702 .cindex SRS excoding
42703 To encode an address use this expansion item:
42705 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
42706 .cindex "&%srs_encode%& expansion item"
42707 .cindex SRS "expansion item"
42708 The first argument should be a secret known and used by all systems
42709 handling the recipient domain for the original message.
42710 There is no need to periodically change this key; a timestamp is also
42712 The second argument should be given as the envelope sender address before this
42713 encoding operation.
42714 If this value is empty the the expansion result will be empty.
42715 The third argument should be the recipient domain of the message when
42716 it arrived at this system.
42717 All arguments are expanded before use.
42719 The result of the expansion is the replacement envelope-from (return path)
42723 .cindex SRS decoding
42724 To decode an address use this expansion condition:
42726 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
42727 The first argument should be the recipient local part as it was received.
42728 The second argument is the site secret.
42729 Both arguments are expanded before use.
42731 If the messages is not for an SRS-encoded recipient the condition will
42733 If it is, the condition will return true and the variable
42734 &$srs_recipient$& will be set to the decoded (original) value.
42736 If the second argument is empty then the condition returns true if
42737 the first argument is in valid SRS formet, else false.
42738 The variable &$srs_recipient$& is not set for this case.
42744 SRS_SECRET = <pick something unique for your site for this. Use on all MXs.>
42750 # if outbound, and forwarding has been done, use an alternate transport
42751 domains = ! +my_domains
42752 transport = ${if eq {$local_part@$domain} \
42753 {$original_local_part@$original_domain} \
42754 {remote_smtp} {remote_forwarded_smtp}}
42759 domains = +my_domains
42760 # detect inbound bounces which are SRS'd, and decode them
42761 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {SRS_SECRET}}
42762 data = $srs_recipient
42764 inbound_srs_failure:
42767 domains = +my_domains
42768 # detect inbound bounces which look SRS'd but are invalid
42769 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {}}
42771 data = :fail: Invalid SRS recipient address
42773 #... further routers here get inbound_srs-redirected recipients
42774 # and any that were not SRS'd
42777 # transport; should look like the non-forward outbound
42778 # one, plus the max_rcpt and return_path options
42779 remote_forwarded_smtp:
42781 # single-recipient so that $original_domain is valid
42783 # modify the envelope from, for mails that we forward
42784 return_path = ${srs_encode {SRS_SECRET} {$return_path} {$original_domain}}
42791 .section DMARC SECDMARC
42792 .cindex DMARC verification
42794 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
42795 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
42796 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
42797 should read and understand how it works by visiting the
42798 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/,DMARC website).
42800 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
42801 the libopendmarc library is used.
42803 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
42804 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/,sourceforge)
42805 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
42806 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
42807 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
42808 This description assumes
42809 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
42810 are in /usr/local/lib.
42812 .subsection Configuration SSECDMARCCONFIG
42813 .cindex DMARC configuration
42815 There are three main-configuration options:
42816 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
42818 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
42819 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
42820 defines the location of a text file of valid
42821 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
42822 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
42823 the most current version can be downloaded
42824 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
42825 See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
42826 The default for the option is unset.
42827 If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
42830 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
42831 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
42832 defines the location of a file to log results
42833 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
42834 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
42835 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
42836 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
42837 directory of this file is writable by the user
42839 The default is unset.
42841 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
42842 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
42843 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
42844 forensic report detailing alignment failures
42845 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
42846 and you have configured Exim to send them.
42847 If set, this is expanded and used for the
42848 From: header line; the address is extracted
42849 from it and used for the envelope from.
42850 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
42851 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
42854 .subsection Controls SSECDMARCCONTROLS
42855 .cindex DMARC controls
42857 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
42858 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
42859 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
42860 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
42861 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
42862 DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
42864 control = dmarc_disable_verify
42866 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
42867 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
42868 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
42869 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
42870 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
42871 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
42872 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
42873 exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
42874 configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
42875 construction might be inadequate.
42877 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
42879 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
42880 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
42881 your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
42884 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
42887 .subsection ACL SSECDMARCACL
42888 .cindex DMARC "ACL condition"
42890 DMARC checks can be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
42891 &"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
42892 call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
42893 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
42894 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
42895 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
42896 occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
42898 The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
42899 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
42900 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
42901 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
42902 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
42903 .irow &'accept'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email"
42904 .irow &'reject'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email"
42905 .irow &'quarantine'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection"
42906 .irow &'none'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral"
42907 .irow &'norecord'& "No policy section in the DMARC record for this RFC5322.From field"
42908 .irow &'nofrom'& "Unable to determine the domain of the sender"
42909 .irow &'temperror'& "Library error or dns error"
42910 .irow &'off'& "The DMARC check was disabled for this email"
42912 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
42913 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
42914 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
42915 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
42916 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
42917 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
42920 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
42921 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
42922 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
42924 Performing the check sets up information used by the
42925 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42927 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
42928 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
42929 expansion variables are available:
42932 .vitem &$dmarc_status$&
42933 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
42934 .cindex DMARC result
42935 A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
42936 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
42937 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
42938 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
42939 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
42941 .vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
42942 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
42943 Slightly longer, human readable status.
42945 .vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
42946 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
42947 The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
42949 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
42950 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
42951 The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
42952 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
42953 is any error, including no DMARC record.
42956 .subsection Logging SSECDMARCLOGGING
42957 .cindex DMARC logging
42959 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
42960 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
42961 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
42962 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
42963 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
42964 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
42965 processing or failure delivery issues).
42967 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
42968 tools, you need to:
42970 Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
42972 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
42973 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
42976 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
42978 Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
42980 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
42981 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
42984 .subsection Example SSECDMARCEXAMPLE
42985 .cindex DMARC example
42990 warn domains = +local_domains
42991 hosts = +local_hosts
42992 control = dmarc_disable_verify
42994 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
42995 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
42997 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
42998 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
43001 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
43003 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
43005 warn dmarc_status = !accept
43007 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
43009 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
43011 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
43012 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
43014 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
43015 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
43016 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
43018 deny dmarc_status = reject
43020 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
43022 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
43029 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43030 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43032 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
43034 .cindex "proxy support"
43035 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
43037 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
43038 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
43041 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
43042 .cindex proxy inbound
43043 .cindex proxy "server side"
43044 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
43045 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
43047 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
43048 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
43049 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
43052 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
43053 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
43055 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
43056 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
43057 to distribute load.
43058 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
43059 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
43060 There is no logging if a host passes or
43061 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
43062 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
43064 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
43065 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
43066 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
43067 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
43068 automatically determines which version is in use.
43070 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
43071 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
43072 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
43073 Exim and the proxy server. The Proxy Protocol header must be received
43074 within &%proxy_protocol_timeout%&, which defaults to 3s.
43076 The following expansion variables are usable
43077 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
43079 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
43080 .irow $proxy_external_address "IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy"
43081 .irow $proxy_external_port "Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy"
43082 .irow $proxy_local_address "IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy"
43083 .irow $proxy_local_port "Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy"
43084 .irow $proxy_session "boolean: SMTP connection via proxy"
43086 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
43087 there was a protocol error.
43088 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
43089 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
43091 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
43092 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
43093 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
43094 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
43095 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
43096 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
43097 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
43098 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
43099 A possible solution is:
43101 # Set max number of connections per host
43103 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
43104 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
43106 defer ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
43107 message = Too many connections from this IP right now
43112 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
43113 .cindex proxy outbound
43114 .cindex proxy "client side"
43115 .cindex proxy SOCKS
43116 .cindex SOCKS proxy
43117 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
43118 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by
43119 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1928,RFC 1928)).
43120 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
43123 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
43124 on an smtp transport.
43126 If unset (or empty after expansion) then proxying is not done.
43128 Otherwise, expansion should result in a list
43129 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
43130 Each proxy specifier is a list
43131 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
43132 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
43134 Each option is a string of form <name>=<value>.
43135 The list of options is in the following table:
43136 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
43137 .irow &'auth'& "authentication method"
43138 .irow &'name'& "authentication username"
43139 .irow &'pass'& "authentication password"
43140 .irow &'port'& "tcp port"
43141 .irow &'tmo'& "connection timeout"
43142 .irow &'pri'& "priority"
43143 .irow &'weight'& "selection bias"
43146 More details on each of these options follows:
43149 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
43150 .cindex proxy authentication
43151 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
43152 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per
43153 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1929,RFC 1929)
43154 for access to the proxy.
43155 Default is &"none"&.
43157 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
43160 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
43163 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
43166 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
43169 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
43170 higher values being tried first.
43171 The default priority is 1.
43173 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
43174 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
43175 weighted by this value.
43176 The default value for selection bias is 1.
43179 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
43180 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
43181 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
43183 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
43184 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
43185 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
43186 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
43188 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43189 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43191 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
43192 "Internationalisation""
43193 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
43196 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
43198 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
43199 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
43200 Standards supported are RFCs
43201 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2060.html,2060),
43202 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5890.html,5890),
43203 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6530.html,6530) and
43204 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6533.html,6533).
43206 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
43207 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
43208 requirement, upon libidn2.
43210 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
43211 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
43212 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
43213 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
43214 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
43215 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
43216 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
43218 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
43219 international handling for the message is enabled and
43220 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
43222 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
43223 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
43224 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
43225 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
43227 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
43228 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
43229 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
43230 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
43232 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
43233 components expanded to a-label form,
43234 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
43237 .cindex log protocol
43238 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
43239 .cindex i18n logging
43240 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
43241 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
43243 The following expansion operators can be used:
43245 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
43246 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
43247 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
43248 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
43251 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
43252 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
43254 may use the following modifier:
43256 control = utf8_downconvert
43257 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
43259 This sets a flag requiring that envelope addresses are converted to
43260 a-label form before smtp delivery.
43261 This is usually for use in a Message Submission Agent context,
43262 but could be used for any message.
43264 If a value is appended it may be:
43265 .itable none 0 0 2 5* right 95* left
43266 .irow &`1`& "mandatory downconversion"
43267 .irow &`0`& "no downconversion"
43268 .irow &`-1`& "if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host"
43270 If no value is given, 1 is used.
43272 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
43273 is initially set to -1.
43275 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
43276 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
43277 or an empty string.
43278 If non-empty it overrides value previously set
43279 (due to mua_wrapper or by an ACL control).
43282 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
43283 Configurations supporting these should inspect
43284 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
43286 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
43287 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
43288 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
43290 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
43291 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
43295 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
43296 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
43297 the following expansion operator can be used:
43299 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
43302 The string is converted from the charset specified by
43303 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
43304 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
43306 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by
43307 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2060.html,RFC 2060),
43308 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
43309 (which has to be a single character)
43310 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
43311 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
43313 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
43314 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
43316 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
43317 by many other IMAP servers.
43321 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
43322 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
43323 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
43326 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
43327 must be representable in UTF-16.
43330 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43331 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43333 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
43337 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
43338 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
43339 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
43340 processing actions.
43342 Most installations will never need to use Events.
43343 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
43344 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
43346 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
43347 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
43348 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
43350 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
43351 An example might look like:
43352 .cindex logging custom
43354 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
43355 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
43356 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
43357 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
43358 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
43359 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
43360 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
43361 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
43362 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
43366 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
43367 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
43368 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
43371 The current list of events is:
43372 .itable all 0 0 4 25* left 10* center 15* center 50* left
43373 .row auth:fail after both "per driver per authentication attempt"
43374 .row dane:fail after transport "per connection"
43375 .row dns:fail after both "per lookup"
43376 .row msg:complete after main "per message"
43377 .row msg:defer after transport "per message per delivery try"
43378 .row msg:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43379 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport "per recipient per host"
43380 .row msg:rcpt:defer after transport "per recipient"
43381 .row msg:host:defer after transport "per host per delivery try; host errors"
43382 .row msg:fail:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43383 .row msg:fail:internal after main "per recipient"
43384 .row tcp:connect before transport "per connection"
43385 .row tcp:close after transport "per connection"
43386 .row tls:cert before both "per certificate in verification chain"
43387 .row tls:fail:connect after main "per connection"
43388 .row smtp:connect after transport "per connection"
43389 .row smtp:ehlo after transport "per connection"
43390 .row smtp:fail:protocol after main "per connection"
43391 .row smtp:fail:syntax after main "per connection"
43394 New event types may be added in future.
43396 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
43397 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
43398 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
43400 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
43401 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
43402 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
43404 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
43405 should define the event action.
43407 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
43408 with the event type:
43410 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43411 .row auth:fail "smtp response"
43412 .row dane:fail "failure reason"
43413 .row dns:fail "failure reason, key and lookup-type"
43414 .row msg:defer "error string"
43415 .row msg:delivery "smtp confirmation message"
43416 .row msg:fail:internal "failure reason"
43417 .row msg:fail:delivery "smtp error message"
43418 .row msg:host:defer "error string"
43419 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer "error string"
43420 .row msg:rcpt:defer "error string"
43421 .row tls:cert "verification chain depth"
43422 .row tls:fail:connect "error string"
43423 .row smtp:connect "smtp banner"
43424 .row smtp:ehlo "smtp ehlo response"
43425 .row smtp:fail:protocol "error string"
43426 .row smtp:fail:syntax "error string"
43430 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
43432 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&,
43433 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
43434 the course of its processing:
43436 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
43439 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
43440 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
43442 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
43443 a useful way of writing to the main log.
43445 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
43446 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
43447 following will be forced:
43448 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43449 .row auth:fail "log information to write"
43450 .row tcp:connect "do not connect"
43451 .row tls:cert "refuse verification"
43452 .row smtp:connect "close connection"
43454 All other message types ignore the result string, and
43455 no other use is made of it.
43457 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
43458 then the &$host_address$& and &$host_port$& variables
43459 will be that of the proxy and not the target system.
43461 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
43462 chain element received on the connection.
43463 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
43466 For dns:fail events from dnsdb lookups, a &"defer_never"& option does not
43467 affect the reporting of DNS_AGAIN.
43469 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43470 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43472 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
43473 "Adding drivers or lookups"
43474 .cindex "adding drivers"
43475 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
43476 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
43477 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
43478 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
43481 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
43482 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
43484 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
43486 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
43488 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
43489 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
43490 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
43492 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
43494 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
43497 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
43498 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
43500 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
43501 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
43502 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
43503 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
43504 simple form that most lookups have.
43506 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
43507 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
43508 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
43510 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
43511 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
43513 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
43516 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
43517 as for other drivers and lookups.
43520 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
43521 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
43522 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
43523 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
43524 searched using a binary chop procedure.
43526 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
43527 the interface that is expected.
43532 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43533 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43535 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43536 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
43537 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
43538 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
43540 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43545 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
43546 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
43550 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
43551 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
43552 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
43555 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43556 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////